Annual Report and Accounts 2022 1
Annual Report and Accounts 2022 1
Annual Report and Accounts 2022 1
ACCOUNTS 2022
STRATEGIC REPORT
Financial KPIs Non-financial KPIs
Revenue BEVs sold
£8.1bn 1.8%
2021: £6.9bn2 2021: 1.2%
28 5.1%
2021: 4.1%2
24%
Operating and
financial review
Profit before tax and Reputation.com
GOVERNANCE
adjusting items1 score
£373m 671
2021: £249m2 2021: 642
£380m 22%
Leadership positions³
2021: £274m2
2021: 18%
Return on capital
employed!
41%
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
2021: 28%2
76 Metric
Gross Profit
£m
1,325.3
Use of metric
Direct profit contribution
from Value Drivers (e.g.
Governance Vehicles and Aftersales)
Less: Segment operating (914.5)
expenses
Adjusted operating profit¹ 410.8 Profit generated
by the Group
37
Less: adjusting items in (10.5)
net operating expenses
Operating Profit 400.3 Statutory measure
of Operating Profit
Responsible
business Less: Net Finance (67.2)
Costs and JV losses
Profit before tax 333.1 Statutory measure of profit
after the costs of financing
the Group
Add back: adjusting items 10.5
in net operating expenses
Add back: adjusting items 29.6
in net finance costs
Adjusted profit Before Tax¹ 373.2
1. APM (alternative performance measure), see page 206.
2. Restated, see page 142.
3. Includes the Group Executive Team and its direct reports, see page 121.
£8.1bn 175+
AT A GLANCE
50+
Brand partners
19,000¹
Employees
OUR DISTRIBUTION
VALUE CHAIN
Inchcape’s value chain 1. Product planning 4. Channel management
comprises six key elements Using our local market Defining and building the optimal
which provide full spectrum expertise to inform channels to reach consumers
certification and vehicle and businesses covering network
‘Differentiated Distribution’
ordering decisions (model management, digital, and omni-
services for our original types and specifications). channel. This also includes selection
equipment manufacturer and training of independent
(OEM) partners. dealers, and ongoing performance
management.
Our value chain is differentiated
from others by our investments
in digital customer experience,
in data analytics, our global
connected platform – which 2. Logistics 5. Retail services
enables us to deploy our Operating comprehensive Bringing our omni-channel
processes consistently post-factory connections platform to customers to
worldwide – and deep to deliver vehicles and parts deliver world-class, digital-
local market expertise. in our markets. first experiences across our
OEM and market portfolio.
6
REVENUE SPLIT BY REGION
Continents
Retail
40+
Europe & Africa
Americas
Asia Pacific (APAC)
Countries and geographies worldwide
GOVERNANCE
RETAIL
£2.3bn EUROPE & AFRICA
£2.0bn
Australia Belgium North Macedonia
Poland Bulgaria Poland
UK Estonia Romania
Finland Djibouti
Greece Ethiopia
Latvia Kenya
Lithuania
Luxembourg
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
3
markets
14
markets
AMERICAS
£1.5bn ASIA PACIFIC (APAC)
£2.3bn
Argentina Brunei
Barbados Guam
Bolivia Hong Kong
Chile Indonesia
Colombia Macau
Costa Rica Saipan
Ecuador Singapore
El Salvador Thailand
Guatemala Australia
Panama New Zealand
Peru
Uruguay
12
markets
10
markets
OUR LONG-STANDING
PARTNER RELATIONSHIPS
Among Inchcape’s competitive advantages are the duration
and strength of our relationships with mobility companies.
We can trace our involvement with the automotive industry almost as far back Brand partnerships
as its inception, but our direct OEM partnerships began in the 1960s when we page online:
started working with Toyota. Since then we have fostered and maintained www.inchcape.
close relationships with some of the world’s leading automotive manufacturers, com/our-
adding new brands as we have expanded, and bringing further long-standing approach/
relationships into our portfolio through acquisitions. A recent example of this is brand-partners/
the acquisition of Ditec in Chile in 2022 which brought with it a partnership
with Volvo extending to over 60 years.
55 52
Toyota Jaguar
Land Rover
46 35
Suzuki Mercedes-Benz
34 33
Volkswagen BMW Group
Group
30
Subaru
Corporation
STRATEGIC REPORT
ACCELERATING
OUR AMBITION
Transforming Inchcape to accelerate our growth through
Distribution Excellence and Vehicle Lifecycle Services.
GOVERNANCE
OUR GROWTH DRIVERS:
OUR ENABLERS:
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
Culture and Capabilities Digital, Data & Analytics Efficient Scale Operations
Responsible Business
To realise these opportunities, 1. Develop the Culture and Capabilities efficient and effective execution using
we need to build on our core strengths data; and ensure all of this data is
we have identified two of executional excellence and totally secure.
strategic growth drivers, automotive knowledge, blending 3. Develop Efficient Scale Operations
Distribution Excellence and these with the digital, technological to standardise our back office and
and process capabilities needed to
Vehicle Lifecycle Services succeed in the future.
core processes, and apply ‘one best
way’ to make us more efficient and
(see next page) supported 2. Use Digital, Data and Analytics to: more successful.
by three critical enablers: create the consumer experience This is underpinned by our Responsible
relevant to each market based Business plan, ‘Driving What Matters’
on data driven insights; make the which you can read about in detail
business critical decisions that support on pages 37 to 42.
OUR STRATEGIC
GROWTH OPPORTUNITIES
DISTRIBUTION EXCELLENCE:
Annual new car volume (units) Global Distribution Opportunity:
17 million vehicles are sold in markets
Typical distribution best suited to Inchcape – often
Global markets1 smaller, more complex and harder
90m 17m
to reach. Whilst Inchcape is the global
leader, it only has a 2% share of the
global distribution market1. Inchcape
has significantly expanded its footprint
in recent years, but there is still a huge
opportunity to capture a greater
share of the industry.
Expansion
Large markets Organic growth: Inchcape is exposed
opportunities
typically to higher growth markets with low
in markets
insourced by motorisation rates2. Inchcape has a
best suited to
OEMs, e.g., strong record of driving market share
Inchcape
China, US, UK, gains for automotive brands, and is
Brazil, Mexico expected to continue following its
investment in digital and data
capabilities.
Inorganic growth: The combination
Inchcape of Inchcape’s strong financial position,
markets extensive OEM relationships and
17m wordlwide broad geographic footprint makes
it the obvious distribution partner for
Inchcape volumes ambitious automotive brands, with
significant opportunities to drive
further industry consolidation.
1. Defined as those markets with annual new car volumes of less than 1m units 2. Number of vehicles per capita
IO
R U
EN IB business with tailored local market offering and
TIA TR
TED DIS expertise. DXP (Digital eXperience Platform) is
Channel Management Brand & now active in 36 OEM markets (including multiple
Marketing OEM partners in single markets), with more in the
pipeline. DAP (Digital Analytics Platform) provides
advanced analytics and machine learning,
leveraging our data and driving smarter, faster
and better business decisions. You can read more
on page 17.
GOVERNANCE
Initial user users vehicle’s life. 75% of the profit turns
(0-4 years) (4+ years) up from year 4 onwards, and this
segment is currently underserved
Currently
underserved
by Inchcape
Total profit
pool
3x
Initial
25%
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
user
phase
3: Analysis shows the split of profit attainable over an average vehicle’s life, and assumes four different owners during that period.
The analysis captures the vehicle sales, finance & insurance commission and the aftersales services (including independent aftermarket)
SUSTAINABLE GROWTH
AND RETURNS
We have set ambitious targets to grow our business, responsibly,
seeking to create significant value for all of our stakeholders.
INVESTMENT PROPOSITION:
DELIVERING SUSTAINABLE GROWTH AND CASH RETURNS
ATTRACTIVE
SHAREHOLDER RETURNS
CONSOLIDATION
OPPORTUNITIES
MARGIN
EXPANSION Dividend payout: 40%
STRONG
ORGANIC GROWTH
Track record of share
We are a leader with a
buybacks
c.2% share of global
Leverage our global scale distribution
to improve profitability
Market consolidation
Exposure to high-growth expected to accelerate
Actively pursuing higher
markets
margin activities
History of market
outperformance
1. Based on constant exchange rates as at November 2021 (>90% profits derived outside of the UK).
2. Per annum, within five years.
WHY INVEST?
INCHCAPE IS THE GLOBAL LEADER, WITH AN AMBITION TO CONTINUOUSLY GROW
GLOBAL MARKET LEADER A RESPONSIBLE BUSINESS DIGITAL & DATA LEADER
>40
markets covering
50.3%
sites switched to
36
markets now live with DXP (Digital
six continents renewable energy supply eXperience Platform)
The leading automotive distributor Growth ambition underpinned Our digital and data capability is a
in a highly fragmented global by our ESG strategy: Responsible significant competitive advantage
market Business
• Created a leading digital
• P resence across >40 markets; • Responsible Business is integral and analytical platform
covering six continents to our Accelerate strategy • Global scale, and internal
• We are the leader with c.2% • Established four priority areas: capability a key differentiator
share of the global distribution Planet, People, Places, Practices • Our technological progress
market • Due consideration for all is impressing OEM brands
• Market consolidation is stakeholders
expected to accelerate
GOVERNANCE
HIGHLY ATTRACTIVE AND DISCIPLINED
1 2 3 4
INVEST IN THE DIVIDENDS VALUE SHARE
BUSINESS ACCRETIVE M&A BUYBACKS
Capex for organic Policy: 40% annual Disciplined Consider
growth and payout of basic approach to appropriateness
technological adjusted EPS (pre valuation of share buybacks
investment adjusted)
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
£450m capex spend £560m of dividends £1.9bn of distribution £440m of share
(<1% of sales) acquisitions buybacks
Cumulative
2016 to 2022
C
ROCE
.25% >50
OEM brands in our portfolio
75%
of a vehicle’s lifetime value
in higher margin activities
Deliver value through organic Expanding the reach of our Uniquely positioned to capture
growth, consolidation and plug-and-play global distribution more of a vehicle’s lifetime value
cash returns platform
• Higher margin activities;
• Distribution markets have higher • Well invested operating model accounts for 75% of the profit-
growth prospects than average a catalyst for further expansion pool of a vehicle’s life
• Leveraging our global scale • Existing portfolio of >40 OEM • Currently significantly
to improve profitability brands; continuing to add underserved by Inchcape
• Highly attractive returns (c.25% new partners • Clear opportunity to leverage
ROCE) and capital allocation • Constantly sharing expertise our existing footprint
across the Group
NIGEL STEIN
CHAIRMAN
A YEAR
OF IMPRESSIVE
STRATEGIC
PROGRESS
DEAR SHAREHOLDERS
AND STAKEHOLDERS
This has been another good year for
Inchcape. Not only reporting a strong
financial performance, but making
impressive progress against the Company’s
Accelerate strategy. On Shareholders’
behalf I would like to thank all Inchcape
colleagues around the world for their hard
work in achieving this. We are building
an even stronger Inchcape for the future.
STRATEGIC REPORT
which exceeded the level expected in Vehicle Lifecycle Services, retaining bringing a wealth of experience
at the start of the year, was achieved vehicles and owners in our network gained at several major international
without the contribution of our after the typical historic period of three businesses. We are also very pleased
business in Russia, previously a years from sale. During the year, the that, as part of the Derco transaction,
sizeable part of the Group. Following Group has seen significant expansion Juan Pablo Del Río joined the Board
the invasion of Ukraine in February in used vehicle sales under the new bringing his substantial experience of
2022, management took decisive bravoauto brand, with a number both the Latin American automotive
action to exit the Russian market, of branches opened in selected market and business generally in
selling our business to the local Inchcape markets using Group the region. These are two areas of
Inchcape management team in April. best-in-class systems, processes expertise we had previously identified
and skills. as desirable when planning our future
Performance across most of the Board membership.
Groups’ markets was strong, with the Automotive trends
business in the Americas particularly Gijsbert de Zoeten resigned from
The automotive market globally is
so. Due to good margin management the Board in November 2022. We
recovering, with 2023 expected to
significantly increased profits were thank him for the contribution he has
show increased supply from most
achieved in spite of strong inflationary made over the last three years. Adrian
GOVERNANCE
OEMs. In many markets, electric
headwinds, particularly in Europe. Lewis, Group Financial Controller, was
vehicles, both battery electric and
appointed as Acting Chief Financial
hybrid, are in strong demand and we
Acquisitions Officer following Gijsbert’s departure.
expect to see growth accelerate. In
As the year ended, we completed choosing our partners and acquisition John Langston, who has served on
the acquisition of Derco, the largest targets, Inchcape looks to represent the Board for nine years will step down
independent automotive distributor winning OEMs in the new “electrified” at the 2023 Annual General Meeting
in Latin America which will significantly world as well as aligning our customer (AGM). We are most grateful to John
enhance our presence in the region. and service offerings around digital for his enormous contribution to the
It also brings additional fast growing and connected vehicles. Board over those years, including
Chinese brands into the Inchcape
acting as a very effective Audit Chair
portfolio. This has long been a key ESG and Responsible Business and providing wise counsel generally
strategic goal as we expect to see
Electrification is particularly important to both Executives and Non-Executive
Chinese OEMs increasing their
in enabling the automotive industry Directors. Sarah Kuijlaars will assume
market share globally.
to achieve its carbon neutral goals. the role of Audit Chair from the end
Under the Planet pillar of our of the May AGM.
Our expansion in Latin America,
Responsible Business agenda,
which as a region is expected to
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
Inchcape has been working hard Dividend
show above average future growth
to define our plans for achieving this Based on the strong performance in
in vehicle sales, also achieves a
to offer our OEM partners the lowest the year, the Board is recommending
long-term goal of rebalancing our
carbon route to market. that the Company maintains its policy
historic profit reliance on Asia, in
particular Singapore and Hong Kong. of paying a dividend of 40% of annual
Our own Scope 1 and 2 goals have
That said, Asia remains a very basic adjusted EPS. This would result
been set, which include substantial
important market and we were in a overall dividend payment for
short- and long-term reductions.
pleased to announce the acquisition the year of 21.3p.
Scope 3, which relates almost entirely
of CATS in the Philippines in early
to the vehicles we sell, is taking time In light of the Derco acquisition,
January 2023.
to pin down as several OEMs have yet the Board has no short term plans to
to publish substantive information on restart its share buyback programme,
Distribution Excellence their own plans. We continue to keep instead concentrating on paying
Distribution Excellence is another this under close review. down debt and freeing capacity
key pillar of the Accelerate strategy.
for further expansion.
The progress on improving our digital Board changes
offering to give customers the best
The Board had increased Looking forward
possible experience has been truly
engagement throughout 2022, Inchcape looks very well positioned
remarkable, with our two digital
with eight additional meetings held to continue its success. We are
delivery centres in Colombia and the
to consider the Derco acquisition confident that whilst the economic
Philippines contributing strongly. We
and the disposal of the Group’s environment in some markets remains
are rapidly deploying these systems
operations in Russia. I am grateful uncertain, the strength of our business
across our major markets and expect
to my colleagues for their model, the geographic spread of
to see the benefits flowing in the
contribution of additional time global operations, combined with
near future.
and for their expertise generally. the hard work of Inchcape colleagues
across the Group, and some added
momentum from acquisitions will
support the Group’s future progress.
NIGEL STEIN
CHAIRMAN
DUNCAN TAIT
GROUP CEO
STRONG
FINANCIAL
PERFORMANCE IN A
TRANSFORMATIONAL
YEAR
I’m pleased to report the Group delivered
a strong performance during 2022 and
made substantial progress with our two
strategic growth priorities: Distribution
Excellence and Vehicle Lifecycle
Services. In 2022 we completed the
transformational acquisition of Derco,
extending our leadership in automotive
distribution in the highly attractive and
fast-growing Americas region, and
providing a platform for us to capture
more of a vehicle’s lifetime value.
STRATEGIC REPORT
environment – the war in Ukraine, a machine learning, leveraging our through investing in servicing
return to inflation, rising interest rates, data and driving smarter, faster and capacity and supporting customers
and continuing supply constraints better business decisions. DAP is now to install home-charging facilities.
across the globe. capable of optimising 70% of our
revenue streams around the world, Business development
Set against this backdrop, I’m contributing to a better experience We continue to focus on markets
delighted at how the Group for our customers and improved that have high growth potential; and
maintained the momentum we gained financial performance for the Group during 2022 we further expanded our
in 2021, with our teams delivering both and our OEM partners. distribution footprint. We agreed deals
our commercial objectives and our
that increase our existing geographic
purpose of bringing mobility to the Another important part of our
and brand footprint, while giving us
world’s communities – for today, for technological transformation is our
access to new markets and brand
tomorrow and for the better. digital delivery centres (DDCs). Over
partners.
the year, we’ve doubled the number
Performance of ‘Inchcapers’ working in our DDCs At the end of 2022, we completed
Inchcape delivered another strong in Colombia and the Philippines. Now, our transformational acquisition of
set of results in 2022, with double-digit some 1,000 people are providing Derco. The combination of our two
GOVERNANCE
growth across all regions. Continued 24/7 services and solutions, further businesses has created the number
strong consumer demand, following a enhancing our digital delivery one independent distributor in the
prolonged period of supply shortages, capability. Americas, bringing together two
and fantastic operational execution companies with complementary
Vehicle Lifecycle Services is about
from our teams has driven growth in portfolios of OEM partners and
maximising the profitability of a
revenue, profit and cash. aligned cultures.
vehicle in the stages of its life after
Group revenue for the year was its first sale, through used resale, It’s an important step in our ambitious
£8.1bn, an increase of 18% on 2021. servicing, parts and finance and growth journey. The enlarged business
We delivered adjusted profit before insurance products. During 2022, will provide exciting opportunities for
tax of £373m, an increase of 50% on we’ve taken some big strides towards our colleagues, OEM partners, dealers
2021 driven by top line growth and our VLS ambitions, especially in used and customers. You can read about
improved operating margins. We also vehicles through our global Used Car the acquisition in detail on pages
reported free cash flow of £380m, up Excellence (UCX) programme and 24 to 25.
39% on last year, further strengthening in building our bravoauto brand.
our cash position. I’m pleased with the progress we’re We also acquired a 70% stake in
making with bravoauto, which is now Ditec, the distributor of Porsche, Volvo
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
I believe our success over the past live in nine markets across Europe, and Jaguar Land Rover in Chile. This
year demonstrates the strength of APAC and the Americas. It’s a has broadened our growing footprint
our strategy and platform which is digital-first proposition in which we in the Americas and added Porsche
powered by the unique expertise of are building momentum in volumes and Volvo – two leading premium
our people, our suite of cutting-edge adding great value for our customers brands – to our list of OEM partners.
technology products, and our and revenues for the Group.
advanced data analytics approach. During the year we acquired the
We’ve also made good progress ITC Group, owner of Interamericana
with our digital parts platform, which Trading Corporation (ITC) and
Strategic development
is planned for launch in 2023. Simpson Motors from the Simpson
In last year’s report, I described
Group. The acquisition gives us entry
how we had been rolling out our The Group’s digital transformation is into the Caribbean, further building
Accelerate strategy across the Group. fundamental to our future success, on our presence in the Americas.
given the changing nature of our It also strengthens our geographic
At the time of our last capital markets
industry – not only in the rise of electric reach with Suzuki, Mercedes-Benz
day in November 2021 we had just
vehicles (EVs), but in the changing and Subaru, while broadening our
over a one per cent share of our
expectations of customers. OEM relationships, with the addition
target market of 17 million vehicles.
As we set out to be the undisputed of Chrysler and other Stellantis brands.
People want more of a digital
number one distribution company experience, both in terms of buying We have further pursued growth with
in our industry, we have, through and ownership of vehicles. We see this EV-first brands, enhancing our offering
organic growth, the addition of wherever we deploy DXP, for example, in established markets. In Hong Kong
new OEM partners, and market resulting in a rise in customer and Macau, we have partnered with
consolidation, positioned ourselves to satisfaction scores. Similarly, OEMs Great Wall Motor’s ORA brand of
achieve market share of two per cent. know digital is vital for the future of EV-only cars and in Belgium and
our industry and want to partner Luxembourg we were awarded the
We’ve continued to develop and
with businesses that are making exclusive sales contract for BYD.
roll out our omni-channel platform
the right investments.
(known as DXP for Digital eXperience
In February 2022 we announced the
Platform). This provides customers Equally, I believe there’s nobody disposal of our remaining retail-only
with a seamless customer experience better placed than Inchcape to help business in Russia, selling to our
however they choose to interact with OEMs introduce new technology to management team in the market.
us, and is rolling out to more markets, our markets. We’re helping brands
with more mobility company partners to operate in new markets where
all the time. there’s very little public charging
infrastructure, such as in Chile with
Responsible business Our Places agenda is all about being I would like to thank all our colleagues
In last year’s report, I described how a good company where we operate. for the contributions they’ve made
we had developed our Responsible It’s been hugely rewarding to see during the year, both as individuals
Business plan. It focuses on our ‘4Ps’ of what we’re doing – for example, in and within the teams that have
responsible business – Planet, People, some of the markets we operate in collectively helped us achieve
Places and Practices – and reaches we’re working with local communities another strong performance.
into those areas of our operations to provide disabled people with
where we can make a positive prosthetic limbs. Our safe driving I would also like to thank my
difference for our stakeholders. programme is another example colleagues on the Executive team
of how we’re contributing to for their leadership and teamwork
Over the past year, we’ve focused communities around the world. during the last year. I am delighted
on bedding in our plan. Much to my to welcome Liz Brown to the Group
delight, it’s been embraced positively The Practices aspect of our Executive Team in the new position of
by our people and our partners, Responsible Business Plan is critical Chief Strategy Officer. Liz joined us in
which has been evident wherever for us in topics such as our Codes February 2023 with a remit to lead the
I’ve travelled to meet our teams. of Conduct, bribery and corruption, future development of our strategy,
and money laundering, all of which as well as leading our strategic OEM
Our work to make a difference for the enables us to protect our people, relationships. You can read more
planet includes reducing our Scope 1 our business and our partners’ brand about Liz on page 81.
and 2 CO2 emissions. I’m pleased to equity. Equally, I believe OEMs want
report that we’re ahead of our to know they’re working with partners Looking ahead
targets, and you can read more who are committed to their own
Inchcape has a diverse portfolio
about this in our TCFD report on responsibility agenda, such as having
and revenue streams, strong balance
pages 44 to 54. health and safety programmes that
sheet and disciplined approach to
look after both employees and
If we’re going to fully realise our investment; in the face of a global
customers. We continue to perform
Accelerate ambitions, we need cost-of-living crisis and rising interest
well in this regard; for example, by
brilliant people inside our company – rates, these provide the foundation
achieving ISO 45001 at the end of
and we know that brilliant people of our resilience and long-term
2022 for our own global health and
want to work for leading responsible sustainability.
safety systems.
businesses. This is why the People In this context, and that of a
aspect of our Responsible Business Overall, I’m pleased at the progress transitioning mobility industry, I’m more
plan is an important factor in how we’re making as a responsible certain than ever that Accelerate is
successful we are in attracting and business. As ever though, it’s work in the right strategy for the Group. It’s
retaining talent at Inchcape. We have progress – there’s much more for us to evident in how our OEM partners are
continued our Women into Leadership do, so we can make even more of a supportive of our consolidation
programme with further cohorts in positive difference within the markets activities. It’s evident in how consumers
2022 and ran Inclusive Leadership for in which we operate. You can read are responding to what we’re doing
all our senior leadership population more about our progress in these with DXP and bravoauto.
(the Group Executive Team and areas in our Responsible Business
The year ahead will see us working
its direct reports). We will have report on pages 37 to 42.
hard on integrating Derco into
completed this for the next level
Inchcape in the Americas. We’ve
of management by the end of Our people
made a strong start, but we must
Q1 this year. As I described earlier, having brilliant make sure we deliver on our
people inside our company is commitments to Derco, our partners,
fundamental to making Accelerate our people and our shareholders.
a success. There’s absolutely no doubt
the Inchcape team has delivered for
our OEM partners, shareholders and
other stakeholders during 2022.
STRATEGIC REPORT
READING
Another important task for 2023 will Investment case INVESTMENT CASE
STRATEGIC REPORT
P8 SUSTAINABLE GROWTH
AND RETURNS
to life. This will include operational We have set ambitious targets to grow our business, responsibly,
seeking to create significant value for all of our stakeholders.
In addition to our growth ambitions, the business is asset-light with a long history of
disciplined capital allocation and delivering highly attractive returns to shareholders.
GOVERNANCE
DELIVERING SUSTAINABLE GROWTH AND CASH RETURNS HIGHLY ATTRACTIVE AND DISCIPLINED
ATTRACTIVE
SHAREHOLDER RETURNS 1 2 3 4
INVEST IN THE DIVIDENDS VALUE SHARE
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
Actively pursuing higher expected to accelerate
markets £450m capex spend £560m of dividends £1.9bn of distribution £440m of share
margin activities (<1% of sales) acquisitions buybacks
Cumulative
History of market 2016 to 2022
outperformance
1. Based on constant exchange rates as at November 2021 (>90% profits derived outside of the UK).
2. Per annum, within five years.
Vehicle Lifecycle Services:
>£50m incremental profit contribution2
STRONG BALANCE SHEET NET DEBT TO EBITDA OF MAX 1x (PRE IFRS16)
GOVERNANCE
We continue to focus on the medium-
WHY INVEST?
INCHCAPE IS THE GLOBAL LEADER, WITH AN AMBITION TO CONTINUOUSLY GROW
GLOBAL MARKET LEADER A RESPONSIBLE BUSINESS DIGITAL & DATA LEADER ATTRACTIVE FINANCIALS GROWING BRAND PRESENCE NEW OPPORTUNITIES
The leading automotive distributor Growth ambition underpinned Our digital and data capability is a Deliver value through organic Expanding the reach of our Uniquely positioned to capture
in a highly fragmented global by our ESG strategy: Responsible significant competitive advantage growth, consolidation and plug-and-play global distribution more of a vehicle’s lifetime value
market Business cash returns platform
• Created a leading digital • Higher margin activities;
markets day:
• Presence across >40 markets; • Responsible Business is integral and analytical platform • Distribution markets have higher • Well invested operating model accounts for 75% of the profit-
covering six continents to our Accelerate strategy • Global scale, and internal growth prospects than average a catalyst for further expansion pool of a vehicle’s life
• We are the leader with c.2% • Established four priority areas: capability a key differentiator • Leveraging our global scale • Existing portfolio of >40 OEM • Currently significantly
share of the global distribution Planet, People, Places, Practices • Our technological progress to improve profitability brands; continuing to add underserved by Inchcape
market • Due consideration for all is impressing OEM brands • Highly attractive returns (c.25% new partners • Clear opportunity to leverage
• Market consolidation is stakeholders ROCE) and capital allocation • Constantly sharing expertise our existing footprint
expected to accelerate across the Group
• Distribution Excellence:
8 INCHCAPE ANNUAL REPORT AND ACCOUNTS 2022 INCHCAPE ANNUAL REPORT AND ACCOUNTS 2022 9
STRATEGIC REPORT
P24 DERCO ACQUISITION “We are delighted to welcome the Derco team to
GOVERNANCE
completed on 31 December 2022, and the core focus for 2023 is on integrating our operations in the Americas.
Group CEO
£2.2bn ~4,500
• Increases exposure to higher
Strong growth markets Barbados
topline growth COSTA RICA
• Leverage combined scale Chile (headquarters)
prospects to capture more vehicle Colombia
PANAMA
revenue (2022) colleagues lifetime value Costa Rica
EL SALVADOR COLOMBIA
4 11
for the Group
upside • Significant opportunity Guatemala ECUADOR
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
for synergies Panama
Peru
markets1 OEM brands
Uruguay
• Significantly increases
Distribution Inchcape’s distribution scale Derco PERU
consolidation
24 INCHCAPE ANNUAL REPORT AND ACCOUNTS 2022 INCHCAPE ANNUAL REPORT AND ACCOUNTS 2022 25
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
our stakeholders.
STRATEGIC REPORT
contributing positively and driving capabilities, and strong financial 2022, the Group’s net debt position
Strategic Report
growth across our key financial position makes us the consolidator was £378m. Given the pipeline of
and non-financial metrics. of choice in the highly fragmented M&A opportunities and our current
automotive distribution industry. In leverage position, we have paused
During the year, consumer 2022 we continued to expand our share buybacks, but will continue
demand remained robust against distribution business through bolt-on to review the appropriateness in line
review
the backdrop of vehicle supply acquisitions in the Americas, further with our capital allocation policy. The
constraints, which supported our contract wins and the exciting Group’s proposed dividend in relation
performance during the year. We acquisition of Derco, an important to 2022 is 28.8p, up from 22.5p in 2021.
P28
used), although this normalised during focus on cash resulted in a record a vehicle’s lifetime value. While we
the second half of the year. level of free cash flow of £380m, are excited about our progress so far,
ADRIAN LEWIS
GOVERNANCE
pages 2 to 67, were reviewed and
versus the previous record of £314m we will maintain our capital allocation
ACTING CHIEF FINANCIAL OFFICER
Underpinning this is the quality of in 2017. As we look ahead, the discipline, and remain focused on
our people and the strength of our acquisition of Derco will provide delivering benefits to all stakeholders.
business model. This enabled the opportunities for us to deploy our
Group to accelerate performance own practices and processes to ADRIAN LEWIS
together with increased geographic drive working capital efficiencies ACTING CHIEF FINANCIAL OFFICER
diversification, which will continue and additional cash-flow generation.
to drive resilience amid economic
GREAT
STRATEGIC, KEY PERFORMANCE INDICATORS
HIGHLIGHTS
on 22 March 2023
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
Revenue Our results are stated at actual exchange rates. However, to enhance
£8.1bn
FINANCIAL AND
comparability we also present year-on-year changes in sales and adjusted
operating profit in constant currency, thereby isolating the impact of
translational exchange rate effects. Unless otherwise stated, changes are
2021: £6.9bn1 expressed in constant currency and figures are stated before adjusting items.
OPERATIONAL
% change
Adjusted operating margin2 % change constant % change
£5.1%
2022 20211 reported FX2 organic3
Key financials (continuing operations)
PROGRESS
Revenue £8,133m £6,901m +18% +16% +15%
2021: 4.1%1 Adjusted Operating Profit1 £411m £281m +46% +41%
Adjusted Operating Margin1 5.1% 4.1% +100bps +90bps
DUNCAN TAIT
Profit before tax and adjusting items1 Adjusted Profit Before Tax1 £373m £249m +50%
£380m
GROUP CEO
Operating Profit (continuing operations) £400m £181m
2022 was a transformational year for the Group Profit Before Tax (continuing operations) £333m £149m
as we made great strides with our strategy, 2021: £274m1
Total (loss)/profit for the year £(6)m £122m
further shifting our portfolio towards distribution Basic EPS (continuing operations) 61.1p 20.3p
and developing our vehicle lifecycle services Return on capital employed1
41%
offering. 1. Restated to adjust for the disposal of the remaining business in Russia which has been reported as
a discontinued operation, see page 142
2. These measures are Alternative Performance Measures, see pages 206 to 207
Fantastic operational execution from all our 3. Organic growth is defined as revenue growth in operations that have been open for at least a year
teams drove growth in revenue and profit, 2021: 28%1
at constant foreign exchange rates
28.8p
2021: 22.5p
28 INCHCAPE ANNUAL REPORT AND ACCOUNTS 2022 INCHCAPE ANNUAL REPORT AND ACCOUNTS 2022 29
Responsible
Business
RESPONSIBLE BUSINESS
STRATEGIC REPORT
P37
the Caribbean. In 2022 we completed the part of our strategy, mapping the way Inchcape creates sustainable value
acquisition of Derco, adding Suzuki to our for all our stakeholders.
operations in Chile, Colombia and Peru,
and adding Boliva to the portfolio.
Locations
Developing our approach to responsible business is central our organisation, as well as full accessibility for our
Distribution: to our future plans at Inchcape. We know it will provide customers; by ensuring the safety and supporting the
GOVERNANCE
Argentina, Barbados+, Bolivia, measurable benefits to Inchcape, bringing us closer to health and wellbeing of our employees; and in supporting
Chile, Colombia, Costa Rica, our customers and partners: it will make Inchcape a more mobility and economic development in the communities
Panama, Peru, Singapore rewarding and safer place to work; it will help us recruit, in which we operate.
engage and retain the best talent; and it will ensure we
remain a trusted partner to the OEMs with whom we work. To deliver this requires us to have a plan that is supported
These elements are fundamental to the successful delivery with a robust framework. Our ‘Driving What Matters’ plan
of our Accelerate strategy and to ensuring Inchcape’s has been designed collaboratively with our markets, for
sustainability for the long-term. ownership and delivery by our teams, locally. The plan
concentrates on our 4Ps (or pillars) of Responsible Business
We are united with the interests of all our stakeholders in – Planet, People, Places, and Practices.
the need to play our role in making a positive contribution
to the communities in which we operate, for our people, Mindful of the need to reflect the different laws, regulations,
for society and for the planet. For Inchcape though, being and cultures where we operate, we have designed a
a responsible business extends into other key areas of our global framework with workstream charters that local
operations where we can make a positive difference to markets use to respond to what is important to meet
our stakeholders: by improving inclusion and diversity in the needs of their local stakeholders.
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
• Inclusion and Diversity • Strengthening our • Safe mobility • Mapping the risks and
• Safety and Wellbeing governance policies • Inclusive mobility opportunities of climate
• Talent and Skills • Reflecting our position • Social mobility change
as an international plc • Setting GHG targets
• Reducing waste
People pillar: R U OK Day, September 2022 Places pillar: Movilizando Corazones prosthetics donation programme,
Inchcape Australia Inchcape Colombia
36 INCHCAPE ANNUAL REPORT AND ACCOUNTS 2022 INCHCAPE ANNUAL REPORT AND ACCOUNTS 2022 37
EMBRACING CHANGES
TO OUR INDUSTRY
Strong business model and We provide OEMs with a Our digital and data Solid Responsible Business
a diversified OEM portfolio solution in lower volume capabilities allow us to agenda implemented
has proven resilient in and high growth potential better understand across our markets
turbulent times emerging markets consumers and cater to
their needs, optimising their
experience
GOVERNANCE
to digital and physical sales channels, service specialists and very importantly, customers.
DIGITAL Digital Experience Platform (DXP) is our digital touchpoint with customers. It
EXPERIENCE provides a fully functional digital showroom and links with dealerships to deliver
PLATFORM a seamless omni-channel experience, which customers tell us is a priority for
OMNI-CHANNEL them. It has been built on a platform that has the ability to scale quickly into
new markets and add new OEM brands.
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
Marketable customers: Sales conversion: Outperformance:
Enables the capture of Digital customers opting Proportion of marketable New vehicle volume
into marketing comms customers translating into growth versus the market
significant customer and a vehicle order
vehicle data
DATA Data Analytics Platform (DAP) is all about predictive analytics and business
ANALYTICS intelligence – combining this with DXP gives us significant advantages over our
PLATFORM distribution competitors. The team has now built algorithms and analytics tools
DATA ANALYTICS to support both vehicle and parts sales and operational planning (S&OP),
aftersales churn prediction and lead scoring to focus sales teams on genuine
‘hot’ leads.
Central capability to
drive better local and MORE IMPROVED HIGHER
global decisions CUSTOMERS EFFICIENCIES GROWTH
OEMs Markets
Organisational
Haval Bolivia
• Focus on retaining and nurturing
ORA
Porsche talent
Renault • ‘Responsible Business’
Volvo programme
Joylong
Revenue
• Opportunity to professionalise
New DS +£2.3bn processes
Existing BYD
Colombia
Changan
Chevrolet Chile
Geely Ecuador
JAC
Jaguar Land Rover Peru
Mazda Belgium
Suzuki Luxembourg
Number of
distribution deals 2 2 3 3 5 5 5 25
Distribution
revenue added1 £400m £100m £250m £150m £200m £200m £2.3bn £3.6bn
Retail revenue
disposed (£70m) (£80m) (£90m) (£600m) (£570m) (£300m) (£730m) (£2.4bn)
1. Shows revenue reported in the last full financial year prior to Inchcape’s ownership (e.g. Derco acquired on 31 December 2022, and ‘revenue added’ is the
£2.2bn generated in the year ending December 2022)
Locations
Distribution:
GOVERNANCE
Belgium, Brunei, Bulgaria, Djibouti,
Ethiopia, Greece, Guam, Hong
Kong, Luxembourg, Macau, North
Macedonia, Saipan, Romania,
Singapore, Chile and Colombia
Retail:
UK
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
FORGING STRONG
RELATIONSHIPS
GOVERNANCE
We aim to enable every colleague Our objective is to deliver outstanding We have a balanced approach to
to achieve their personal goals at returns on long-term investment based engagement with the communities
each stage of the employee journey; on a sustainable platform for growth, in which we operate, empowering
to recognise and develop talent; and disciplined approach to capital ownership at local level with structural
to foster a socially conscious culture allocation and cash returns through support from Group.
based on inclusion, empowerment and dividends and share buyback.
optimised potential through learning.
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
• Strategy • Strategy • Local employment
• Reward, training and development, • Company purpose and values • Health and safety, including local
diversity and inclusion • Financial performance and strength environmental concerns, e.g. waste
• Strong approach to health and of balance sheet disposal
safety – duty of care • Capital allocation • Community activities, e.g. support
• Company purpose and values • Responsible Business/ESG of local charities
• Long-term commercial sustainability • Long-term commercial sustainability • Road safety campaigns in some
• Security of employment stemming and business viability markets
from business viability • Key developments in the business and • Responsible approach to local law
• Responsible employer issues we are facing and regulations
• Consultation with employees on the • Held over 200 investor meetings • Around 19,000 people employed in
2022 Remuneration Policy during 2022 over 40 countries and geographies
• Held four employee forums in 2022 • Consultation with shareholders on • Strong levels of local community
• Employee engagement event in the 2022 Remuneration Policy involvement including road safety
Santiago facilitated by the • 99.9% votes in favour for Derco campaigns and inclusive mobility
designated Non-Executive Director acquisition at EGM
• Three day leadership strategy event • Launched the ‘In the Driving Seat’
held in November in Austin, Texas investor webinar series
Q2 Trading • Q1 trading update with Q&A • Performance during the first quarter of • Appreciation for swift and clean exit from
• Investor conferences 2022 and completion of exit from Russia Russia
AGM • 2022 AGM held on 19 May 2022 • No issues were raised by shareholders • All resolutions passed with over 90% of
votes in favour
Webinar • Launched first webinar for our “In the • Focus on the Group’s fastest growing • Positive engagement from investors and
Driving Seat” series with a “Spotlight on region, and the growth prospects going analysts; appreciated the deep-dive on
the Americas” forward within Distribution Excellence the region showing its evolution/growth
and Vehicle Lifecycle Services.
Q3 Trading • Interim results and presentation with Q&A • 2022 interim performance and dividend • Key area of focus was the Derco
• Investor roadshow and conferences acquisition which was well received
Remuneration • Consultation with shareholders on • ESG metrics, pension alignment and • Positive feedback that policy is working
proposed 2023 Remuneration Policy continued use of two long term well. Caution advised on the use of ESG
incentive plans metrics. Further information on page 99
Derco • Derco acquisition announced on 28 July • Proposal of the Derco acquisition • Further information on page 21
2022
Q4 Trading • Q3 trading update with Q&A • Performance during the third quarter • Key areas of focus were inflationary
• Investor roadshow of 2022 headwinds, vehicle supply, interest rates,
• Update to our FY22 outlook and demand trends across our markets
Webinar • Hosted our second webinar for our “In the • Progress the Group has made on its digital • Positive engagement from investors and
Driving Seat” series with a “Spotlight on and data journey and how it is integral analysts; appreciated insights on how
Digital & Data” to the Group’s growth ambitions integral digital and data is to the business
Derco • Derco acquisition circular sent to • No matters were raised by shareholders • The resolution passed with 99.99% of
shareholders. EGM held on 16 December votes in favour. Transaction completed
2022 on 31 December 2023
• In response to investor feedback on understanding further key areas of our business, we launched our “In the Driving Seat” series.
We hosted our first webinar in Q2 on “Spotlight on Americas”, and in Q4 our second one in the series “Spotlight on Digital & Data”.
£1.2bn
2016: £160m Digital experience Data analytics platform
platform Predictive analytics and
OEM brands BMW* Fuso Mini Omni-channel business intelligence
25
BMW Motorrad* Geely Porsche • Providing consumers with • Central capability to drive
BYD Hino Rolls Royce a fully functioning digital better local and global
showroom decision
Changan Jac Motors Subaru
Chrysler Jaguar Suzuki • Built on a platform with the • Using predictive analytics
ability to scale, quickly, to to facilitate business
Diechi Jeep Volvo intelligence
new markets
DFSK Land Rover Western Star
• Enables the capture • Globally integrated data
Doosan Mack of significant customer repository, addressing
Freightliner Mercedes-Benz and vehicle data the entire value chain
12
Barbados (+)* Ecuador Peru* Inchcape Digital Architecture: Digital Delivery Centres:
Chile* El Salvador Uruguay a single common global our internal digital delivery
Colombia Guatemala technology stack capability
1. 2021 revenue pro forma for acquisitions announced up until 30 June 2022 pre-Derco
+ Indicates the base of the core distribution operations which also serves as other neighbouring islands
* part of the Inchcape business in 2016
Consequences of long-term decisions The Derco acquisition brought five new OEM brands to
GOVERNANCE
Many of the decisions the Board makes today will affect the the Inchcape Group. When reaching its decision on the
success of the Group in the longer term. When making such acquisition, the Board considered the OEM brand portfolio
decisions, the Board considers what value will be created as a whole, agreeing a programme of engagement with
for shareholders, if the appropriate resources are available, both current and new OEM brand partners to ensure
how current and future employees will be affected and what strategies and expectations are aligned.
impacts these decisions will have on communities and the
Impact of communities and the environment
environment in which Inchcape operates. Consideration is
also given to the ‘what ifs’ as long-term decisions, by their The Planet pillar assesses the impact the automotive industry
nature, contain a degree of uncertainty about what may has on the environment and the impact of climate change
happen in the future. upon our business by focusing on understanding the Group’s
climate related risks and opportunities and Scope 1,2 and 3
The Board’s risk management procedures identify the emissions. During the year, the Board considered whether it
potential consequences of decisions in the short, medium was appropriate to set emissions reduction targets for Scope
and long term so that mitigation plans can be put in place to 3, which account for 99.97% of the Groups’ total footprint.
prevent, reduce or eliminate risks to the business and wider Ultimately the Board decided not to set science-based
stakeholders. Please see pages 59 to 66 for further details. Scope 3 targets due to the complexities of achieving targets
Further information on the significant decisions taken by where we have limited control. However, this will be reviewed
the Board during the year are given in the Corporate on a regular basis by the Board who are committed to
Governance Report on page 82. tackling the impacts of climate change. Please see pages
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
The Responsible Business framework: Driving What Matters, 44 to 54 for further information.
which is owned and delivered by our colleagues around
High standards of business conduct
the Group, sets out what responsible business means for
Inchcape under four pillars, People, Places, Practices and It is important to the Board to maintain a reputation for high
Planet. Please see pages 37 to 42 for further information. standards of business conduct. This is taken into account by
the Board when making material decisions, i.e. acquisitions,
The pillars focus on the issues that are important to our joint ventures and remuneration outcomes.
employees, our communities, ensuring ethical business
conduct, and the environment. The data points give the During the decision-making process for the Derco acquisition
Board context for what the potential consequences of the Board reviewed the due diligence findings, management
long-term decisions will be. and external advisor reports, and its reputation locally. The
Derco business is well respected, with a strong culture that is
Interests of employees similar to Inchcape’s. However, there are always integration
A major transaction such as the Derco acquisition will bring and business plan risks associated with acquisitions.
uncertainty for employees in both businesses, as there is a Therefore, the Board approved a set of 11 key controls which
likelihood that some roles are duplicated and/or become can be implemented from day one to mitigate those risks.
redundant. The Board took these impacts into consideration
Shareholders
during the decision making process and, while it is always
a difficult decision to remove roles, the Board agreed Engagement is a key tool for taking into account the views
becoming part of a larger global organisation will also offer of shareholders. During 2022, the Remuneration Committee
career development opportunities for Derco employees. Chair and the Chairman carried out a shareholder
A comprehensive change management and consultation on the proposed remuneration policy which
communications plan was put in place including a series will be put to shareholder vote at the Annual General
of townhalls to explain the acquisition process, start the Meeting in May 2023. The feedback received from investors
on-boarding programme, and to provide an opportunity provided valuable input for the Committee, especially
for employees to express their views. around introducing a carbon reduction related ESG target
into the long-term incentive plans. Further details are given
Further information on engagement with employees, any on page 99.
outcomes where applicable, and decisions which have
affected employees, are given throughout this report. The Board approved a range of activities designed to
enhance shareholder value, including dividend policy,
Fostering business relationships share buyback programme and the acquisition of Derco,
Our OEM relationships are of paramount importance to which was overwhelmingly approved by shareholders at
the achievement of the Accelerate strategy and the length the EGM in December 2022 with 99.99% of votes in favour.
of these relationships is testament to their strength. When Further information on how the Derco acquisition will create
considering acquisitions and new partnerships which are shareholder value is given on pages 24 to 25.
fundamental to achieve the Group’s purpose of bringing All shareholders are invited to attend the Annual General
mobility to the world’s communities – for today, for Meeting and have the opportunity to speak or ask questions
tomorrow and for the better the Board considers whether to the Board members.
the combination of Inchcape and the OEM will be a good
strategic and cultural fit.
DERCO ACQUISITION
Extending Inchcape’s global leadership in automotive distribution
As outlined in our Accelerate strategy (see pages 5 to 7), the global automotive market presents significant
opportunities for Inchcape to consolidate in the distribution market. Despite being the biggest independent
automotive distributor, we had been tracking at around 1% of the 17 million vehicle volume addressable
market. Accelerating acquisitions in this fragmented market is a key part of our growth strategy.
The Group announced its proposed acquisition of Derco in July 2022. Prior to Inchcape‘s acquisition, Derco,
a family-founded and privately owned company, was the largest independent automotive distributor in Latin
America with revenue in 2022 of £2.2bn. Following shareholder and market regulatory approval, the deal
completed on 31 December 2022, and the core focus for 2023 is on integrating our operations in the Americas.
£2.2bn ~4,500
• Increases exposure to higher
Strong growth markets
topline growth • Leverage combined scale
prospects to capture more vehicle
revenue (2022) colleagues lifetime value
4 11
for the Group
upside • Significant opportunity
for synergies
markets1 OEM brands
• Significantly increases
Distribution Inchcape’s distribution scale
consolidation
150k 329
• Global automotive distribution
remains highly fragmented
DUNCAN TAIT
GOVERNANCE
Group CEO
OUR LOCATIONS
Inchcape GUATEMALA
Argentina BARBADOS
Barbados
COSTA RICA
Chile (headquarters)
PANAMA
Colombia
Costa Rica
EL SALVADOR COLOMBIA
Ecuador
El Salvador
Guatemala ECUADOR
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
Panama
Peru
Uruguay
erco
D PERU
Bolivia
Chile (headquarters)
Colombia BOLIVIA
Peru
Derco brands
• Changan • Haval
• Chevrolet • Jac Motors
• Citroen • Joylong
• DS Automobiles • Mazda
• Great Wall • Renault
• Suzuki
MEASURING PROGRESS
performance
measures
Key performance indicators (KPIs) provide insight into how the Board and Group Executive Team monitor the
Group’s strategic and financial performance, as well as directly linking to the key measures for Executive remuneration.
KPIs are stated in actual rates of exchange and pages 206 to 207 provides definitions of KPIs and other alternative
performance measures.
FINANCIAL KPIS
£8.1bn
2021 £6.9bn of success.
2020 £6.8bn 2022 performance
2019 £9.4bn The Group has delivered £8.1bn, up 15%
2021: £6.9bn2 organically (excluding currency effects and
2018 £9.3bn
net M&A) and up 18% reported versus prior
Definition year. This has been driven by robust consumer
Consideration receivable from the sale of goods demand following a prolonged period of
and services. It is stated net of rebates and any supply shortages.
discounts, and excludes sales related taxes.
5.1%
2019 4.0% 2022 performance
Operating margin is 5.1%, up 100bps versus
2018 4.3%
2021. This is owing to a combination of higher
Definition vehicle gross margins, driven largely by the
2021: 4.1%2 Operating profit from continuing operations combination of robust consumer demand
(before adjusting items) divided by sales. and supply shortages.
£373m
2019 £326m In 2022 this increased 50% to £373m, reflecting
the strong improvement in revenue and
2018 £351m
operating profit.
Definition
2021: £249m2 Represents the profit made after operating
and interest expense excluding the impact
of adjusting items and before tax is charged.
£380m
2021 £274m inorganic growth and to make distributions
2020 £177m to shareholders.
2019 £213m £289m 2022 performance
2021: £274m2 The Group delivered free cash flow (FCF)
2018 £279m
of £380m, an increase of 39% on 2021 and
Definition representing a conversion of operating profit
Net cash flows from operating activities, before of 92%, exceeding the long-term average
adjusting cash flows, less net capital expenditure of 60-70%.
and dividends paid to non-controlling interests.
41%
2020 12% we invest.
2019 22% 2022 performance
ROCE for the period was 41%, compared to
2018 22%
2021: 28%2 28%2 for the equivalent period last year. This
Definition increase was primarily driven by the recovery
Operating profit (before adjusting items) divided in Group profits.
by the average of opening and closing capital
employed where capital employed is defined
as net assets add net debt/less net funds.
STRATEGIC REPORT
Distribution
People
Planet
Over the year we have introduced a number of new Non-financial KPIs which align to our business model as part of our
Accelerate strategy and “Driving What Matters” plan. Our focus on the customer whilst operating responsibly is at the heart
of our business model. This is a fundamental to our strategy, and maps the way Inchcape creates sustainable value for all
our stakeholders.
NON-FINANCIAL 2018
KPIS [XX]%
2019 [XX]%
BEV’s sold 2022 1.8% Why we measure
This is a new KPI in 2022. A core element of our strategy is
1.8%
2021 1.2%
the deployment of Battery Electric Vehicles (BEV’s), which
2020 0.8% underpins our core business model and is fundamental
GOVERNANCE
Definition to the long-term sustainability of the business.
2021: 1.2% % of battery electric vehicles (BEV) 2022 performance
2018BEV’s are fully battery
sold. £XXbn
powered We continue to make progress on increasing the number
and
2019run on electric power.
£XXbn of BEV’s sold. As part of our Responsible Business Plan we
will continue to see growth in this trend, particularly in our
2020 £XXbn
developed markets.
2021 £XXbn
Reduction in 2022 24% Why we measure
This is a new KPI in 2022. Reducing the emissions over
Scope 1 and Definition which we have the greatest degree of control is a key
Scope 2 GHG Aggregate Scope 1 and Scope 2 sustainability priority for the Group. We have set targets for
GHG emissions in 2022 vs 2019 base.* Scopes 1 and 2 using Science Based Targets Methodology
emissions For further information on TCFD see with the aim of reducing our emissions by 46% by 2030 and
24%
pages 44 to 54 achieving net zero by 2040.
2022 Performance
Scope 1 and 2 emissions were reduced by 9,800 tonnes
* 2019 figures have been restated to reflect
measured on a market basis and by 8,700 tonnes on
relevant disposals, acquisitions and data
a location basis against the 2019 revised baseline. This is
rectification
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
included in the strategic element of the CEO bonus –
please see pages 96 to 116 for further details.
671
2020 566 experience measure using Google Business Profiles and
2019 522
monitors customer sentiment.
2022 Performance
2018 475
2021: 642 Adoption of Reputation.com is at an all-time high and
Definition we see this through our strong increase in 2022. We have
A measure of the end customer been focusing on improving the things within our control,
experience in our dealerships (both ensuring data accuracy, and helpful, timely responses
distribution and retail), using Google to customer input, whilst offering a high level of service
Business Profiles star ratings among in our dealerships around the world.
other metrics. Score up to 1000.
22%
Percentage of women in top three months of programme completion and to increase the
bands, which includes the Group proportion of women in senior positions from 18% to 30%
Executive Team and its direct by the end of 2025.
reports. 2022 Performance
2021: 18% Please see page 121 for more Since the programme inception, six cohorts have
information, including a complete launched covering all geographic regions, with 45 women
breakdown of the gender diversity completing the pilot programme in 2021 and a further 45
within the Group. women completing the 2022 programme. Mentoring was
also added to the 2022 programme.
ADRIAN LEWIS
ACTING CHIEF FINANCIAL OFFICER
GREAT
STRATEGIC,
FINANCIAL AND
OPERATIONAL
PROGRESS
I am pleased to present the Operating and
Financial Review for 2022, a year in which the
Group has continued to make substantial
strategic, operational and financial progress.
2022 was a transformational year for the Group
as we made great strides with our strategy,
further shifting our portfolio towards distribution
and developing our vehicle lifecycle services
offering.
Fantastic operational execution from all our
teams drove growth in revenue and profit,
and another year of excellent cash flow.
STRATEGIC REPORT
contributing positively and driving capabilities, and strong financial 2022, the Group’s net debt position
growth across our key financial position makes us the consolidator was £378m. Given the pipeline of
and non-financial metrics. of choice in the highly fragmented M&A opportunities and our current
automotive distribution industry. In leverage position, we have paused
During the year, consumer 2022 we continued to expand our share buybacks, but will continue
demand remained robust against distribution business through bolt-on to review the appropriateness in line
the backdrop of vehicle supply acquisitions in the Americas, further with our capital allocation policy. The
constraints, which supported our contract wins and the exciting Group’s proposed dividend in relation
performance during the year. We acquisition of Derco, an important to 2022 is 28.8p, up from 22.5p in 2021.
saw a gradual improvement in supply milestone in the execution of our
through the year, which helped an Accelerate strategy. The pipeline The Group launched Accelerate in
acceleration of our revenue growth. for future M&A remains healthy. 2021, and we have made fantastic
During the period of supply-demand progress against our ambitions to
imbalance, we experienced elevated In addition to a strong revenue and extend our leadership in automotive
levels of vehicle profitability (new and profit outturn, the Group’s resolute distribution, and to capture more of
used), although this normalised during focus on cash resulted in a record a vehicle’s lifetime value. While we
the second half of the year. level of free cash flow of £380m, are excited about our progress so far,
GOVERNANCE
versus the previous record of £314m we will maintain our capital allocation
Underpinning this is the quality of in 2017. As we look ahead, the discipline, and remain focused on
our people and the strength of our acquisition of Derco will provide delivering benefits to all stakeholders.
business model. This enabled the opportunities for us to deploy our
Group to accelerate performance own practices and processes to ADRIAN LEWIS
together with increased geographic drive working capital efficiencies ACTING CHIEF FINANCIAL OFFICER
diversification, which will continue and additional cash-flow generation.
to drive resilience amid economic
uncertainties.
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
Revenue Our results are stated at actual exchange rates. However, to enhance
£8.1bn
comparability we also present year-on-year changes in sales and adjusted
operating profit in constant currency, thereby isolating the impact of
translational exchange rate effects. Unless otherwise stated, changes are
2021: £6.9bn1 expressed in constant currency and figures are stated before adjusting items.
% change
Adjusted operating margin2 % change constant % change
£5.1%
2022 20211 reported FX2 organic3
Key financials (continuing operations)
Revenue £8,133m £6,901m +18% +16% +15%
2021: 4.1%1 Adjusted Operating Profit1 £411m £281m +46% +41%
Adjusted Operating Margin1 5.1% 4.1% +100bps +90bps
Profit before tax and adjusting items1 Adjusted Profit Before Tax1 £373m £249m +50%
£373m
2021: £249m1
Adjusted Basic EPS1
Dividend Per Share
Free Cash Flow1
72.0p
28.8p
£380m
46.3p
22.5p
£274m
+56%
+28%
+39%
£380m
Operating Profit (continuing operations) £400m £181m
Profit Before Tax (continuing operations) £333m £149m
Total (loss)/profit for the year £(6)m £122m
2021: £274m1
Basic EPS (continuing operations) 61.1p 20.3p
Return on capital employed1
41%
1. Restated to adjust for the disposal of the remaining business in Russia which has been reported as
a discontinued operation, see page 142
2. These measures are Alternative Performance Measures, see pages 206 to 207
3. Organic growth is defined as revenue growth in operations that have been open for at least a year
at constant foreign exchange rates
2021: 28%1
28.8p
2021: 22.5p
PERFORMANCE REVIEW
Performance review: full year 2022 During the reporting period adjusting driven by the growth in Group profits
The Group delivered another great items amounted to an expense of on stable capital employed. Following
set of results in 2022, driven by growth £40m (2021: £100m). This was primarily the dilutionary effect of acquisitions
across both Distribution and Retail driven by one-off costs related to we expect this will normalise to c.25%.
segments. Our performance was acquisitions and the disposal of
driven by growth of new vehicles, Russia (£28m) and non-cash, non- Fourth quarter 2022
underpinned by robust consumer operational losses arising from the Group revenue for the fourth quarter
demand and price-mix tailwinds adoption of hyperinflation accounting was £2.1bn, up 32% reported. On an
against a backdrop of supply (Ethiopia; £30m), partially offset by organic basis revenue increased
shortages, and a solid contribution other operating items (£18m). 22%, compared to +16% in Q3 – the
from used vehicles, which benefited step-up in growth was primarily owing
from unprecedented pricing-levels The highly cash-generative nature of
to lapping the trough for supply which
and our roll-out of bravoauto. While our business model was evident with
impacted the fourth quarter of 2021.
revenue growth was skewed towards record free cash flow generation of
In Distribution, the fourth quarter
the second-half, as we lapped the £380m (2021: £274m) – this represents
was the strongest quarter of the year,
trough for supply, profit was split more a conversion of adjusted operating
underpinned by organic growth
evenly due to a combination of profit of 92% (2021: 97%), exceeding
and some contribution from M&A
margin normalisation, with improving the long-term average of 60-70%. In
(Americas and Asia). On an organic
vehicle supply, set-up costs related 2022 we saw a net working capital
basis revenue increased 25%,
to new OEM relationships and an inflow of £75m primarily as a result
following an 18% increase in Q3. The
increase in investment in VLS in the of a rebound in the level of inventory
sequential step-up in organic growth
second-half. financing, which more than offset the
was driven by the improvement
rise in inventory levels (following last
in vehicle supply that was most
year’s trough reached in Q4) and
Over the course of the year, the prominent in Australasia.
an expected increase in receivables.
Group generated revenue of £8.1bn, In Retail, revenue increased 14%
As we look ahead the Group’s free
adjusted operating profit of £411m organically, following a 11% increase
cash flow conversion is expected
and free cash flow of £380m. in Q3. The improvement in revenue
to normalise towards its historic
growth was owing to a higher volume
range of 60-70%.
of new (due to better vehicle supply)
Group revenue of £8.1bn rose 18%
and used vehicles (bravoauto), while
year-on-year reported and 16% in Other notable elements of the cash
Aftersales performance continued
constant currency. The growth rate flow bridge include: net acquisitions
to be solid.
is supported by the addition of and disposals, which amounted to
new distribution businesses in the an outflow of £412m (primarily relating
to the acquisition of Derco, as well Derco acquisition
Americas and in APAC. There was
no contribution from Derco to our as other acquisitions in the Americas: The Group completed the £1.3bn
FY22 financial performance. It is Ditec and Simpson Motors, and acquisition of Derco on 31 December
worth noting that the comparative includes the first tranche of cash 2022, funded by £400m cash and
period includes the results of our received in relation to our Russia £600m of new debt. The transaction
St. Petersburg operation which was disposal), dividend payments of increased Group leverage 0.6x Net
disposed towards the end of 1H21. £89m and an outflow of £70m related Debt/EBITDA1 (pre IFRS 16), with
to our share buyback programmes. deleveraging supported by the
On an organic basis, excluding highly cash generative nature of the
currency effects and net M&A, business. Derco did not contribute
The Group closed the reporting
revenue increased by 15%, driven by to the Groups financial performance
period in an adjusted net debt
a combination of continued volume in 2022. Revenue was £2.2bn (2021:
position of £378m (excluding lease
recovery and price-mix tailwinds. £1.9bn) with an adjusted operating
liabilities), which compares to
profit of £192m (2021: £237m). We
adjusted net cash of £379m at the
The Group delivered an adjusted expect Derco will generate an
end of December 2021, and £439m
operating profit of £411m, up 46% operating margin towards the
as at 30 June 2022.
year-on-year reported and 41% in top-end of the range of a typical
constant currency. The profit growth automotive distribution business
reflects the topline increase and The movement primarily relates to (5-7%), before recurring synergies.
the year-on-year operating margin the acquisition of Derco (cash-out The transaction is expected to deliver
improvement. and net debt acquired). On an IFRS 16 annualised recurring synergies of
basis (including lease liabilities), we at least £40m, with the significant
Adjusted profit before tax (PBT) ended the period with net debt of majority delivered by the end of
of £373m (2021: £249m) reflects £877m (December 2021: net funds of 2024. There are opportunities to
the improvement in revenue and £55m). Adjusted Return on capital drive significant revenue synergies,
operating profit. The net interest employed over the period was 41%, which are as yet unquantified. These
expense of £37m (2021: £33m) rose compared to 28% for the equivalent will require one-off cash costs of up
versus the prior year due to higher period last year. The increase was to £60m over two years.
cost of financing.
STRATEGIC REPORT
The Distribution segment rising 28%. In Asia, the improvement and will provide an underpin in
versus the prior year was due to the 2023 as we navigate a changeable
reported revenue of £5.9bn positive contribution from our smaller, economic backdrop. Performance
increasing 26% year-on-year, newer and more developing markets across the halves was broadly
(e.g. Guam, Saipan, Brunei, consistent in terms of revenue,
with all regions growing
Indonesia). In the case of Hong Kong, although some strategic investments
versus the prior year. pandemic related restrictions (e.g. bravoauto) in the second-half
weighed on our first-half results, but resulted in slightly lower margins. In
performance in the second-half Africa, revenue and profit improved
improved markedly and at the in the second-half, supported by
beginning of 2023 the border with higher vehicle volumes and
China was reopened, which may Aftermarket resilience.
GOVERNANCE
signal the trough of the market. In
Singapore our performance Americas revenue grew 60% year-on-
continues to be impacted by lower year (with new businesses contributing
availability of vehicle licences (with more than 20% to growth), driving
volumes 70% below the peak in 2017). adjusted operating profit1 up 98%.
Our current expectation is that The Americas delivered excellent
licence availability will begin to performance across all major
improve in late-2023. The trends across markets, notably in Chile, Columbia
the rest of Asia continued be solid, and Peru. This was driven by a
with revenue and profit above both combination of robust consumer
the prior year and the first-half of 2022. demand and a shortage of vehicle
In terms of our newest distribution supply which supported pricing and
businesses (JLR in Indonesia, and margins, particularly in the first-half.
commercial vehicles and machinery In the second-half, we saw a step-up
in Micronesia), the performance of in revenue owing to higher new and
The combination of an excellent both has exceeded our expectations. used vehicle volumes. While margins
topline performance and higher In Australasia, our performance returned to a more normal level
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
margins drove adjusted operating was helped by a gradually improving (6-6.5%), in line with the improvement
profit¹ of £363m (2021: £246m). supply situation (vehicle supply was in vehicle volumes, overall profitability
Adjusted operating margin¹ rose at its highest in Q4) and favourable was broadly evenly split. During the
90bps to 6.2%. price-mix. Volumes, revenue and first-half we acquired two distribution
profit reached a three year high in the businesses (Simpson Motors and
Our regional disclosure has been fourth quarter, supported by broad- Ditec), which we indicated would add
aligned with the Group’s based performance (across New, an aggregate c.£250m of annualised
Management responsibilities and Used and Aftermarket) and the revenue, and both businesses have
reporting structure. In the second benefits of our cost-restructuring. contributed meaningfully in 2022.
half of 2022, in preparation for our At the end of the fourth quarter we
acquisition of Derco, the Americas Europe & Africa revenue was up 28% purchased Derco, the largest
moved to be managed as a single year-on-year with adjusted operating distributor in Latam, which will provide
region (under Romeo Lacerda), and profit1 rising 44%. In Europe, growth a step-change to our presence in
Africa was combined with the Europe was driven by the improvement in the region. For more information on
region (under Glafkos Persianis). vehicle supply (>20% increase in new the region please visit our website
APAC, which includes both Asia vehicle volume) coupled with robust where you can watch a replay of our
and Australasia, continues to be demand. This resulted in us gaining webinar: ‘In the driving seat: Spotlight
managed by Ruslan Kinebas. share in each of our largest markets on Americas’, outlining our growth
(i.e. Belgium, Greece, Romania). to date, strategic priorities and our
APAC revenue was up 9% year-on- While vehicle supply continued to confidence in the region’s growth
year with adjusted operating profit1 improve towards the end of the year, prospects over the medium and
order banks remain at record levels long term.
REGIONAL BREAKDOWN
APAC Europe & Africa Americas
Adjusted
Revenue Adjusted operating profit1 operating margin1
RETAIL
Following a proactive Retail delivered organic revenue From the start of 2023, in the UK
growth of 10% and adjusted certain manufacturers will change
disposal programme, the operating profit1 rose 34%, resulting the way they sell new vehicles
Retail segment only includes in an operating margin of 2.1%. While (choosing to sell directly to consumers
vehicle supply improved gradually via dealer groups), and as such
the results of the UK and
throughout the year (we saw Inchcape will only recognise a
Poland franchise dealerships sequentially higher new vehicle handling-fee (not the selling price of
and our bravoauto business volumes every quarter) this lagged the vehicle). The estimated impact of
demand, which remained solid. this change on Inchcape’s reported
in these markets. We continued to invest in and Retail revenue is a c.£200m reduction.
expand our bravoauto business, The impact on operating profit is
which is performing as per our plan. expected to be negligible.
As anticipated, our Used car business
1. Operating profit and operating margin stated
has started to see profitability pre adjusting items
normalise, consistent with the
reduction in used car prices. We
reported an operating margin of
1.5% in the second-half, with the
reduction owing to normalising
vehicle profitability and our
investment in bravoauto.
REGIONAL BREAKDOWN
Total Retail (UK & Poland)
Adjusted
Revenue Adjusted operating profit1 operating margin1
STRATEGIC REPORT
reported a pre-tax charge of £40m interests were £5m (2021: £5m). The £93m (2021: £82m), with the increase
(2021: charge of £100m) in respect of Group’s non-controlling interests driven largely by movements in
adjusting items. This includes benefits comprise a 40% holding in PT JLM corporate bond yields over the period
of £20m, following the change from Auto Indonesia, a 33% share in UAB affecting the discount rate assumption
RPI to CPI for pension increases, and Vitvela in Lithuania, a 30% share in NBT used to determine the value of
£13m in respect of disposal proceeds Brunei, a 30% share in Inchcape JLR scheme liabilities and the pension
from Russia. This was offset by £42m Europe, a 30% share in Ditec in Chile, indexation gain treated as an adjusting
relating to acquisition related costs, a 10% share of Subaru Australia and item, partially offset by lower than
primarily in relation to the acquisition 6% of the Motor Engineering expected returns on scheme assets.
of the Derco group and a net Company of Ethiopia. In line with the funding programme
monetary loss of £30m upon agreed with the Trustees, the Group
application of hyperinflationary Dividend: The Board has declared made additional cash contributions
accounting in Ethiopia. Further details a final ordinary dividend of 21.3p per to the UK pension schemes amounting
can be found in note 2 of the financial ordinary share which is subject to the to £2m (2021: £6m).
statements. approval of shareholders at the 2023
Annual General Meeting, and if Acquisitions: In 2022 the Group
Net financing costs: Reported net approved will be paid in June 2023. continued to further expand its
GOVERNANCE
finance costs were £67m (2021: £33m). This follows an interim dividend of distribution footprint, completing six
This includes the net monetary loss 7.5p, and takes the total dividend in deals during the year. This includes
on adoption of hyperinflationary respect of FY22 to 28.8p. The Dividend the acquisitions of Ditec and Simpson
accounting in Ethiopia of £30m, noted Reinvestment Plan is available to Motors in the Americas region during
above as an adjusting item. Adjusted ordinary shareholders and the final the second quarter, and several new
net finance costs were £37m (2021: date for receipt of elections to contract wins over the course of the
£33m) with the increase versus the participate is 26 May 2023. year (Geely in Ecuador, ORA in Hong
prior year due to higher cost of Kong and Macau, BYD in BeLux). The
financing. The interest charge is stated Capital expenditure: During 2022, Group completed its acquisition of
on an IFRS 16 basis and excluding the Group incurred net capital Derco on 31 December 2022, resulting
interest relating to leases our Reported expenditure of £59m (2021: £40m), in a cash-outflow of £407m and the
net finance costs were £57m (2021: consisting of £69m of capital assumption of Derco’s closing net
£23m). In 2023 the Group anticipates expenditure (2021: £65m) and £10m debt (£522m) – which reflects the
net finance costs of c.£110m, based of proceeds from the sale of property closing position of the balance sheet
on prevailing interest rates, with the (2021: £25m). 2022 net capital upon completion. The purchase price
step-up versus 2022 reflecting higher expenditure includes £2m related included the issuance of 39 million new
rates and financing of Derco. to Russia, incurred prior to its disposal. Inchcape shares (valued at c.£280m
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
In 2023, we continue to expect net in July 2022 when the transaction
Tax: The effective tax rate for the capital expenditure of less than 1% terms were agreed). In light of the
year is 29.5% (2021: 43.4%), and the of Group sales. deal-timing, it was agreed that the
underlying effective tax rate on pre-completion dividend owed to
adjusted profit before tax is 26.1% Financing: As at 31 December 2022, the Del Río family and the acquisition
(2021: 25.4%). The increase in the the committed funding facilities of of minority shareholdings (£270m in
underlying effective tax rate includes the Group comprised a syndicated total) would occur during 2023.
the impact of a change in the revolving credit facility of £700m (2021:
Group’s profit mix resulting in more £700m), sterling Private Placement Discontinued operations: During
profit arising in markets with higher loan notes totalling £210m (2021: the year, the Group agreed the sale
corporate tax rates. Following the £210m), a bridge facility of £350m of its remaining retail-only operations
acquisition of Derco, and reflecting (2021: £nil) and a term facility of in Russia. In 2022, the operations
the greater profit contribution from £250m (2021: £nil). As at 31 December generated revenue of £237m and
markets with higher corporate tax 2022, the bridge and term facilities operating profit of £21m. This has
rates, the Group’s underlying effective were fully drawn and the syndicated been classified within discontinued
tax rate is expected to be between revolving credit facility was undrawn operations. The total loss reported
27% and 28%. (2021: undrawn). was £241m, where we realised £99m
of accumulated foreign exchange
losses upon disposal.
VALUE DRIVERS
We provide disclosure on the value drivers behind the Groups gross profit. This includes:
• Gross profit attributable to Vehicles: New Vehicles, Used Vehicles and the associated income from finance and insurance
products; and
• Gross profit attributable to Aftersales: Service and Parts
Vehicles Aftersales
We operate across the automotive value chain, and during the year we generated 33% of gross profit through Aftersales
(2021: 35%). In 2019 Aftersales accounted for 39% of Group gross profit. The reduction since 2019 reflects the greater gross
profit contribution from vehicles as volumes improved and the benefit from higher vehicle gross margins.
APAC
Country Brands
Brunei Lexus, Toyota
Guam2 BMW, Chevrolet, Freightliner, Hyundai Construction, Kohler, Lexus, New Holland, Toyota, Western Star
Hong Kong Daihatsu, Hino, Jaguar, Land Rover, Lexus, Maxus, ORA, Toyota
Indonesia Jaguar, Land Rover
Macau Daihatsu, Hino, Jaguar, Land Rover, Lexus, ORA, Toyota
Saipan Toyota
Singapore Hino, Lexus, Suzuki, Toyota
Thailand Jaguar, Land Rover
Australia Citroen, Peugeot, Subaru
New Zealand Subaru
2. Distribution agreements for these brands across a range of Pacific islands, centred on Guam
RETAIL
Country Brands
Australia3 Isuzu Ute, Jeep, Kia, Mitsubishi, Volkswagen
Poland BMW, BMW Motorrad, MINI
UK Audi, BMW, Jaguar, Land Rover, Lexus, Mercedes-Benz, MINI, Porsche, Smart, Toyota, Volkswagen
3. Following scale disposal of retail businesses in Australia, retail is no longer reported as a separate segment in APAC.
Locations
Distribution:
Colombia, Estonia, Finland,
Hong Kong, Indonesia, Latvia,
Lithuania, Kenya, Macau, Poland,
Thailand
Retail:
UK
Locations
Distribution:
Argentina, Barbados+, Bolivia,
Chile, Colombia, Costa Rica,
Panama, Peru, Singapore
STRATEGIC REPORT
DRIVING WHAT MATTERS
Being a responsible business is reflective of our purpose and a fundamental
part of our strategy, mapping the way Inchcape creates sustainable value
for all our stakeholders.
Developing our approach to responsible business is central our organisation, as well as full accessibility for our
to our future plans at Inchcape. We know it will provide customers; by ensuring the safety and supporting the
GOVERNANCE
measurable benefits to Inchcape, bringing us closer to health and wellbeing of our employees; and in supporting
our customers and partners: it will make Inchcape a more mobility and economic development in the communities
rewarding and safer place to work; it will help us recruit, in which we operate.
engage and retain the best talent; and it will ensure we
remain a trusted partner to the OEMs with whom we work. To deliver this requires us to have a plan that is supported
These elements are fundamental to the successful delivery with a robust framework. Our ‘Driving What Matters’ plan
of our Accelerate strategy and to ensuring Inchcape’s has been designed collaboratively with our markets, for
sustainability for the long-term. ownership and delivery by our teams, locally. The plan
concentrates on our 4Ps (or pillars) of Responsible Business
We are united with the interests of all our stakeholders in – Planet, People, Places, and Practices.
the need to play our role in making a positive contribution
to the communities in which we operate, for our people, Mindful of the need to reflect the different laws, regulations,
for society and for the planet. For Inchcape though, being and cultures where we operate, we have designed a
a responsible business extends into other key areas of our global framework with workstream charters that local
operations where we can make a positive difference to markets use to respond to what is important to meet
our stakeholders: by improving inclusion and diversity in the needs of their local stakeholders.
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
PEOPLE PRACTICES PLACES PLANET
• Inclusion and Diversity • Strengthening our • Safe mobility • Mapping the risks and
• Safety and Wellbeing governance policies • Inclusive mobility opportunities of climate
• Talent and Skills • Reflecting our position • Social mobility change
as an international plc • Setting GHG targets
• Reducing waste
People pillar: R U OK Day, September 2022 Places pillar: Movilizando Corazones prosthetics donation programme,
Inchcape Australia Inchcape Colombia
PEOPLE
Our colleagues are at the heart of the People pillar of our ‘Driving What Matters’ plan,
which aims to ensure we have a safe operating environment with an inclusive and diverse
culture as well as the best talent and skills to deliver our future success.
1. Inclusion
& Diversity 2. Safety and
Wellbeing
the foundations we need to create
a culture where people of all
backgrounds and experiences can
• Defined and executed our Global • Launched, promoted and be themselves in a safe environment
Inclusion & Diversity Framework embedded Lifeworks EAP and become equipped with the skills
• Delivery of our bespoke Inclusive Programme for today and tomorrow. To do this,
Leadership Programme to all senior • Progressed our approach to flexible we’ve rolled out programmes, built
leaders globally working across our regions communities and created
• Implemented a global senior opportunities for our colleagues to
recruitment supplier reset on come together to learn, progress
inclusion and diversity and feel a sense of belonging at
STRATEGIC REPORT
INCLUSIVE LEADERSHIP At the start of 2022 we began The programme consists of a series
our global Inclusive Leadership of workshops and coaching pods
Programme for all our leadership which are supplemented with pre
populations. and post session learning and
actions. Learning was measured
The programme has been delivered before and after the programme
to our Global Executive Team and to evaluate its impact and found:
top 600 leaders across the business.
The programme is designed to • 76% of leaders reported they now
enable our leaders to learn more have the tools to check bias and
about inclusion and diversity, build ensure it does not play a role in
trust and psychological safety, the decisions they make (increase
involve and integrate diverse from 52% pre-programme)
perspectives and make
GOVERNANCE
• 92% of leaders reported they now
demonstrable commitments to have the skills to encourage team
grow an inclusive culture within members to discuss inclusion and
their teams and beyond. exclusion experiences (increase
from 70% pre-programme)
LIFEWORKS Over the past year we have The webinars were hosted by senior
embedded our employee leaders who openly shared their
assistance programme, LifeWorks, experience of mental health and
across all our markets to ensure our wellbeing and engaged over
colleagues have access to support 1,150 colleagues across all regions.
for mental, physical, social and
financial wellbeing. Our global Team leaders were provided with
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
celebration of World Mental Health toolkits to share more about
Day 2022 provided an opportunity LifeWorks and an opportunity to
to further promote LifeWorks and check-in and talk with their teams
raise awareness, advocate against about overall wellbeing. A total
stigma and take steps to support of 360 talks took place involving
better mental health for everyone. approximately 12,000 colleagues.
WOMEN INTO The Women into Leadership Guest speakers are a key feature
LEADERSHIP Programme was developed in 2021 of the programme and include
to provide continuous opportunity women from our two most senior
for professional and personal leadership levels. Also incorporated
growth of Inchcape’s female talent. into the 2022 Programme is an
This global programme is sponsored introduction to Inchcape’s female
at an executive level by Ruslan Plc Board Non-Executive Directors
Kinebas (CEO, APAC). Since the who share their life and career
programme inception, six cohorts experiences and top tips.
have launched covering all
geographic regions, with 45 women Mentoring was also added to
completing the pilot programme the 2022 programme, following
in 2021 and a further 45 women feedback from the previous cohorts
completing the 2022 programme. about the desire to ‘pay it forward’
20% of our 2021 Women into and the value that mentoring can
Leadership cohorts have been bring. The 2021 pilot cohorts have
promoted since their programme now become mentors to current
completion in March 2022. programme participants.
PRACTICES
As a global business we have huge opportunities, but also a great sense of our responsibilities.
Being an ethical organisation depends on everyone and at Inchcape we will continue to
update and strengthen our practices to ensure our colleagues always do what is right.
1. Codes of
Conduct 3. Whistleblowing worldwide, most of which have their
own regulations, different tax regimes
and varying levels of corporate
• We have refreshed and translated • We refreshed the communication governance. Our aim is to respect
the employee Code of Conduct, of our whistleblowing contact all the national jurisdictions in which
and retrained all our people channel, Speak Up! we operate while, of course, applying
• A Supplier Code of Conduct was • We are committed to completing our own controls and the rules that
introduced, communicated all investigations and communicate govern Inchcape globally as a
internally and to our suppliers, the results within three months, UK-based multi-national plc. The
and hosted on inchcape.com reporting the number of cases Practices pillar seeks to strengthen
quarterly to our regional leadership our policies and codes of conduct
so they reflect our position as an
organisation with world-class
2. Framework
for Reporting
4. Policies
standards. At the same time, we seek
to guide and protect our people to
ensure they know how to do business
• We have updated external ethically and responsibly, whatever
reporting statements on Anti-Money • Group policies have been role they play in Inchcape’s success.
Laundering, Anti-Bribery & Corruption translated into local languages
Rodrigo Schmidt
and Anti-Trust/ Competition policies and made available on the intranet
Legal & Regulatory Compliance
on inchcape.com, in the Annual • Policy Principles established to Director, Inchcape Americas and
Report and on our employee support consistency in creation Practices pillar leader
intranet of both global and local policies
1. Safe • Partnerships with prosthetic limb the safe use of roads with the
Mobility solutions for amputees in Europe objective of becoming a strong and
GOVERNANCE
with Prosfit, and the Americas with visible advocate for reduced road
Group-wide safe driving awareness the Fundafe Foundation accidents and deaths across all
and training initiatives have been • In Australia, sponsors of the Lifeline markets in which we operate. In
introduced for employees, alongside Mobile Cafe for mental health inclusive mobility, we support people
market-level road safety agency services and crisis support with disabilities to access appropriate
partnerships targeting employees, • Supply of retrofitted transport mobility solutions to improve their
customers and public on safe use solution for the disabled with quality of life. And, in social mobility,
of roads. These include TOUCH Community Services we develop local projects and
initiatives that support and enable
• BMW Driving Academy in Europe
equality of opportunity for young
and the Americas
people; for example through
3. Social
• Primary student education on road internship, apprenticeship, technical
safety in Greece Mobility education and female education.
• Partnerships with government Our responsible business plan would
institutions to deliver driver training We provide local NGOs with not be complete without considering
in Colombia sponsorship of transport for families our contribution to our communities.
• Partnerships with Singapore Road
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
and communities in need, and build
Safety Council and Australian Road partnerships with educational Julian Martini
Safety Foundation institutions to support underprivileged Head of Group HR and
and underrepresented groups Places pillar leader
PLANET
As a company, we are aware both of the impact our industry has upon the environment
and also the likely impact of climate change upon our business. Within the planet pillar,
we are working on both of those areas.
1. Understanding,
reporting and acting
upon climate
2. Scope 1 and 2
greenhouse
gas emissions
we are mostly thinking about climate
change. This is by far the most urgent
and important environmental
change risks and challenge that we face both as
opportunities • We have set science-based targets a business and as a society.
for scopes one and two with the Understanding climate change risks
• We have undertaken a Group-wide aim of halving emissions by 2030 and opportunities means that we can
exercise to understand our climate and achieving net zero by 2040 be well prepared for them and this
change risks and opportunities • We have switched to renewable gives confidence to our stakeholders
• We quantified the potential impacts sources of electricity in UK, Australia that we can rise to the challenges
of our most important risks to and most of Europe presented by climate change. Our
incorporate into our financial • We have reduced our scope one journey to become a Responsible
planning and two emissions by 19,996 tCO2e Business is well underway, and the
• We are now reporting in line with against our 2019 baseline Planet pillar is key to our strategy.
requirements of the Task Force on (unrevised)
Mike Bowers
Climate Related Financial
Group General Counsel and
Disclosure (TCFD) in our Annual
Chief Sustainability Officer
Report (see pages 44 to 54)
3. Addressing
value chain
our
GHG emissions
• We have completed mapping
our value chain emissions which
provides the baseline for us to
address our scope three emissions
and use our influence, where we
can, to help to reduce them
Locations
Distribution:
Barbados+, Colombia, Ecuador,
El Salvador, Guam+, Guatemala,
Uruguay
Retail:
UK
Our response to climate change comprises three pillars: In line with the UK Listing Rules, we confirm that the
disclosures included in the 2022 Annual Report and
• understanding, reporting and acting upon our climate
Accounts are consistent with the recommendations of the
change risks and opportunities (CROs);
Task Force on Climate Related Financial Disclosures (TCFD).
• reducing our Scope 1 and Scope 2 greenhouse
This section contains the relevant disclosures or otherwise
gas emissions; and
provides cross-references where the disclosures are located
• addressing our value chain (Scope 3) greenhouse
elsewhere in the report.
gas emissions.
This year, our disclosure is consistent with the TCFD
Understanding, reporting and acting upon our CROs recommendations except for the disclosure of an Internal
Our stakeholders depend upon us to understand how Carbon Price (ICP), which we explain in the metrics and
man-made climate change, and the efforts of society targets section on page 54. We have also not quantified
to limit the effects of that climate change, will affect our the potential financial impact for Risk 4 and Opportunities
business. In 2021, we undertook a comprehensive exercise 1 & 2 in this disclosure because the data is not yet
to identify our most important CROs under a range of sufficiently robust enough. We have therefore concluded
different scenarios. This year, we have built upon that work that such analysis would not lead to better informed
and sought to quantify the potential impacts of our five decision making at this stage, but we expect to build
most significant CROs under a 1.5°C warming and 4°C on these strong foundations in future disclosures
warming scenario. The results of that analysis are set out GOVERNANCE
on pages 50 to 51. We have embedded the outputs from Board’s oversight of climate related risks and opportunities
that analysis into our strategic planning and financial This year, the Board has specifically considered two areas
forecasting and identified a series of mitigation of focus. First, it has considered the work undertaken to
and adaptation measures to address each CRO. quantify the Group’s principal CROs. The Board will further
consider this analysis in the context of its strategy
Reducing our Scope 1 and Scope 2 greenhouse gas
discussions in 2023. Second, the Board has reviewed the
emissions
assessment of the Group’s Scope 3 footprint and the
We have set a target to reduce our Scope 1 and Scope 2 actions that we can take to reduce that footprint. In each
emissions by 46% by 2030 with 2019 as the baseline year. case, the Board has been supported by external specialists
This is consistent with a 1.5°C warming world under the with appropriate levels of experience and expertise.
Science Based Targets initiative. Our aim, consistent with Further, as climate change becomes ever more relevant,
our Accelerate strategy, is to be the lowest carbon route it permeates an increasing number of Board conversations.
to market for our OEM partners. For example, when considering a new OEM partnership,
During the year, we have made good progress in reducing or an acquisition opportunity, the Board will consider how
our Scope 1 and Scope 2 emissions by switching to the OEM or business in question is equipped to manage
renewable sources of electricity, investing in on-site the transition to a low carbon economy.
renewables and reducing our energy usage. We provide Other climate-related issues considered by the Board
more details on page 53. during the year include the:
Addressing our value chain (Scope 3) greenhouse gas • EV response strategy which has been developed for
emissions the APAC region. This will inform the development of
In 2022, we established our Scope 3 GHG footprint. This a Group-wide EV response strategy;
has enabled us to understand the principal sources of • EV safety impact requirements which have been
our Scope 3 emissions and, therefore, what we can do to developed to build on industry and OEM advice; and
reduce those emissions. We believe that no-one is better • material climate-related risks and opportunities which
placed than Inchcape to help our OEM partners make are incorporated into the list of principal risks and the
the transition to a low carbon future and we will take emerging climate related risks.
three sets of actions:
• reduce those emissions within our direct control as Role of the Committees in assessing climate
quickly as possible; change impacts
• seize opportunities to partner with OEMs that are able The Board delegates the oversight of certain aspects of
to offer our customers lower emissions vehicles; and climate change to its Committees. Where climate-related
• support our customers, teams and OEM partners in issues have been considered at Committee level, updates
making the transition. are given to the full Board following each meeting.
STRATEGIC REPORT
BOARD
The Board has ultimate responsibility for overseeing strategic climate-related matters; however,
it delegates certain areas to its committees
GOVERNANCE
Key activities:
• Engaged with the
finance teams in
relation to both the Oversight, monitoring, targets, KPIs
KPIs and risk
evaluation work so
that each element
was understood in
their proper
context TCFD WORKING GROUP
• Led the Defining actions, reporting, disclosure
quantification of
CROs agreeing the
CRO shortlist,
climate scenario
options and
approach to the
quantification of
transition and FINANCE STRATEGY RISK LEGAL
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
physical risks
The CSR Committee considers climate change at each Committee and Board, in addition, the GET also considered
meeting, usually three each year, as part of its oversight climate-related issues as part of the following discussions:
of the Planet workstream. Please see pages 94 to 95
for further details. • design of strategy – considering our strategic choices
through a climate change lens;
The Audit Committee reviews the impact of climate • implementation of Risk Management framework –
change when considering significant accounting related oversight of how climate-related risks are being
judgements, the viability of the Group, and during its continually assessed at regional level;
assessment of the Group’s significant and emerging risks. • financial planning – impact of climate on future cash
Please see pages 88 to 93 for further details. The Board flows and impairment;
and the Committees delegate responsibility for assessing
• business development – assessment of current and future
and monitoring climate-related risks to the Group Executive
OEM partners’ new energy vehicle line up and market
Team (GET), which is chaired by the Group CEO.
infrastructure;
• customers – considering the changing consumers
Management’s role in assessing and managing
preferences and needs both for product and
risks and opportunities
purchasing process;
The GET analysed the CRO quantification and Scope 3
footprint prior to the findings being presented to the CSR
Identification
1
In 2021 we undertook a CRO exercise
consisting of a top-down by group,and 192
bottom-up by each business unit, exercise potential CROs
to identify potential climate risks in our identified
business and value chain.
Assessment
2
We assessed our long list of CROs to develop
a shortlist to focus on and explore through 10
scenario analysis. Each risk and opportunity CROs
is qualitatively rated for likelihood, velocity continued
and potential impact.
Prioritisation
3
Using the outputs of our assessment we
shortlisted our CROs for quantified scenario 5
analysis. This process concluded that some CROs
CROs have a low financial impact and other shortlisted
can be combined with adjacent risks.
GOVERNANCE
Physical risks are the exposure of our assets or value chain to We have disclosed the financial impact, up to 2030, of our
physical hazards caused by the effects of climate change. CROs as low, medium and high impact, which is aligned
to our risk rating criteria as defined by our risk management
Transition risks are the most material climate-related issue framework.
to our business. We identify these risks and opportunities
through: We have not specifically quantified the long-term impacts
of EV transition due to the inherent uncertainty of the extent
• regulatory horizon scanning, senior leadership and their of the CRO.
teams are accountable for identifying regulatory risk
and incorporating these into the existing risk register; and In comparison, data sets and assumptions for carbon taxes
and physical risks are more readily available so have been
disclosed to 2050.
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
COMPARATIVE IMPORTANCE OF RISKS
Likelihood
To assess the likelihood of a CRO, we
considered the alignment between
the outcome under a 1.5ºC scenario,
4ºC scenario and current policies.
Each risk is then categorised as very
high, high, medium or low. 1
Velocity
Our assessment at the time in 4
LIKELIHOOD SCORE
Potential impact
The potential impact was determined 3
which qualitatively categorised CROs
and considered technology trends,
supply/demand projections, impact to
revenue and impact to our cost base.
Risks
1. Misalignment 4. Margin pressure
2. Aftersales 5. Physical risks VELOCITY SCORE
3. Carbon tax
The Group defines our risk appetites as risk-averse, risk tolerant and risk seeking. The appetite for each specific risk is decided
by the Group. For more detail see page 61.
To monitor and manage risks, each risk is assigned a risk owner and action owners. The risk owner is accountable for the
risk and holds action owners to account for progressing actions that move the risk to its target level. For further information
please see the Risk Management report on pages 59 to 66.
SCENARIO ANALYSIS
We employ climate scenario analysis to help understand the potential financial impacts to our business, in its current state,
from our short-listed CROs under two scenarios. Our 1.5°C scenario is characterised by accelerated intervention and is used
to assess our exposure to higher impacts from a transition to a low carbon economy. Our 4°C scenario assumes greater
impacts from physical risks. Combining the outputs of both will inform the key areas where our response must focus.
Please see the below table which outlines our scenario assumptions.
SCENARIOS
IPCC RCP 2.6 IEA NZE NGFS Net Zero IPCC RCP 8.5
Key: IEA NZE: International Energy Agency Net Zero, NGFS Net Zero: Network for greening the financial system, IPCC: Intergovernmental Panel on Climate Change
RPC: Representative Concentration Pathway
The IEA NZE scenario was selected due to the additional detail specific to the transport sector. This granularity is critical
because the transition from ICE to EVs is significant to our business. The NGFS Net Zero scenario was used to assess our
exposure to carbon taxes because it includes regional carbon prices which vary significantly across our markets. It enables
comparison between orderly and disorderly scenarios using the same sources, and there is transparency over the key policy
changes that drive modelling assumptions. Further details of the NGFS Net Zero scenarios are publicly available.
Scope of analysis
Transition risks
To scope markets for our analysis we set a financial threshold for coverage. We included the markets with a significant
contribution to our operating profit until we had coverage which was >70% of overall operating profit. This helped us filter
markets and compare the relativity of these financial impacts.
Misalignment Market-level (>10% of operating profit Australia, Belgium, Chile, Hong Kong,
by market coverage in scope) Luxembourg, Singapore, and UK
Aftersales Global-level A shift from conventional ICE to BEV
could potentially develop new
aftersales services specifically targeted
for BEV. Despite uncertainty over how
new revenue streams could evolve
over time, our analysis showed
potential cashflows are expected to
be more significant for BEV than for ICE
vehicles due to additional weight and
cost of electric components, albeit less
regular in occurrence.
GOVERNANCE
Carbon tax Market-level All markets
Margin pressure
Physical risks
Physical risk analysis considered the impact of six key acute hazards, including coastal inundation, surface water flooding,
riverine flooding, extreme wind, forest fire and extreme heat. A screening of 590 sites by hazard type, insured value, stock
value and gross profit was completed to determine those sites that are financially significant. The screening filtered the sites
down to 23. For these sites we investigated the likelihood and severity of each hazard to provide an overview of the
potential asset and stock value at risk, and the impact to operations.
The map below identifies the most material sites and the relative exposure under the RCP 8.5 pathway, which represents
a high emissions scenario, exceeding 4°C.
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
GUAM
SINGAPORE Extreme heat
ECUADOR Surface water
Extreme heat flooding
ETHIOPIA DOCKLANDS
Extreme heat AUSTRALIA
CHILE
Riverine Riverine flooding
PERU
Extreme heat flooding
RISKS
Risk Summary Scenario Financial impact Strategic response and resiliency Measurement
Description Short Med Long
1 Misalignment between IEA NZE Med High N/A As part of our broader strategy, our ambition is Metric:
Misalignment the speed at which our 1.5°C to form new partnerships with pure EV entrants NEV sales as
between OEM partners transition to expand our OEM portfolio. We have taken a % of new
OEM and their model line-up to proactive steps in 2022 to achieve this by vehicle sales
BEVs and the pace of 4°C Low Low partnering with OEMs such as BYD and Ora.
markets on Sensitivity:
BEVs leads to adoption in the markets This will help offset any potential misalignment
market share in which we operate. This identified with our current portfolio. % Revenue
decline misalignment may mean We are actively taking measures to facilitate CAGR
that we lose market share. the EV transition through: % Gross margin
Analysis showed the risk of
• providing consumers with the option of a BEV % Long-term
misalignment is greatest in
alternative for every ICE model; growth rate
the short to medium term
in the APAC region but is • facilitating EV charging through product
packages to enable customers to switch to EVs;
expected to disappear
by 2050. • providing consumers knowledge of quantified
carbon footprint savings for choosing BEV.
2 Due to a reduced number IEA NZE Low Low N/A The low-impact outcome from this risk is Metric:
Reduction of moving parts in a BEV 1.5°C largely driven by the relatively low global BEV % of AFS
in aftersales compared to an ICE 4°C Low Low volume in comparison to ICE in 2030 in a 1.5°C revenue
revenue for vehicle we may experience scenario. However, this exposure may affect attributable
BEVs a reduction in revenue us in the long term as global BEV volumes to NEV
generated from the existing increase. Therefore, we are considering an
aftersales services we offer expansion of our proposition for aftersales Sensitivity:
around repair, maintenance services to include new BEV-specific services. % Revenue
and replacement of parts. Potential services could include battery CAGR
Our analysis indicated diagnostics and transportation for end-of-life % Gross margin
this may affect our retail (EoL) batteries. These additional services could
% Long-term
businesses more than our help offset any potential impact to revenue
growth rate
distribution businesses. reduction from aftersales services.
3 Governments are likely to NGFS Low Med High Our analysis considers our targets and presents Metric:
Carbon tax use carbon taxation as a 1.5°C reduced impact if we take action. Based on Scope 1 & 2
costs mechanism to decarbonise orderly these findings we are actively implementing absolute
the economy. Despite decarbonisation levers across Scope 1 and
expected variation in 2 to ensure we meet our interim target of 46% Sensitivity:
carbon tax policy across NGFS Med High High reduction by 2030 and net zero by 2040. This % Revenue
countries we anticipate 1.5°C includes switching to renewable electricity CAGR
carbon taxation will affect dis- supply and installation of solar panels at our % Gross margin
all markets. We analysed orderly larger sites. Our strategy acknowledges a
this risk across our Scope 1 faster decarbonisation can help avoid the risk
4°C Low Low Low
and 2 emissions. of high carbon tax costs.
4 An accelerated EV IEA NZE N/A N/A N/A Our analysis indicates that the impacts of Metric:
Transition to transition could affect 1.5°C margin pressure may be offset due to the Gross margin
BEVs leads certain cost drivers for disparity of price between BEVs and ICE
our OEM partners until 4°C N/A N/A N/A vehicles. We actively monitor margins at the Sensitivity:
to pressure
on distributor cost parity is reached market level and our Accelerate Strategy % Average
margins between BEVs and ICE is designed to address this risk by providing gross margin
vehicles, which in turn a compelling offering to our OEM partners
could lead to potential (Distribution Excellence), capturing additional
downwards pressure. vehicle profit pools (Vehicle Lifecycle Services)
on distributor margins. and enabling expansion into new, margin-
However, where there is accretive markets through M&A. We have not
the potential for current quantified the potential impact as the data
prices to be maintained for is not sufficiently robust, and therefore we
BEV vehicles, the impact concluded that such analysis would not lead
on gross margins can be to better informed decision making.
mitigated or maintained
5 Exposure to climate- RCP 2.6 Low Low Low Our analysis showed low impacts across our Metric:
Physical related physical risks can 1.5°C physical assets with the highest risk exposure % sites at risk
risk – direct expose our property and from surface water floods in Singapore. from physical
impact to inventory to potential However, this resulted in low impact due to hazards
damage. It can also lead 4°C Low Low Low the low financial significance and existing
property and Sensitivity:
inventories to business interruption insurance policies in place to mitigate the
from extreme at our sites causing lost risk. To mitigate risk for future sites from new % Revenue
weather revenue. Our 590 sites were acquisitions. We will include physical risk CAGR
events screened against six acute assessments in our consideration of organic
physical hazards. We then and inorganic growth opportunities
calculated our exposure for
our 23 most material sites.
1 In markets where there IEA NZE N/A N/A N/A As part of our broader strategy, our ambition Metric:
Alignment is a rapid shift towards 1.5°C is to consider forming new partnerships with NEV sales as
between OEM EVs, there is potential pure EV entrants to add to our OEM portfolio. a % of new
and markets to capture market share We have not quantified the overall opportunity vehicle sales
where supply of EVs from 4°C N/A N/A from alignment due to a lack of robust data,
on EVs leads to Sensitivity:
market share our OEM partners keeps however we assess the financial opportunity
increase pace with BEV adoption presented from new OEM partnerships within % Revenue
rates. In a 1.5°C scenario, specific markets on a case by case basis. CAGR
the accelerated EV % Gross margin
transition increases this
GOVERNANCE
% Long-term
potential opportunity,
growth rate
with our analysis showing
this opportunity is most
significant in the near-
term where the disparity
between different levels
of EV supply from OEMs
is greatest.
2 A shift from conventional IEA NZE N/A N/A N/A We are facilitating the choice of a BEV among Metric:
Increase in ICE to BEV could 1.5°C consumers in our retail business by increasing % of AFS
aftersales potentially develop consumer knowledge of the benefits of BEVs revenue
revenue for BEV new aftersales services and expanding our aftersales services to attributable
specifically targeted for 4°C N/A N/A facilitate BEV adoption for the customer. The to NEV
BEV. Despite uncertainty potential size of opportunity has not been
over how new revenue quantified due to a lack of robust data and Sensitivity:
streams could evolve significant uncertainties in how the aftersales % Revenue
over time, our analysis market could evolve. However work is ongoing CAGR
showed potential cash to consider how we can expand our aftersales % Gross margin
flows are expected to proposition with new BEV-specific services
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
% Long-term
be more significant for and we will continue to monitor changes to
growth rate
BEV than for ICE vehicles aftersales market dynamics.
due to additional weight
and cost of electric
components, albeit less
regular in occurrence.
The sensitivities applicable to each of the risks and opportunities can be found on page 169 (note 11) of this report
Estimates for the potential financial impact of climate risks are indicative at this stage, with significant uncertainties in
their underlying assumptions. We aim to build on this analysis going forwards, improving on the robustness of data and
assumptions where available. The likelihood of all risks manifesting concurrently is very low, so the aggregation of potential
impacts would represent an extremely unlikely scenario
ACCELERATING CHANGE: OUR PLAN TO TRANSITION expected changes in our emissions profile over time. We
The TCFD recommends that companies design and have considered this trajectory in the context of science-
disclose a transition plan that sets out the key steps to based target requirements. The results suggested that OEM
deliver on their targets. Throughout the year we have decarbonisation activities are not expected to yield the
deepened our understanding of the climate risks and necessary emissions reductions required to meet our
opportunities that affect our business and we recognise potential science-based targets on either an absolute or
the need to act now. During 2022, we have built a plan intensity basis. The key challenges identified in our emissions
to reduce GHG emissions supported by short, medium, profile to 2030 can be summarised as follows:
and long-term actions.
• absolute emissions for passenger vehicles are expected
Our transition plan is commensurate with our Accelerate to remain relatively stable post 2023, with organic vehicle
Strategy and describes how we will transition and continue volumes growth largely offsetting emissions intensity
to grow a sustainable and climate resilient business. improvements from BEV uptake and grid
Our Accelerate strategy relies upon two strategic growth decarbonisation;
drivers; Distribution Excellence, and Vehicle Lifecycle • our HGV sales are a significant driver of emissions, and
Services. Within Distribution Excellence, our OEM partners of growth in emissions; and
recognise the need to transition and are looking for • the methodology used by the Science Based Targets
partners to support them on their journey. Our plan: initiative to set targets for our OEM partners, who are
categorised as part of the transport category, differs from
• targets decarbonisation of our operations to become that applied to Inchcape which falls under the
our OEM partners’ lowest carbon route to market; and consumer-retail category.
• looks for ways to help our OEM partners achieve a faster
and more robust transition to lower emission vehicles. We plan to further our work with various stakeholders to
develop potential frameworks for target setting and will
Our approach to our different sources of emissions review our plans on an ongoing basis. However the Board
Our emissions are split across Scopes 1, 2 and 3, which can has agreed on the following actions for 2023:
be further divided into direct (within our control) or indirect
• Develop and grow our BEV vehicle offerings within
(limited control). Initially, we are prioritising those areas over
our portfolio: ICE vehicles have been central to road
which we have direct control, and those areas in which
transport for many years. However, new technology
we can partner with our industry to drive decarbonisation.
is needed to decarbonise the sector. BEVs provide an
alternative means of power that is not contingent on
Direct control over Inchcape’s emissions
burning fossil fuels, but dependent on the supply of
We have direct control across our Scope 1, 2 and a small electricity. The emissions intensity of BEV vehicles will also
portion of our Scope 3 emission categories, e.g. waste and fall as economies and power grids decarbonise. So, while
business travel. For these areas we are taking direct action BEVs are not a perfect solution for low carbon transport
to reduce our emissions so that we can facilitate a faster today, they do offer an alternative form of transport that
transition and be our OEMs’ lowest carbon route to market. can be decarbonised in line with national energy supply.
We have set targets across our Scope 1 and 2 GHG By embracing the BEV transition, and increasing our
emissions using the SBTi methodology. We are committed to revenue from BEVs, we also reduce our portfolio average
a 46% reduction in absolute scope one and two emissions emissions intensity per unit sold – as compared with our
from our 2019 footprint (adjusted for disposals) by 2030 and portfolio today. We will also continue to monitor our OEM
to achieve Net Zero by 2040. This is aligned with a 1.5° C targets and achievements of those targets over time. We
temperature pathway scenario. will measure progress of our BEV transition by tracking the
percentage of NEVs sold (refer to the table on page 54).
We are going to achieve these targets through meeting
• Support our customers, teams and OEM partners on
recently developed executive level objectives related to
the transition: As our sector undergoes unprecedented
our climate strategy. For example, our regional CEOs have
disruption from the EV transition, we are developing new
been assigned energy intensity reduction targets of 5% year
solutions for our customers. One of our short-term
on year. We have taken steps to reduce our Scope 1 and 2
objectives is to support customers and our sales teams to
emissions footprint which has decreased by 24% from the
overcome obstacles in BEV adoption, such as charging
2019 revised baseline. Our case studies and Planet section
solutions, range anxiety, affordability and lack of
outline a selection of our emission reduction initiatives, such
familiarity with the product. We are educating our sales
as producing our own power and switching to
teams and customers so that we can offer a BEV product
renewable energy sources. In 2023, in the Americas, we
when it is right for the customer. When our local sales
are rolling out 15 projects related to Scope 1 and 2
teams engage with customers, we are seeing positive
emissions including solar panel installations, replacement
outcomes for the customer and our business – see
of vehicle fleets to PHEVs/BEVs, and controlling our fossil fuel
educating customers about electric vehicle alternatives
consumption. For Scope 3, the Americas are also initiating
on page 53. To address short-term affordability concerns,
three projects related to waste, recycling, and water
we will seek to develop financing solutions for customers
reduction consumption.
purchasing BEVs that are competitive with the purchase
of ICE vehicles.
Indirect control – transitioning with partners
• Understand what would be required for us to set an
A significant portion of our emissions come from the use
SBT: Investigate the identified methodology disparities
of the products we sell and the goods and services we
to setting Scope 3 science based targets.
purchase – these emissions require collaboration with
our OEM partners. This year we mapped our indicative
emissions trajectory to 2030 using OEM partner targets
(based on currently published OEM plans) to understand
STRATEGIC REPORT
ACTION TO REDUCE
EMISSIONS
EDUCATING At the beginning of 2021 our BMW Poland stores launched
an initiative to offer an EV alternative to each customer who
CUSTOMERS
comes to the dealership to view new vehicles. The initiative
ABOUT was instigated to access new profit pools in line with OEM
ELECTRIC priorities and to reduce the impact on the planet. Upskilling
VEHICLE and educating our teams has been advantageous in
ALTERNATIVES positioning our brand and helping employees understand
GOVERNANCE
the benefits of EVs. Customers to whom we show a new
perspective appreciate one key thing: they see that we
are looking for solutions and offer products that they have
not thought about before.
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
50.3%
sites switched
low emission vehicles.
to renewable
suppliers
24
sites across the UK
prices. A small example to show how we are building a
resilient business for the future while doing some good
for the planet.
with rooftop solar
PV systems
10%
of all parking
electrified vehicle preferences. This will enable us to better
understand user behaviour and anticipate evolving
demands to optimise future e-mobility programmes.
spaces to have
charging points
Our direction of travel is clear in our strategy and the Group uses a variety of metrics to measure the current and potential
impact of our climate related risks and opportunities, including GHG emissions and business specific metrics. Our metrics
are laid out across the seven cross-industry metric categories defined by the TCFD and 2022 is the first year of reporting.
During 2023 we will be exploring options for a physical risk metric and internal carbon pricing.
Table identifying key metrics, targets and dates used to measure progress against the transition plan
Metric category Status Metric FY22 actual Objective
GHG emissions Total emissions (tCO2e) 218,517 To track the reduction in our
% of sites at 100% 50.3% emissions, improvements in our
renewable electricity energy efficiency and generation
of our own renewable power
Energy intensity by 26.9
revenue (tCO2e/£m)
Physical risk We do not have physical risk metric in place
Capital deployment % of capex towards 10.8% To demonstrate the level of
climate initiatives investment we are committing
towards climate to achieve our
strategy
GHG emissions
Direct GHG emissions are from our operations through combustion of fuels (Scope 1). We also purchase energy from the
grid (Scope 2) and have indirect GHG emissions throughout the value chain mainly because of our purchase of goods,
consumer use of vehicles and transportation, which together make up more than 95% of our total Scope 3 emissions.
We are acting across all three Scopes and working closely with our partners to reduce GHG emissions for our business,
our customers and our value chain. Please see pages 119 to 120 for our Streamline Energy and Carbon Emission reporting
(SECR). We report our GHG emissions according to the Greenhouse Gas Protocol, published by the WBCSD and the WRI.
We also disclose our energy intensity per square foot. This metric measures our energy efficiency and will track the impact
of our energy saving initiatives. We chose to do this as we recognise that until the grid consists of 100% low carbon energy
supply, the renewable energy we purchase reduces the renewable energy remaining on the grid for other users and may
not have the decarbonisation effect at an economy level.
Locations
Distribution:
Chile, Estonia, Guam, Kenya,
Latvia, Lithuania, Peru
Retail:
Poland, UK
NON-FINANCIAL
INFORMATION STATEMENT
Environmental matters are considered We aim to ensure we have a safe We embrace, support and respect
as part of the Planet pillar of the operating environment with an the human rights of everyone we work
Driving What Matters plan. inclusive and diverse culture and the with and we comply with appropriate
best talent and skills for our future human rights legislation in the
• Our Health and Safety (H&S) success. countries in which we operate.
framework is designed to ensure
employees comply with relevant • Our I&D framework demonstrates • Employment policies are
environmental legislation. our commitment to helping address implemented at local level and are
• The Group has set science based the barriers preventing full designed to protect employees’
targets for Scope 1 and 2 emissions. participation for marginalised human rights.
Each region has developed its own groups. • Our Modern Slavery statement
policies in order to achieve these • Our H&S framework is designed describes the actions taken in
targets. to protect the health and safety respect of our supply chain.
• Energy efficiency policies are also of employees.
implemented at local level. • Our Code of Conduct provides Our policies set out our commitment
guidance on the ethical behaviour to human rights and the steps taken
The Planet Charter is set out on page we expect from all employees. to assess the risk of slavery.
42 and manages climate-related • Our Whistleblowing Policy provides
issues, carbon performance metrics Modern slavery training is rolled out to
guidance to employees to raise
and responsible resource use. Our those employees whose roles and
concerns without fear of reprisal.
policies are designed to help us remit require additional focus in this
pursue activities that influence us area.
Our People Charter is stated on page
and our suppliers to reduce their 38 focusing on health and safety,
Our Modern Slavery statement is
carbon footprints. training, culture, reward, and I&D.
available at www.inchcape.com
All employee related policies were
reinforcing an ethical business culture.
reviewed and updated where
necessary during 2022.
Policy implementation To ensure effective implementation of The Board and Group Executive Team
our policies we communicate clearly review certain policies on an annual
through employee induction, the basis, such as our Tax Strategy Policy,
Group-wide intranet, updates and Risk Policy, and Delegated Authorities
briefings and via the Practices pillar Policy. Other polices are overseen
of our Driving What Matters plan. at regional and local level by the
subsidiary management teams.
The non-financial reporting requirements contained in sections 414CA and 414CB of the Companies Act 2006 are addressed in this section and by means of cross
GOVERNANCE
reference. The Group’s business model is given on pages 2 to 4. The Group’s KPIs are stated on pages 26 and 27. Principal risks are given on pages 61 to 66.
It is available in 18 languages
Social matters cover a vast range of It is important that the Group operates
and is accompanied by an online
potential issues including responsible to high ethical standards and
training module. All employees
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
business policies. Our policies set complies with all applicable laws.
are expected to complete the
out our commitment to high social Employees and supply chain partners
training every two years, in
standards and the requirements for are made aware of the Group’s
addition to an annual re-
our supply chain. We have in place strategy and how their behaviours
attestation confirming they are
the following Group-wide policies: affect delivery and they are expected
aware of and fully understand the
to work in line with the Group’s values.
• Tax strategy. Code. New joiners are expected
To support this the Group has in place to complete the Code of
• Data protection/data privacy.
the following policy statements which Conduct training within four
• Competition/anti-trust.
detail the expected conduct of our weeks of joining the business.
• Privacy policy. Where employees do not have
employees and supply chain:
• Conflicts of interest policy. access to a computer, they are
• Anti-bribery and corruption. made aware of the Code through
The Group’s tax strategy is available various non-digital means.
• Anti-money laundering.
at www.inchcape.com
The policy statements are available It is important to the Board to
We do not have a global policy maintain a reputation for high
at www.inchcape.com and set out
covering community matters as any standards of business conduct
the risk assessment, procedures,
initiatives are championed at local and a separate Supplier Code of
due diligence, communications,
level. Social matters form part of the Conduct sets out the behaviours
and monitoring involved from any
Places pillar of our Driving What we expect from our suppliers. The
instances of bribery, corruption, or
Matters plan. Supplier Code of Conduct aligns
fraud being reported. The findings
of any investigations are then with the Group’s policy statements
Our Places Charter is set out on page
reported to the Audit Committee. on anti-bribery and corruption
41 outlining sustainable procurement,
and modern slavery, providing
responsible approach to tax, and
a strong governance framework
supporting vulnerable customers.
in which to do business.
Code of Conduct training is rolled out The Internal Audit function monitors
to all employees, and bespoke policy implementation. Our
training, such as anti-bribery and whistleblowing helpline, Speak Up!, READ MORE Both Codes of
corruption, anti-tax evasion facilitation, enables employees to raise concerns Conduct are available at
and modern slavery is delivered to confidentially and without fear of www.inchcape.com.
those employees whose roles and reprisal, including non-compliance
remit require additional focus and with policies and procedures.
expertise in these areas.
Locations
Distribution:
Argentina, Australia, Chile,
Colombia, New Zealand, Peru
STRATEGIC REPORT
ACCELERATING
RISK MANAGEMENT
Well-managed risk-taking lies at the heart of our ambition to be the undisputed number one
distribution partner for automotive manufacturers, the employer of choice for current and
future employees and the stock of choice for our investors.
In the last year, the Group’s risk landscape has continued APPROACH TO RISK MANAGEMENT AND INTERNAL CONTROL
to be challenged by a number of issues including declining Our approach to risk management is clearly integrated
GOVERNANCE
macro-economic conditions, geo-political unrest, within our decision making. It has been designed to ensure
continued supply chain disruption and electric vehicle (EV) we assess the risks we need to take in order to remain
supply and demand issues. Throughout these challenges, successful and to grow, and we use the available evidence
we remained focused on the delivery of our business to manage those risks as effectively as possible. Effective
transformation agenda and managing the associated risk management is therefore essential to executing our
risks while continuing to successfully embed, enhance Accelerate strategy and achieving sustainable
and mature the overall risk management framework into shareholder value.
the wider business.
We believe that effective risk management starts with the
In delivering our Accelerate strategy we have made right conversations to drive better business decisions. Our
several significant investments in new businesses during primary focus is to identify and embed mitigating actions
2022, our most recent and significant to date being the for significant risks that could affect our current or future
acquisition of Derco. The combination of our two performance, and/or our reputation. Our risk management
businesses brings the opportunity to create better value efforts aim to be holistic and integrated, bringing together
and more efficient routes to market within the Americas risk management, internal controls, and responsible
for our OEM partners and drive revenue and customer business, ensuring that our activities across this agenda
satisfaction. The enlarged business will also expose the focus on the risks that could have the greatest impact.
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
Group to new risk factors. 2023 will see harmonisation of
risk management practices for the expanded Americas Inchcape deploys three lines of defence to manage risk
region to ensure we remain focused on the risks that which is overseen by the Board and its Committees.
matter in delivering our integration plans and synergies Accountability for managing risk is, however, fully
while ensuring a fit-for-future operational framework to embedded across our business. Each region and function
deliver the priorities for the region. undertakes quarterly risk assessments, establishes mitigation
plans and monitors risk on a continual basis. These risks are
consolidated into our Group’s principal risks, emerging risks
and risk appetite and are reviewed by the Group Executive
Team and Board twice per year. The effectiveness of the
risk management and internal control systems are reviewed
at least annually by the Audit Committee.
CLIMATE CHANGE RISKS AND OPPORTUNITIES supply of electric vehicles and changing market
Critical success factors for our business are becoming the conditions. The changing market conditions combined
lowest carbon route to market for our OEM partners and with our OEMs’ transition to electrified drivetrains are putting
for our stakeholders to have confidence we are here for pressure on margins. This ‘margin pressure’ (see Risk G)
the long term. Understanding, reporting, and acting could lead to new routes to market or new business models
responsibly upon our climate related risks and opportunities with lower margins.
is our goal to ensuring the environmental sustainability
of our operations and to manage any potential climate The Group’s Accelerate strategy has been designed to
change impacts on our business and performance. address these issues. However, potential new and external
emerging risk factors relating to the availability,
The Group’s responsible business agenda is fully aligned sustainability and ethical sourcing of rare earth materials
to the above and requires the effective identification and used in the production of EV batteries remain and, in some
management of our climate related risks and opportunities cases, have been exacerbated by the macro events of
(CROs). 2022 saw our CRO management strengthen, and 2022. High energy costs, the ability for electrical grids to
we have integrated the identification of CROs into our risk answer spikes in demand, and the high costs at charging
management programme and will continue to embed points might make other powertrains more cost-effective.
and mature the methodology going forward. Through These emerging risks form part of our ‘watch list’.
this process we have affirmed that our key CROs are
appropriately linked to several of our principal risks. Climate change is also increasing potential physical risks,
such as intense flooding, severe storms and heat stress.
‘EV transition’ (see Risk L) remains a moderate risk to the A Group-wide business continuity strategy has been
Group as we continue to seek alignment between the designed to address these should they eventuate.
BOARD, AUDIT COMMITTEE AND Sets strategy; sets risk appetite; reviews principal and
GROUP EXECUTIVE TEAM emerging risks twice per year; reviews system of risk
management and internal control.
During 2022, the Board, Audit Committee and Group Executive Team reviewed the following topics relating to the Group’s
principal risks:
Board Audit Committee Group Executive Team
Critical
to risk management and is determined
by the Board. This definition provides
GOVERNANCE
direction to all areas of the Group on
acceptable levels of risk and where
further remediation is required to
reduce the risk to acceptable levels.
Major
H G F A
The Board has considered its risk
appetite in relation to the Group’s
principal risks in July and November
2022. Risks were allocated to one of
Moderate
three acceptable levels of exposure
Impact
O N J D
(aligned to the risk heatmap), L E B R
P I M
indicating tolerable levels of risk:
Minor
C
(even after mitigation is applied). We will
tolerate these risks being in the upper dark
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
blue area of the heatmap.
Minimal
B – Supply chain disruption
C – Covid-19
M – Acquisition ROI
PRINCIPAL RISKS
Of the principal risks assessed, the following have the highest relative impact or likelihood
scores and are assessed as the most significant ‘net’ risks, after mitigation has been applied.
Development of new technology Disruption to product availability The business includes the operation of
platforms and digital capabilities form has continued across the business vehicles, machinery and other manual
an integral part of our Accelerate throughout 2022 and has primarily activities, resulting in a risk of serious
strategy. These initiatives continue to been driven by the lack of timely, cost injury or fatality to our colleagues.
be delivered at pace and benefits are effective, sustainable and successful Additionally, the use and disposal
already being realised by the business. procurement of essential components of harmful substances and chemicals
However, the continued digitalisation of and rare earth minerals required in poses a risk to the environment and
our business also increases the likelihood the vehicle manufacturing process. colleagues. The Group is aware of
of cyber attacks, which, if successful, The impacts of these shortages include the impacts that remote working,
could result in confidential data being reduction in distribution volumes, a transformation project pressures and
compromised, significant business shortage of vehicles for sale as well organisational restructuring could have
disruption, reputational damage and/or as delays or cancellations of customer on the mental and physical wellbeing
financial loss. orders. This risk is expected to continue of our colleagues. The Group has
well into 2023 and beyond and is being implemented a wide variety of
Mitigating actions mitigated by sales and operations mitigations to reduce harm to our
• Multi-year security improvement planning, inventory optimisation and colleagues and the environment
programme underway as an integral effective margin management. through initiatives that provide
component of Accelerate. appropriate support and training
• Existing cyber security measures, Mitigating actions to colleagues.
including policy, asset management, • Close management and monitoring
risk assessment, access control, of margins. Mitigating actions
protective technologies, DR plans. • OEM portfolio management and • Ongoing implementation of HSE
close liaison with our OEM partners. programmes.
• Sales and operation planning • Monitoring of HSE function, including
procedures. tracking of KPIs and action plans
• Inventory management and planning • Roll-out of executive due diligence
processes. programme.
• Mandatory Annual HSE training.
• Regular review of performance by
GET and Board.
• Evaluation and remediation of risks
related to EVs underway.
Overall HSE business performance is on
track with a variety of Group-wide and
regional specific action plans in place
to further enhance the procedures
and culture throughout Inchcape.
Risk level with current mitigation Risk level with current mitigation Risk level with current mitigation
GOVERNANCE
Our OEM partners continue to innovate Geopolitical uncertainties, supply
and develop new ranges of EVs in chain disruption, risk of high inflation,
response to climate change. Currently, and risk of recession, are likely to lead
EVs carry increased R&D and production to a global economic slowdown and
costs and thus may offer decreased reduced consumer confidence and
margins comparative to internal demand. Additionally, increasing
combustion engines (ICE). However, interest rates might make financing
the Group’s view is that over time, as the for new cars less affordable and slow
technology and production capability down sales.
and capacity relating to EVs matures,
margins in the medium-term will Mitigating actions
normalise. • Management and monitoring of
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
cost base.
Mitigating actions • Financial budgeting and forecasting.
The Group’s refreshed strategy, • Cash flow and margin management.
Accelerate, is designed to address this
• Review potential cost base
risk in three ways:
efficiencies.
• through a compelling offering to our • Maintaining and increasing our
OEM partners known as Distribution geographic diversification as well
Excellence by transforming the route as our diversified OEM portfolio
to market via the development of (OEM origin, segments, positioning
a consistent, technologically and more).
advanced, low-cost, low-carbon
distribution and retail offering;
• through Vehicle Lifecycle Services –
enabling the Group to capture new
sources of value throughout the
vehicle and customer lifetime, as well
as exploring new EV-related profit
pools; and
• through expanded M&A, enabling
our growth into new, margin-accretive
markets and with potentially new
OEM partners.
Risk level with current mitigation Risk level with current mitigation
Ref # Risk title Description and impact Trend Key mitigating actions
C Covid-19 DRE, The materiality of this risk has reduced The range of local market measures that
pandemic VLS, significantly as markets continue to lift were introduced at the start of the pandemic
M&A restrictions. The risk remains on the profile due to remain ready and available for use in the event
China’s recent rapid lifting of its restrictions which of changing levels of infection and trading
have resulted in a surge of infections that could restrictions. This includes but is not limited to:
affect global supply chains. The re-emergence • The formation of dedicated pandemic
of the new variants in markets is unpredictable, response teams;
and may lead to a subsequent delayed • Measures at all sites to reduce infection risk;
economic recovery. Although restrictions are • Working from home rules;
being lifted across the globe, a worsening • A wellbeing programme to support colleagues
situation may again affect the Group’s global through the pandemic and increased
frequency of employee surveys and customer
trading performance and cash flows. It may
communications;
lead to increased pressure on margins; reduced
• Enhanced monitoring of working capital;
capital availability for both the Company
• Delayed discretionary spend where needed
and for our customers; and supply chain
to reflect market conditions; and
interruptions. • Accelerated roll out of digital trading
capabilities.
D People: DRE, Following the global pandemic and the business • Employee experience surveys followed
engagement VLS, transformation underway, there is a risk of by analysis and action planning at senior
and retention management level.
M&A increased wellbeing issues (driven by workload
and working arrangements) and of ‘change • Employee wellbeing frameworks, programmes
fatigue’. As economies return to growth, there and support.
will be increased competition for key skills. • Enhanced career development programmes
and talent reviews.
Key skills are increasingly in demand as • Reformed change management and
economies return to growth. retention initiatives.
• Pay and reward reviews and benchmarking.
E Political risk/ DRE, The Group operates in markets where there may • Close monitoring of political situation in higher-
social unrest VLS, be greater volatility in the political, economic risk markets.
M&A and social environment, for example in, and • Business continuity planning.
adjacent, to: Ethiopia, Hong Kong, and Latin • Collaboration with OEM partners on stock
America. This may threaten the safety of our allocation flexibility.
employees and disrupt business operations. • Expansion of digital trading capabilities.
H Loss of The Group has individual distribution contracts, The Group’s current strategy, Accelerate, is
Distribution several of which have been in place for many designed to mitigate this risk in the following
Contract
years. The loss of such contracts would have a ways:
significant impact on revenue and profit, as well • through a compelling offering to our OEM
as future growth opportunities. The cancellation partners known as Distribution Excellence;
of a number of smaller contracts at the same • through Vehicle Lifecycle Services which
time could have a similar impact. enables us to capture more value from the
vehicle lifecycle while reducing dependency
on specific contracts; and
• maintaining and increasing (through M&A)
our geographic diversification as well as
our diversified OEM portfolio (OEM origin,
segments, positioning).
I Change DRE, Success of the Group’s strategic transformation • Oversight by the Group’s Transformation
delivery VLS, priorities are dependent on the delivery of a Committee, supported by Portfolio
M&A number of key enabling programmes. Management tool to track status.
• Ongoing reviews and reprioritisation of
There is a risk that we lack the capacity and initiatives to ensure focus on strategic
risk mitigation to deliver on these key enabling imperatives.
programmes on time, with quality, within budget • Risk and issue management.
while realising the expected benefits. • Oversight by Steering Committees and
reporting to senior management.
J People: DRE, As we continue our business transformation • Development of in-house capability (Digital
future skills VLS, journey, we will require appropriate new Delivery Centres).
M&A skills and capabilities. These new skills and • Strategic resource planning and recruitment.
capabilities relate particularly to change • Training and development programmes,
management, leadership skills, used car e.g. digital academies.
retailing, digital marketing, M&A and data • Salary benchmarking.
analytics. The demand for these skills is high • Company profile and branding.
across many industries thus impacting our
ability recruit and retain talent.
GOVERNANCE
mobility solutions or combined EV and charging
packages.
L EV transition DRE There is a risk of lost market share due to • Monitoring of emerging EV-related legislation
misalignment between market uptake of EVs in each market.
driven by new or changing legislation or tax • Close liaison with OEMs to understand their
incentives and OEM EV supply. Risk that we do ambitions and feedback on the EV readiness
not develop optimum operating models relating of individual markets.
to EV demand and supply in various markets • Brand diversification – contracts with new
as not achieving optimum ROI on EV related OEM partners.
• Market-level risk assessment of EV
investments.
infrastructure, legislative plans; OEM partner
and competitive capability.
• Strong relationship and regular
communication to ensure optimal EV
allocation from our OEM partners.
• Reposition the brand in the market to
mitigate risk.
M Acquisition M&A Inorganic growth continues to underpin the • Pipeline of opportunities.
ROI significant role in growing the Group’s profit • Experienced M&A teams at Group and in
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
before tax. As we continue to accelerate Regions.
M&A activity, we recognise the risk of failure to • M&A playbook.
optimise value creation and ROI targets through • Integration playbook.
effective integration of new acquisitions into the • Post-merger reviews and audits.
Group. • Board review of larger transactions.
N Loss of DRE, The Group is dependent on a range of complex • Consolidation of existing systems into SaaS
technology VLS, and diverse technology systems. There is a risk with availability service level agreements
systems continues.
(non–cyber) M&A that we do not have timely or reliable access to
such business-critical information or information • Cloud-hosting, physical and technical security
systems. This could be due to issues such as in place with active system monitoring.
systems outages, software glitches, hardware • Incident management, disaster recovery and
failure, system complexity and capacity or continuity plans.
• Back-up and restoration procedures in place.
ineffective change management.
• IT general controls in place and audited.
• Crisis management training and simulations
undertaken.
O Financial DRE, The Group may be subjected to the risk of • Group Code of Conduct and relevant training.
reporting VLS, inaccurate or delayed financial reporting, • Established financial control framework.
and fraud • Defined programme of work to document
M&A or fraud. This risk may be exacerbated
through new ways of working following the controls and owners through the transition.
reorganisation of some aspects and functions • Monthly monitoring of control performance.
as the transition completes and matures. • Change management and staff retention
arrangements to enable a smooth transition.
• Established Group and regional shared service
governance including stage gate sign off;
Internal Audit assurance reviews; Group and
regional controls oversight.
P Foreign DRE, The Group operates a geographically diverse • Treasury policy and hedging strategies.
exchange VLS, structure with transactions occurring in multiple • Central treasury function and regional treasury
M&A currencies, therefore the Group is exposed to centres (in relevant regions).
the risk of adverse currency fluctuations which • Monthly monitoring of foreign exchange
can impact financial results. The Group’s impacts and hedging positions.
results and asset values are translated back to
GBP from local market currencies for reporting
consolidation, which can result in year-on-year
fluctuations in asset values.
Ref # Risk title Description and impact Trend Key mitigating actions
Q Legal, DRE, The Group operates in diverse markets across • Group-wide Code of Conduct, with
regulatory VLS, the globe. This risk relates to our ability to meet associated training.
compliance • Market-level policies and procedures,
M&A the requirements of local laws and regulations
and contracts in those diverse markets. supported by Group-wide policies for higher
risk areas.
Anti-bribery and corruption, data protection, • Nominated legal representative and/or
competition, anti-money laundering and the retained counsel in major markets to monitor
distribution and sale of finance and insurance existing and emerging legislation.
remain key legal and regulatory obligations • Online training for specific regulations.
for the Group.
Emerging risks
The identification of emerging risks is achieved through several ways which include: the strategic replanning process;
external publication analysis (including peer reviews and OEM risk disclosures); review of risk studies and publications;
the regular cadence of risk committees and Board meetings and risk-related discussions and analysis (which all form part
of the revised risk management framework implemented last year). Through regular consideration and monitoring of these
emerging risks early on, we can effectively respond to potential threats by preparing contingency plans, implementing
mitigants or adjusting our operations and Group strategy as required.
GOVERNANCE
contracts having terms of less than three years; three years
is a key timeline for new car changeover in mature retail capital expenditure.
markets with good personal finance penetration; and the
In the most severe scenario modelled, the test indicates
number of Units in Operation (UIO) up to three years old is a
that the Company would not breach the single financial
key driver of our aftersales business. However, as illustrated
(interest) covenant on its committed facilities. Details of
in the diagram below, a variety of other time horizons is
the Company’s financing arrangements can be found in
also relevant to the management of the business.
note 23 to the financial statements on pages 185 to 186.
The Directors have determined three years to be the
most appropriate period for the viability assessment as Longer-term prospects
they believe it strikes a balance between the different The following factors are considered both in the formulation
time horizons which are used to manage the business of the Group’s strategic plan, and in the longer-term
and is a reasonable period for a shareholder to expect assessment of the Group’s prospects:
a distribution business to be assessed over.
• the principal risks and uncertainties faced by the Group,
Process and scenarios considered as well as emerging risks as they are identified, including
any supply chain shortages, and the Group’s response
Our financial planning process incorporates an Annual
to these;
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
Operating Plan (AOP) for the next financial year (2023),
together with financial forecasts/models for the remaining • the prevailing economic climate and global economy,
years covered by the Viability Assessment. These financial and changing customer behaviours;
forecasts consider the Group’s profitability, gearing, cash • the inclusion of known acquisitions; and
flows and other key financial metrics over the period to • any opportunities through operational simplification
December 2025. These metrics are subjected to sensitivity and leveraging technology.
analysis, in which a number of the main underlying
assumptions are adjusted and tested to consider Viability statement
alternative risk-based scenarios. Using the Group’s most Based on the outcomes of the scenarios and considering
significant risks, including TCFD risk considerations, unlikely the Group’s financial position, and principal risks, the
but realistic worse-case scenarios are created and their Directors have a reasonable expectation that the Group
impact projected onto the three-year projections. These will be able to continue in operation and meet its liabilities
risks are (i) loss of a material Distribution contract, (ii) a as they fall due over the period of their assessment. The
major cyber incident, (ii) digital disruption to our markets Directors’ statement regarding the adoption of the going
concern basis for the preparation of the financial
statements can be found on page 122.
1 Year Viability 5 years 10 years
(3 years)
Detailed financial
forecasts
Currency hedging
Succession planning
Strategic planning
Financing considerations
Investment planning
Pension obligations +
Locations
Distribution: Chile
Retail: UK
GOVERNANCE
70 Chairman’s Statement
76 Governance at a glance
78 Board of Directors
85 Nomination Committee Report
88 Audit Committee Report
94 CSR Committee Report
96 Directors’ Report on Remuneration
117 Directors’ Report
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
CHAIRMAN’S STATEMENT
Derco acquisition
NIGEL STEIN The Board spent a significant amount of time discussing the
CHAIR Derco acquisition during the year. Details of the acquisition
are given throughout this report and the Board believes the
acquisition presents a unique opportunity to accelerate
our global distribution business and deliver substantial
shareholder value.
Climate change
The impact of climate change continues to dominate
the agenda for both businesses and governments around
the world. We are continuing on our journey to reduce our
impact and during the year the focus was on performing
quantified scenario analysis for the most material climate
related risks and opportunities.
Progress has been made on the Scope 1 and 2 emissions
targets set last year, with a reduction of over 19,000 tonnes
DEAR SHAREHOLDERS AND through a variety of initiatives. At the beginning of this year,
STAKEHOLDERS the Board reviewed the Group’s Scope 3 footprint which has
enabled us to understand the principal source of our Scope
I am pleased to present the Corporate 3 emissions. To reduce these emissions the Board agreed to
the actions detailed below but concluded that it was not
Governance Report for the year ended appropriate to set reduction targets for Scope 3 emissions
31 December 2022. The next few sections at the current time. This position will be reviewed annually.
explain how the Board and its Committees • Reduce those emissions within our direct control as
have discharged their duties throughout quickly as possible;
• Seize opportunities to partner with OEMs that are able
the year and I hope you find it informative. to offer customers lower emissions vehicles; and
• Support our customers, colleagues and OEM partners
Board changes in making the transition to a low carbon future.
As noted last year, Till Vestring left the Board in May 2022
after 10 years’ service. John Langston, who has been with Employee engagement
the Board since July 2013, will retire from the Board ahead
I am delighted that the Board was able to visit our business
of the Annual General Meeting in May 2023. I would like
in Chile in October 2022. The event gave my fellow Directors
to thank Till and John for their strong contribution and the
the opportunity to see our operations first hand and to
sound advice provided to the Board over the years and
meet our overseas colleagues face to face. An excellent
I wish John a long and happy retirement. As announced
employee engagement session was held by Alex Jensen,
in January 2023, Sarah Kuijlaars will assume the role of
Chair of the CSR Committee, further details of which can
Audit Committee Chair in May 2023.
be found on page 95.
I am delighted that Byron Grote and Juan Pablo Del Río
Jane Kingston, Chair of the Remuneration Committee, also
joined the Board as Non-Executive Directors at the start
held two employee forums during the year, one covering
of 2023. Byron has extensive corporate experience across
reward principles and one to consult on our proposed
a range of leading international businesses. Having
remuneration policy. Further details are given on page 97.
previously been Chief Financial Officer at BP plc between
2002 to 2011, Byron is currently Senior Independent Director Governance landscape
at Tesco plc, Non-Executive Director at InterContinental The Board, and the Audit Committee, will keep updated
Hotels Group plc, and Deputy Chairman of the Supervisory of the developments expected under the proposed audit
Board at Akzo Nobel N.V. and governance reforms and will report as appropriate
Juan Pablo has been appointed to the Board as part of in next years’ Annual Report and Accounts.
the Derco acquisition. Juan Pablo is currently a member
of the board of directors of Cruzados S.A.D.P. (a company Looking forward
with shares listed on the Santiago Stock Exchange) and I would like to take this opportunity to thank all our
is chairman of Sodimac S.A., a position he has held Inchcape colleagues for their hard work during the year
since 1986. which has contributed to our great performance against
the backdrop of continued uncertainty. I thank you for
Gijsbert de Zoeten resigned from the Board in November your support in 2022 and look forward to the coming year.
2022. Adrian Lewis, Group Financial Controller, has been
appointed as Acting Chief Financial Officer and the NIGEL STEIN
recruitment process has commenced. CHAIRMAN
GOVERNANCE
his pension allowance will be frozen at the current value, as an interim step, and reduce to 7% after 31 December 2023.
The Board is collectively responsible for defining, approving, and monitoring the Accelerate FURTHER READING
strategy to ensure it delivers long-term sustainable success within a fast-changing Strategy
environment. – pages 5 to 7
The Directors use their judgement and objectivity, supported by a structured governance Director biographies
framework, which enables the Board to operate effectively, generating value for shareholders, – pages 78 to 79
and contributing to wider society. Matters reserved
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
for the Board
If a Director has a concern about the running of the Company which cannot be resolved,
– www.inchcape.com
it would be recorded in the Board minutes. No such concerns arose during 2022.
The Group’s purpose is underpinned by the Accelerate strategy and Responsible Business FURTHER READING
Plan. In order to operate effectively, it is important that the appropriate culture is embedded Strategy
throughout the business, and this is approached in several ways: – pages 5 to 7
• Code of Conduct; Employee
engagement
• A designated Non-Executive Director responsible for workforce engagement; – page 21
• Whistleblowing hotline; Responsible Business
– pages 37 to 42
• Remuneration policies and practices;
• Setting appropriate financial targets and monitoring performance against targets
throughout the year;
• Employee engagement survey; and
• Delegated authorities.
We deliver great experiences through fresh thinking and working better together
The Board reviews performance against strategic targets throughout the year and reviews FURTHER READING
certain key performance indicators to ascertain whether the necessary resources are in place Principal risks
to achieve the Group’s strategic aims. Through its governance structure, the Board also – pages 62 to 66
ensures that the necessary controls, processes and procedures are in place to drive a strong Internal controls
ethical culture to facilitate the delivery of the strategy. – pages 91 to 92
Engagement
The Company has a broad group of clearly defined stakeholders and engages with them FURTHER READING
via a variety of channels allowing the Board to understand what issues are important to Stakeholder
stakeholders. The Chair of the CSR Committee is the designated Non-Executive Director engagement
responsible for engagement with the workforce. – pages 20 to 22
Workforce policies
The Code of Conduct, among other policies, sets out the behaviours expected of our FURTHER READING
employees and ensures policies remain aligned to culture and support long-term success. Responsible Business
Other policies include health and safety, anti-bribery and corruption, inclusion and diversity, – pages 37 to 42
and whistleblowing, which are all available in multiple languages. The Board recognises the Non-financial
importance of a two-way flow of communication and the importance of employees having information
the facilities to raise matters of concern, via the whistleblowing hotline. Any whistleblowing statement
claims are integrated with case management software to support efficient and effective – pages 56 to 57
investigation, remediation and reporting.
Division of responsibilities
The role of the Chairman
The Chairman is responsible for the leadership of the Board and is separate from the role of FURTHER READING
Group Chief Executive. He sets meeting agendas designed to encourage constructive debate Board evaluation
and promote a culture of openness and inclusion. He oversees that all Directors receive – page 83
accurate, timely, and clear information. The Chairman is considered independent.
As at 31 December 2022, the Board comprised of the Chairman, one Executive Director, FURTHER READING
and six Non-Executive Directors. The Group Chief Executive is responsible for developing the Director biographies
Group’s strategy, running the day-to-day operations, reporting to the Board on performance, – pages 78 to 79
implementing strategy, managing risk and internal control, and engaging with shareholders. Committee terms
The Senior Independent Director acts as a sounding board for the Chairman, serving as an of reference
intermediary to other Board members. The Senior Independent Director leads the annual – www.inchcape.com
appraisal of the Chairman’s performance with the other Non-Executive Directors.
The Non-Executive Directors are appointed to provide a wide range of skills, knowledge, FURTHER READING
and experience to supply context to the matters being debated, and the decisions needed Board skills
to achieve the Accelerate strategic goals. – page 77
Director biographies
The Non-Executive Directors are required to allocate sufficient time to the Company to – pages 78 to 79
discharge their responsibilities. Board dates are agreed two years in advance and time
commitment expected is reviewed annually to ensure Directors are able to plan their time
accordingly. Directors must obtain prior approval from the Board before taking on another
GOVERNANCE
directorship to avoid over-boarding.
Company Secretary
The Group Company Secretary supports the Board by providing advice on the governance FURTHER READING
framework and ensuring that the appropriate policies and procedures are in place to allow Matters reserved
it to function effectively. for the Board
– www.inchcape.com
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
Appointments to the Board and succession planning
Ensuring there is the right mix of Board Directors is a key element of the succession planning FURTHER READING
process. The Nomination Committee reviews the skills matrix and tenure of Directors on a Board skills
regular basis to ensure its succession plan remains aligned with the natural rotation of Directors – page 77
off the Board, and the strategic objectives of the Group in the longer term. Nomination
Committee
The Nomination Committee engages external search consultancies when searching for Board – pages 85 to 87
position candidates.
The Directors must possess the skills, experience and knowledge to support and challenge FURTHER READING
management in the execution of the Accelerate strategy and to provide sound advice and Board skills
insight on material issues. – page 77
Nomination
The Committee considers breadth of perspective on the Board can only be achieved by Committee
appointing Directors from a diverse range of backgrounds and takes into account gender, – pages 85 to 87
ethnicity and professional experience when considering suitable candidates.
Board evaluation
The Directors provide feedback on how the Board operates, its culture and effectiveness FURTHER READING
during the evaluation process. During 2022, the Board carried out an internal evaluation. The Board evaluation
specific reasons why the Board considers that each Director’s contribution is, and continues – page 83
to be, important to the Company’s long-term sustainable success may be found in the Notice Notice of Meeting
of Annual General Meeting. – www.inchcape.com
The Chair of the Audit Committee reports to the Board on the independence and FURTHER READING
effectiveness of internal and external audit functions and the integrity of the financial udit Committee
A
statements throughout the year. Report – pages 88
to 93
The Audit Committee regularly meets with the auditor without the presence of management to Non-Audit Services
discuss any areas of concern they might have. John Langston, Chair of the Audit Committee, – pages 93
also meets with the Chief Financial Officer and Head of Internal Audit in one-to-one meetings
which enable him to fully understand the key issues ahead of Committee meetings.
The Board reviews the Annual Report and Accounts, the interim financial statements, and FURTHER READING
the trading updates prior to publication to ensure that they provide a fair, balanced and udit Committee
A
understandable assessment of the Group’s position and prospects. The Board considers the Report – pages 88
weight given to published information to ensure that it is objective and there are no omissions. to 93
The Board also ensures that the narrative reporting is consistent with the financial statements.
The Group has a system of risk management and internal control which is designed around an FURTHER READING
established three lines of defence model. This model engages management teams, corporate Risk Management
functions and independent assurance to manage risk, which is overseen by the Board and – pages 59 to 67
its Committees. Audit Committee
Report – pages 88
The risk management and internal control processes are designed to manage rather than to 93
eliminate the risk of failure to achieve business strategic objectives. In establishing and
reviewing the system of internal control, the Directors have regard for the nature and extent
of relevant risks, the likelihood of loss being incurred, and the costs of control. The system can
only provide reasonable but not absolute assurance against material misstatement or loss
and cannot eliminate business risk.
On behalf of the Board, the Audit Committee carries out a review of the effectiveness of
internal control. Any significant control failings or weaknesses are reported to the Board, along
with a detailed review of the findings and mitigation plans being put in place. The Board will
monitor progress against plans until it is satisfied that the matter has been resolved
appropriately.
The Directors are satisfied that the Group’s risk management and internal control systems
accord with the FRC’s guidance on Risk Management, Internal Control and Related Financial
and Business Reporting.
The Chair of the Remuneration Committee reports to the Board on its oversight of the FURTHER READING
remuneration policy, practices and processes throughout the year. The Remuneration irectors’ Report on
D
Committee ensures the remuneration policy is designed to support the successful delivery Remuneration
of the Accelerate strategy, and is aligned to the Group’s purpose and values. – pages 96 to 116
The Committee believes that the disclosure of the remuneration arrangements is transparent
with clear rationale provided on implementation and changes to policy. The Committee
remains committed to consulting with shareholders and other key stakeholders on the policy
GOVERNANCE
and its application.
The Committee believes the performance measures used in the long-term incentive plans,
along with those in the bonus scheme, also aid simplicity due to the clear alignment to
Inchcape’s strategy, and are familiar to all stakeholders.
The Committee has ensured that remuneration arrangements do not encourage and reward
excessive risk taking by setting targets which are stretching yet realistic, with discretion to
adjust formulaic bonus and PSP outcomes and expanding the circumstances in which malus
and clawback can be applied.
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
Procedure for developing remuneration
The Remuneration Committee has delegated responsibility for setting the Executive Directors’ FURTHER READING
remuneration under the shareholder-approved Directors’ Remuneration Policy. This policy is irectors’ Report on
D
reviewed every three years to ensure it remains fit for purpose, aligns with stakeholder Remuneration
expectations, and promotes appropriate behaviours. The Committee is supported by external – pages 96 to 116
advisors to provide guidance on best practice. The Committee consults with shareholders
prior to the policy being put to shareholder vote to ensure their interests are supported.
The Remuneration Committee is made up of independent Non-Executive Directors. When FURTHER READING
agreeing Executive remuneration outcomes, the Committee uses its independent judgement Directors’ Report on
to reach decisions taking into account financial performance, personal objectives, wider Remuneration
business context, and the longer term impacts. pages 96 to 116
GOVERNANCE
AT A GLANCE
GOVERNANCE STRUCTURE
The Board of Inchcape plc
Collectively responsible for the long-term success of the Company
Delegated authorities:
• Financial Reporting • Remuneration Policy • Group Strategy • Board Composition • Responsible Business
• Risk Management • Incentive Plans • Operational • Diversity • Engagement
• Internal Control • Performance Targets Management • Succession Planning • Climate Oversight
Delegated Delegated
authorities: Group Risk Investment authorities:
Risk oversight Committee Committee Oversight of
InControl Group capital
Standards expenditure
BOARD ATTENDANCE
The table below shows the Board and Committee meetings held during the year.
GOVERNANCE
Strategy
January February May
Day
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
July September October November
BOARD SKILLS
The Board recognises the importance of the right mix of skills, experience and diversity to deliver the Group’s strategic
objectives and contribute towards long-term success. These skills will be enhanced in 2023 following the appointments
of Byron Grote and Juan Pablo Del Río to the Board.
GOVERNANCE
1
The Directors recognise the benefits of
diversity and the value that this brings 4
to the organisation in terms of skills,
knowledge, and experience.
2
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
Non-Executive Director at Aggreko plc. of directors of Falabella S.A., a company 0 to 3 years
NATIONALITY
Sarah has a Mathematics degree from with shares listed on the Santiago Stock
Exchange, between 2015 and 2020 and
NATIONALITY
3 to 6 years ETHNICITY
Oxford University and is a Fellow of the 6 to 9 years
Chartered Institute of Management has held a number of senior leadership 9+ years
1 British
Accountants. roles across a range of companies within 1
the automotive, retail and real estate 1 Chilean
Committee membership – Audit and sectors in Latin America. Singaporean
Nomination Committees.
Committee membership – Nomination
Committee.
8
9
British
ETHNICITY
ETHNICITY
Chilean
GENDER
Singaporean
Asian
1
White
4
John Langston Byron Grote
NON-EXECUTIVE DIRECTOR NON-EXECUTIVE DIRECTOR 9 6
Appointed – August 2013 Appointed – January 2023
Skills and experience – John has corporate Skills and experience – Byron has extensive Asian
finance, accounting and international experience across a range of leading GENDER
White
experience acquired in senior financial international businesses at Board level.
GENDER
roles in the engineering sector. John is Having previously been Chief Financial Female
a chartered accountant and is an Officer at BP plc between 2002 to 2011,
Male
experienced Non-Executive Director who Byron is currently Senior Independent
has a strong governance background and Director at Tesco plc, Non-Executive 4
was the Audit Committee Chair of Rexam Director at InterContinental Hotels Group
plc until its sale to Ball Group in 2016. plc, and Deputy Chairman of the 6
Committee membership – Chair of Audit Supervisory Board at Akzo Nobel N.V.
Committee and member of the Byron has previously served on the Boards
Nomination Committee. of Anglo-American plc, Standard
Chartered plc, and Unilever plc.
Female
Committee membership – Audit, CSR,
Nomination, and Remuneration Male
Committees.
GOVERNANCE
SENIOR MANAGEMENT
Improving Inclusion and Diversity
(I&D) at senior leadership level is
a key focus of the GET and the
Board, with a target to increase
the proportion of women leaders
to at least 30% by the end of
Romeo Lacerda Adrian Lewis 2025. To help achieve this target,
CEO AMERICAS ACTING CHIEF FINANCIAL OFFICER the Women into Leadership
Appointed – September 2021 Appointed – November 2022 Programme was developed in
Romeo joined Inchcape in 2021 as CEO Adrian joined Inchcape in 2015, initially 2021 to provide professional and
Americas & Africa. Since joining the Group, as CFO for the Emerging Markets region personal growth for Inchcape’s
Romeo has overseen the acquisition of where he played a leading role, with the female high potential talent and
Ditec, ITC, and Simpson Motors which have Indumotora acquisition and integration, to strengthen our succession
strengthened the Group’s geographic at the time Inchcape’s most significant
pipelines. Please see page 39
reach and broadens its OEM relationships, acquisition for many years. Adrian
with the addition of Chrysler to its list of subsequently moved to Singapore as CFO for further details.
brand partners. In addition, the Group has for Asia Pacific, Inchcape’s most profitable
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
acquired Derco, the largest automotive region. In October 2020, Adrian returned In 2022, an external recruitment
distributor in Latin America, increasing to the UK to lead the finance function supplier reset took place for
scale in the Americas with a footprint on as Group Financial Controller. Prior to Executive hires, to identify the
over 30 OEM brands in 12 markets creating Inchcape Adrian held various senior best-fit providers and solutions
a significant region in one geography. finance roles at Tesco.
who could contribute actively
Adrian is a CIMA qualified chartered to our I&D agenda and our
accountant.
continued drive for a broader
diverse mix of colleagues. During
this process, providers were asked
to provide:
Derco acquisition
In addition to the scheduled Board meetings, eight ad hoc Board meetings were held during the year to consider the
acquisition of Derco. The meetings were structured to allow the Board members to consider all aspects of the transaction
covering:
• Introduction and overview of the Derco business and its shareholders.
• Valuation, transaction terms and structure: investor perspectives, business plan review, synergy analysis, valuation, impact
on leverage.
• Geopolitical analysis, industry and OEM brand portfolio.
• Class 1 transaction: general duties of Directors, obligations for Directors of a listed company, UK Corporate Governance
Code 2018 and risk mitigation.
• Transaction process, financial projections, synergy assessment.
• Valuation/financing and impact on the Group and key transaction terms.
• Board approval of the transaction.
The meetings were attended by the Group’s external advisors who provided guidance and independent advice throughout
the process. After announcing the intention to acquire Derco, members of the Board held meetings with shareholders
accounting for 60% of our share register. Investor reaction to the deal has been very supportive, with Derco viewed as
a good strategic fit. Further details of the Derco business can be found in the Strategic Report on pages 24 and 25.
Russia disposal
As announced in 2022, the Group decided to exit its Russian operations due to the conflict with Ukraine. Working in
conjunction with our OEM partners the Board agreed to transition our Russian business in full compliance with international
and local regulations and with the aim of safeguarding the continuing employment of our colleagues. The Company’s
operations in Russia was a Retail-only operation, and during 2021 it disposed of its St. Petersburg operations.
The GET engaged with both Toyota and BMW, the largest OEM partners in the region, before agreeing to the transaction.
Following the start of the conflict, all OEMs eventually ceased production and shipments to Russia, and the lack of new
vehicles entering the country would lead to a gradual unwinding of the business as supply diminishes. The management
team in Russia remained extremely professional during the transaction which also affected our other Northern European
regions such as Poland, the Baltics and Romania. The Group Chief Executive held townhall meetings with our European
markets on the decision to make the sale.
The Board discussed the situation in detail noting the need to have regard for employees in both the Russian business
and neighbouring countries and how the decisions made will affect them, the expectation of investors and OEM brands
partners, and the risk of setting a precedent as historically the Group operates in markets with potential political uncertainty.
The Board also discussed the sale of the St. Petersburg business in 2021, noting the strategic intent had been to sell the entire
Russian operations if an appropriate buyer had been identified. The Board considered the financial impact noting early
2022 trading was strong; however, with no new inventory the business would likely be sustainable for three to six months
without any cash injection or working capital facilities. There were inevitably losses with selling the Russian operation due
to FX and impairment. The exit scenarios were considered in detail with an exit from Russia ultimately resulting in transferring
ownership or ceasing to trade. The Board agreed that whatever the outcome the fair treatment of employees remains
paramount, taking into account the investor and market view, and guidance from the UK Government.
Pension
In May 2022, the Board approved a package of measures to be made to a UK subsidiary pension scheme. Historically
this scheme was made up of four sections which were operated on an individual sectionalised basis, was a mixture of
final salary and cash balance schemes and was aligned with a mixture of RPI and CPI. It was agreed to:
• Merge three of the individual sections of the scheme.
• Align the inflation index used in the scheme to be CPI across all inflation-linked benefits.
• Enhance the security provided to scheme members by giving access to the covenant of the subsidiary in the form
of a guarantee.
This package of measures was to the benefit of both the scheme members and the Company as it improves the funding
position of the scheme overall, reduces investment risk, enhances scheme members’ security, and reduces the time period
within which the scheme will become fully funded on a solvency basis.
In order to formalise the Company’s approach to pensions decision-making, in line with the requirements of the Pension
Schemes Act 2021, terms of reference were incorporated for the Group’s Pension Committee along with a Governance
manual to document day-to-day operational responsibilities. A DC Governance Committee was also set up to ensure
the DC Schemes are appropriately governed, including a focus on matters such as delivering best member outcomes
and ESG matters.
A broad range of workforce engagement mechanisms are in place with a feedback loop to ensure the Board is able
to assess the culture of the organisation. The Chair of the CSR Committee is the designated Non-Executive Director with
responsibility for workforce engagement and further details of the engagement session carried out in 2022 is given on
page 95.
GOVERNANCE
The Board has delegated oversight of the Company’s whistleblowing arrangements to the Audit Committee but retains
overall responsibility and receives updates on cases as appropriate.
The Company has a framework of values and behaviours that underpin the Group’s purpose to ensure that the strategy
and culture of the Company are aligned. The new One Inchcape Values and Behaviours Framework was rolled out across
the Group in January 2022. The framework supports the successful delivery of the Accelerate strategy by improving the way
we do things to drive business performance.
BOARD EVALUATION
2021 Board Evaluation outcomes
Board All Board members received training on TCFD, response to electric vehicle developments, market
supply shortages and global inflation affecting pricing. This has helped enhance the Board’s
knowledge on recent industry and regulatory movements.
CSR Committee The Board enhanced its understanding of ESG issues during the year through external updates on
where ESG is heading, why it matters and key trends. From 2023, all Committee Chairs will attend one
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
CSR Committee annually to improve ESG synergy and transparency when making decisions at Board
level.
Nomination The Nomination Committee reviewed its succession criteria to enable more focused assessment of
Committee candidates. Sarah Kuijlaars and Byron Grote, come from financial positions at public companies to
help steer the Audit Committee when John Langston retires in May 2023. The Board acquired further
representation of global operations and regional markets through the appointment of Juan Pablo Del
Río, whose first-hand knowledge of the automotive industry and South American markets strengthens
the Board’s understanding of operations.
2022 Board Evaluation The Board believes there is the right level of focus on
An internal evaluation of the Board was conducted by succession and diversity, with good progress made on
the Chairman in 2022 which involved all Board members identifying and developing future talent overall however
completing an anonymous questionnaire covering areas continued focus on improving representation of minority
such as strategy, knowledge, succession, risk, culture, groups on the Board and at executive level will be key
and effectiveness. The results of the questionnaire were in 2023.
considered by the Board to agree actions for 2023. The assessment shows that the Board continues to operate
The evaluation showed that Board members feel their effectively; however, there is still a strive for continuous
experiences and contributions are valued, and any improvement.
challenges made are constructive. Communication Areas of improvement for 2023 include:
between Board members and senior management is
open with strong working relationships resulting in an • Improved Board training on industry and regulatory
optimal collaborative environment enabling timely environments;
resolution of issues. • Increased ESG knowledge and considerations when
making decisions;
When considering the knowledge, skills and experience
• More representation of automotive experience; and
of the Board, the appointments of Byron Grote and Juan
Pablo Del Río in 2023 will add new perspectives which will • Continue focus on succession planning for Board,
enhance the Board’s expertise and knowledge of finance GET and senior leaders to meet diversity requirements.
and Latin American markets however with the departure
The 2023 Board review process will be externally facilitated,
of John Langston in May 2023, automotive experience
with details of the evaluation being reported in next year’s
will be a key area for future appointments. In addition,
annual report and accounts.
given the Company’s focus on digital and technology,
the primary expertise in this area is seen at GET level rather
than on the Board itself, which will also be a consideration
for Board appointees.
WOMEN INTO
LEADERSHIP
Q. Why did you want to speak at Q. What role does Women into
the Women into Leadership Leadership play in Inchcape?
programme? JK. I am delighted to observe the
JK. It was a great opportunity to way Inclusion and Diversity is
connect with colleagues across really valued as of core
all parts of the Group. Having importance to how we operate
learnt and seen a lot of change and what we do. I think we are
over a long career, I wanted to going the extra mile to make this
Jane Kingston share my thoughts and insights a core living value and that all
NON-EXECUTIVE DIRECTOR with colleagues as they develop comes down to leadership.
their own careers. I am always
“ If our people feel they are valued pleased to talk about the
Q. What advice did you give the
for who they are, they are more participants of the programme?
transition into NED roles and
likely to feel at home and will stay JK. Be brave and build yourself a
explain how the Board works
with us and make great broad platform to have choices
and the role it fulfils.
contributions.” in the long-term. When you need
it, ask for support – that is a
strength.
GOVERNANCE
Alex Jensen 2/2 2/2
Jane Kingston 2/2 2/2
Sarah Kuijlaars* 2/2 1/1
John Langston 2/2 2/2
Till Vestring** 1/1 1/1
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
between 2002 to 2011 and is currently Audit Committee
I am pleased to present the report of Chair at Tesco PLC and Akzo Nobel N.V. and a Non-
Executive Director at InterContinental Hotels Group plc.
the Nomination Committee for the year He has also served as Non-Executive Director of Standard
ended 31 December 2022. The aim of this Chartered plc, Anglo American plc and Unilever plc.
Sarah and Byron’s extensive financial and international
report is to provide an overview of how the experience have strengthened the existing Board’s skill set
Committee has discharged its responsibilities as well as providing experienced voices as part of the
during the year. Audit Committee.
Juan Pablo Del Río was appointed to the Board in January
Board composition and succession planning continues 2023 following the successful acquisition of Derco. Prior to
to be the main focus of the Committee with two new this Juan Pablo served on the Board of Derco and brings
Directors recruited during 2022. Sarah Kuijlaars joined in a wealth of knowledge and experience of the business
January 2022 and Byron Grote who joined in January 2023. and Latin American markets to the Board.
In addition, Juan Pablo Del Río joined the Board following
the successful acquisition of Derco. John Langston will retire Following Sarah, Byron and Juan Pablo’s appointments,
from the Board in May 2023 and I would like to thank John the Nomination Committee believes the current
for his contribution and wise counsel during his time with composition is a good fit for the Board to optimally perform
Inchcape and to welcome our new Board members. for the benefit of its members and ensures that the Board
and its Committees remain well equipped with the skills
In recruiting Sarah and Byron, the Committee reviewed the and capabilities needed to drive the future success at
mix of skills and experience of the current Board members Inchcape. The Nomination Committee continues to
taking into account any gaps which would arise following consider suitable candidates should any vacancies arise
the departure of John. As such, the Committee agreed unexpectedly or where it could be deemed that another
that strong financial and UK listed company experience Non-Executive Director would enhance the performance
was essential. and experience of the Board.
Sarah is currently Chief Financial Officer and Executive Gijsbert de Zoeten resigned from the Board in November
Director of De Beers plc and was previously a Non- 2022. The recruitment process for a new Chief Financial
Executive Director at Aggreko plc. Sarah was also Officer has commenced.
previously CFO of Arcadis NV, deputy CFO at Rolls-Royce
Holdings plc, and has held a number of senior financial
leadership roles during a 25-year career at Royal Dutch
Shell plc. Sarah will assume the role of Audit Committee
Chair following John Langston’s retirement.
Looking ahead, the Committee is focused on the long-term This includes programmes such as the Women into
succession of the Board and the need to integrate more Leadership programme and the graduate programme.
diversity at executive level. Further information can be found in the Responsible
Business Report on pages 37 to 42.
The recruitment consultants used for Board appointments
are aware that gender and ethnic diversity are key factors NIGEL STEIN
when recruiting Board members and the Group is putting CHAIR OF THE NOMINATION COMMITTEE
in place various initiatives and programmes to reach the
leadership goals.
Skills, experience, The Committee reviews the Board Skills Matrix throughout the year. The matrix sets out the
and diversity skills and experience of each Board member which the Committee reviews in the context
of the Accelerate strategic aims in the medium and longer term.
The Committee has discussed gender diversity at the Board and Group Executive Team
level, noting diversity is an increasingly important area of focus for investors and a clear plan
is needed to address this area. Several initiatives are in place for the Company to work
towards improving gender diversity in leadership roles, including the Women into Leadership
programme which has a target of no less than 90% progression to a new role (at the same
level or promoted) with 24 months of programme completion, and to increase the
proportion of women in senior positions from 18% to 30% by the end of 2025.
Succession planning The Committee reviews length of service and recommends to the Board the appointment
of Non-Executive Directors (NEDs) for a further three-year term as and when they arise. It is
usual for Board members to serve nine years on the Board and length of service is a key
factor when looking at succession planning. However, a Director may resign before they
have completed nine years’ service. In these circumstances, a longlist of potential
candidates is continually kept up to date so the appointment process can begin
immediately to fill vacancies as they arise.
The performance of the Group Executive Team is considered by the Board as a whole during
the annual organisational health check and the Non-Executive Directors discuss succession
planning for senior leadership during the year without the presence of executive
management.
Independence The Committee assesses the Non-Executive Directors’ independence on appointment and
throughout the year. Non-Executive Directors are required to inform the Committee of any
situation which could impair their independence and report on any potential conflicts of
interest at each meeting.
Over half of the Board, excluding the Chairman, are Non-Executive Directors who are
considered to be independent under the Code. Under Code provision 10, the criteria for
Director independence states a tenure over nine years could impair a Director’s
independence. During 2022, John Langston served his tenth year with Inchcape; however,
the Board is satisfied that despite having over nine years’ service, John continues to
demonstrate independent character, judgement and objectivity, and this continued
service has not impaired his independence. John will step down from the Board prior to
the AGM in May 2023.
Juan Pablo Del Río is not considered independent due to his close family relationship with
the Derco business and the family shareholding. Please see page 87 for further details.
Election or re-election by In line with the UK Corporate Governance Code, all Board Directors will be subject to
shareholders at the AGM election or re-election annually at the Company’s Annual General Meeting. The Company
has agreed, subject to certain terms and conditions including the family owners maintaining
at least a 7% shareholding in the Company, that a Derco family Director will continue to be
nominated for reappointment until and including at the Company’s Annual General
Meeting in 2026.
Time commitment and Non-Executive Directors must have the time necessary to devote to the role. The Committee
policy on multiple Board reviews the expected time commitment on a regular basis and also implements a policy
appointments on multiple Board appointments to limit the possibility of a Director being ‘over-boarded’.
GOVERNANCE
and knowledge needed to enable the Board to
2023. John agreed to stay on the Board while we recruited
make the right decisions to achieve the objectives
two new Non-Executive Directors, Sarah and Byron, who
of the Accelerate strategy and to create long-term
both joined the Audit Committee upon appointment.
sustainable success.
John has been instrumental in their induction to the Audit
Committee and the Board felt that his continued service The importance of Board diversity is clearly understood
allowed a smooth transition for these important roles. by our recruitment consultants and is built into the
process of succession planning and recruiting
Juan Pablo Del Río is not considered independent as he
Executive and Non-Executive Directors. The Board
has a significant shareholding in the Company, and has
remains dedicated to achieving gender parity and
close family ties with some of the Company’s senior
greater representation of diverse ethnic backgrounds
employees. The Company acknowledges that Juan Pablo
and considers all aspects of diversity to be relevant
Del Río is not independent but the rationale behind the
when considering appointments to the Board or its
Derco acquisition, as stated in pages 24 and 25, are of
committees.
tremendous benefit to the Company with the acquisition
dramatically increasing our scale in the fast growth The Board’s philosophy on diversity is also reflected
Americas region, bolstering our presence in several existing throughout Inchcape and the business has continued
markets, and will secure Bolivia as a new Inchcape to strive for increased diversity of all identities,
backgrounds and experiences across its workforce
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
distribution market. Derco also brings a fantastic set of
highly complementary OEM relationships, including and is building a more inclusive environment where
deepening our decades-long relationship with Suzuki, and everyone believes they can belong, be themselves
broadens our brand footprint in the markets, with Mazda, and succeed.
Changan, JAC, Renault, Great Wall, and Haval. As a result As at 31 December 2022, at least 40% of the Board are
of this Juan Pablo will have no voting authority when it female and at least one member of the Board is from
comes to making decisions about the Derco subsidiaries. a minority ethnic background. However, the target to
have a female Chair, CEO, SID or CFO by the end of
Appointment process
2025 as recommended under LR.9.8.6 (ii) has not yet
An external recruitment consultant is appointed to assist
been met. This requirement is and will be factored into
with the recruitment of Directors. The Chairman will develop
any Board recruitment process.
an appropriate job specification, and set out any other
desirable attributes, and agree a longlist of potential The data on Board and Executive diversity is given
candidates with the consultant. From this, a shortlist is in the Directors’ Report on page 121.
agreed, and the interview process begins. Potential
candidates meet with the Chairman, Senior Independent
Director and other Board members. Once a preferred
candidate has been identified, the Committee makes its
recommendation to the Board for approval. During the
recruitment process a comprehensive assessment is carried
out to evaluate each candidate’s capability, strengths and
personal attributes needed to complement and enhance
the skills, experience and knowledge of the Board members.
Odgers Berndtson were appointed to assist with the
recruitment of Sarah Kuijlaars and Lygon Group were
appointed to assist with the recruitment of Byron Grote.
Odgers Berndtson and Lygon Group are signatories of the
Voluntary Code of Conduct for Executive Search Firms and
neither firm has any other connection to the Company or
any individual Director.
* Jane Kingston left the Committee in May 2022. Jerry Buhlmann was unable
to join the additional meetings due to prior engagements.
STRATEGIC REPORT
addressed in the 2022 Annual Report and Accounts. The
I am also pleased to report that following the approval
FRC noted the repurchase agreement and closed the
of a three-year cyber security plan last year to improve
enquiry after we explained that, as of 31 December 2021,
the Group’s National Institute of Standards and Technology
we had a contractual right to terminate the arrangement
(NIST) cyber security benchmarking assessment, Inchcape
without giving notice and without any penalty.
reached the proposed 2.2 NIST target, globally and in
Cyber security all regions.
The current cyber threat landscape increased significantly
during the year, influenced by political turmoil and the
JOHN LANGSTON
conflict in Ukraine. The Committee spent time reviewing the
CHAIR OF THE AUDIT COMMITTEE
Financial reporting The Committee’s work focused on checking the appropriate accounting treatment for, and
disclosures of, the issues considered. The Committee carried out its work using information
supplied by management, the external auditor and other advisors as appropriate. The
GOVERNANCE
Committee members bring their experience and knowledge to the deliberations which
results in the collective view being expressed to the Board.
The Committee approved the move away from the columnar format of presentation to
a simple two column approach that presents the income statement on an IFRS basis with
a reconciliation between IFRS and non-GAAP measures of performance shown below
the income statement.
Fair, balanced, and The Committee considered key audit issues, accounting treatment and judgements in
understandable relation to the financial statements. Management was challenged on the assumptions
used and the judgements that have been applied, with assurances given from both
external and internal sources. The Committee assessed whether this Annual Report
and Accounts was fair, balanced and understandable.
Risk management The Committee reviewed the principal and emerging risks, assessing the appropriateness
of the risk management framework and carrying out a robust assessment of principal risks.
Emerging risks and the process used to identify them were monitored. The Committee
reviewed the risk profile, any changes to the risks, major whistleblowing reports, and any
mitigating plans implemented by management. Further details of the Group’s approach
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
to risk management and its Principal Risks is given on pages 59 to 67.
Internal controls The Committee undertook a deep dive into the Group’s reconciliation processes to ensure
expected controls had been designed and were operating effectively. Where required,
management worked with the GBS team to provide further analysis on transactions to
ensure processes were strengthened across the Group and management aligned to the
control standards.
The new platform to host the InControl Standards was rolled out enabling the ICS entity
hierarchies and structures to be refreshed to fully align with local structures, business types,
systems and locations following completion of recent M&A activities. Markets refreshed
their ICS compliance self-assessment and the Committee monitored compliance rates.
The Committee reviewed the progress of the roll out throughout the year and self-assessed
compliance scores.
The Committee received regular reports from the Group Internal Controls (GIC) on the
process for mapping the Groups IT General Controls (ITGCs) to our new global digital
platforms which commenced in the second half of the year. GIC is working with the Cyber
Security Team to ensure the new ITGC accountability structure rollout also aligns with NIST
standards and requirements adopted by the Group.
Whistleblowing The Committee received updates on cases reported during the year, reviewing themes
and trends of reported cases. 127 whistleblowing reports were received from the Speak Up!
hotline, in addition to 175 separate cases being reported to regional HR teams, which shows
that there is awareness of the process. Most cases are originating from Latin America, and
are employee related.
Material cases were reviewed in detail with the Committee monitoring follow-up action
plans and resolution.
Auditor effectiveness The Committee reviewed the report from the external auditors, assessing the auditor’s
approach to, and findings in relation to, the audit to assess independence and objectivity.
Materiality, scope and fees for the annual audit plan were agreed. Updates on upcoming
corporate reform and other regulatory topics were regularly received throughout the year.
After considering all available information and reviewing the findings, the Audit Committee concluded that
management’s impairment reviews of non-financial assets were appropriate and that a net reversal impairment of £7.2m
relating to property, plant and equipment, and right-of-use assets, in Australia and the UK should be recognised for the
financial year ending 31 December 2022.
The Committee concluded that the disposal constituted a transfer of control under IFRS10 and the disposal represented
a discontinued operation. The Committee also concluded that the fair value of the deferred consideration to be nil given
the uncertainty.
Only members of the Committee are entitled to attend Reports are provided at each meeting, detailing the risk
Committee meetings. Other regular attendees at the environment to allow the Committee to monitor and assess
invitation of the Committee include the Chairman, Group the effectiveness of the Group’s risk management
Chief Executive, Chief Financial Officer, Group Financial approach.
GOVERNANCE
Controller, Group Head of Internal Audit, Group General
Counsel, Group Tax Director, and representatives from Internal control
the external auditor. The Internal Control framework encompasses controls
relating to financial reporting processes, preparation
Financial reporting of consolidated Group accounts, operational and
The Committee reviews with both management and compliance controls and risk management processes.
the external auditor the appropriateness of the half year
InControl Standards
and annual financial statements, taking into account:
InControl Standards (ICS), are designed to enable
• The quality and acceptability of accounting policies management to establish, assess and enhance strong
and practices; and consistent risk and control governance. The framework
• Material areas in which significant judgements have is regularly reviewed and updated in line with emerging
been applied or discussed with the external auditor; Group risks, in response to emerging internal audit issues,
• The clarity of the disclosures and compliance with and following any investigation activity.
financial reporting standards and relevant financial and The standards form part of the broader control environment
governance reporting requirements including the Code; consisting of:
• Any correspondence from regulators in relation to the
• culture and behaviours;
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
Group’s financial reporting; and
• Code of Conduct;
• Reviewing assumptions and providing assurance to
support the long-term viability statement. • Group, regional and local policies and procedures,
including legal and regulatory compliance;
Fair, balanced and understandable • delegation of authorities;
The Audit Committee also carries out its own assessment • risk management process; and
of the financial statements, and the Annual Report as a • roles and responsibilities.
whole, and is satisfied that it provides the necessary
information for shareholders. The Committee considered The ICS has been designed to mitigate the most significant
whether the information given in the financial statements risks across the Group providing robust governance and
is a true reflection of the narrative reporting throughout the a sound controls framework to ensure:
Annual Report and Accounts, whether the key performance • reliability of financial reporting;
indicators give a true indication of the health of the business • effectiveness and efficiency of operations; and
and if the issues considered of significant risk by both the
• compliance with applicable laws and regulations.
external auditor and the Committee are aligned.
The processes and procedures in place to satisfy the Board They are also there to help protect us from:
of the integrity of the financial and narrative statements • fraud and misappropriation of cash and assets; and
include a robust disclosure verification process, monthly
• material error in the financial statements.
financial performance updates, and meetings with the
internal and external audit functions without the presence The central and regional Internal Controls teams support
of management. the business by providing the framework, tools and training,
The Company’s business model and strategy are set out on and ongoing support to embed the ICS across the business
pages 2 to 7, a statement of the Directors’ responsibilities is which in turn enables management to monitor the
set out on pages 121 to 122 which includes the going effectiveness of controls in the business and to implement
concern statement. actions plans where improvement is required. The Internal
Control function is separate from the Internal Audit function
Risk management
and works with management teams to design controls that
The Audit Committee has delegated responsibility for are proportionate to the level of risk, supported by systems
ensuring that: and easy to follow.
• there is an appropriate mechanism in place to identify Monitoring the effectiveness of the risk management
the risks the Group faces; and internal control systems
• management teams have the correct focus on those The Audit Committee considers reports from the Group
risks and the action plans in place to mitigate or respond Head of Internal Audit at each meeting covering Internal
to those risks; Audit, Internal Controls and Risk Management functions.
The reports provide:
• update on the control framework; controls team, recommunication of the code of conduct
• management’s self assessment of controls and risk and additional deep dives by the compliance officer into
management; themes arising is required. The Group’s whistleblowing
• self-assessment compliance scores; process aligns with the EU Whistleblowing Directive.
• identified control gaps and status of management Internal Audit
actions;
The aim of the Internal Audit function is to provide
• assurance from management on the effectiveness independent and objective risk-based assurance for the
of the risk management and internal control system Group by bringing a systematic and disciplined approach
and compliance with policies; and to evaluate the effectiveness of risk management,
• whistleblowing and other incidents governance and control. An annual programme of audit
activity is approved by the Audit Committee; this is flexed
A report on open ICS actions is provided in addition to if required throughout the year in accordance with the
the status of actions arising from the External Auditors risk profile of the organisation and any subsequent
Management Letter which are monitored to closure by amendments are discussed in detail and agreed by
the regional controls teams. the Committee.
There was a significant increase in self assessed controls The function carries out audits across a selection of Group
compliance across all regions over the last year with ICS businesses, functions and programmes which include the
being implemented for new businesses and functions – management of risks and controls over financial,
Indonesia, Inchcape Digital and the Digital Delivery operational, IT and other compliance areas, such as GDPR
Centres. Over 1,200 control gaps were closed by the and anti-bribery and corruption.
business with the majority of reported outstanding ICS gaps
in newer markets within Europe and the Americas. Overall The Internal Audit function, led by the Group Head of
ICS compliance scores remain consistent at 88%, with good Internal Audit, consists of appropriately qualified and
progress being made across most regions. experienced employees with an in-depth understanding
of the business culture, systems, and processes. The Group
This information enables the Committee to assess the Head of Internal Audit reports to the Audit Committee and
effectiveness of internal controls on an ongoing basis. The has direct access to, and has regular meetings with, the
external auditor also provides an annual report on control Audit Committee Chair, prepares formal reports for Audit
improvement recommendations and other observations Committee meetings on the activities and key findings of
which allows the Committee to assess effectiveness the function and reports on progress against mitigation
annually. plans. The purpose, authority and responsibility of Internal
The reports are available to all Board members to ensure Audit are defined in the Internal Audit Charter, which the
they are aware of the risk management and control Committee reviews annually.
environment. Board members are also able to attend The Audit Committee and a selection of senior employees
Committee meetings should they wish and the Audit carried out an effectiveness review on the internal audit
Committee Chair also provides an update on the control function in 2022 through an anonymous questionnaire. The
and risk environment to the full Board following each feedback had been broadly positive with no overarching
Committee meeting. issues to report. Areas of focus for improvement were
Any significant control failings or weaknesses are reported relayed to the Head of Internal Audit and an appropriate
to the Board, with a detailed review of the findings and action plan has been agreed to implement these.
mitigation plans being put in place. The Board monitors
External audit
progress against plans until it is satisfied that such matters
are resolved appropriately. The Board has determined that Following an audit tender process during 2017, Deloitte LLP
there were no significant failings or weaknesses identified was appointed as the Group’s auditor with shareholder
during the review of risk management and internal control support for the appointment given at the 2018 Annual
processes during the year and further confirms that these General Meeting. Anna Marks was the lead audit partner
systems were in place during 2022 and to the date of this for this year’s audit and will now rotate after serving five
report. The Board is satisfied that the control environment years. Dave Griffin will become the lead audit partner
was materially effective during the course of the year. for 2023.
The Company confirms that it complied with The Statutory
Whistleblowing
Audit Services for Large Companies Market Investigation
The Group Head of Internal Audit reports to the Committee (Mandatory Use of Competitive Tender Processes and Audit
at each meeting on fraud and whistleblowing claims that Committee Responsibilities) Order 2014 for the financial
have been received since the last Audit Committee year under review.
meeting, and significant currently open issues. The new
and open cases which are reported to the Committee Auditor effectiveness, independence and objectivity
are those of sufficient significance to warrant attention; Ensuring that the external audit process provides a high
however, a list of all reports is also provided to the quality audit is a key activity of the Audit Committee as
Committee along with a breakdown by market, report a high quality audit provides stakeholders with assurance
type and source. that the financial statements give a true and fair view.
The Committee carries out its assessment on an ongoing
The Audit Committee Chair reports to the Board on any basis by considering its interactions with the auditor, its
significant issues or resolutions made by the Committee observations of the auditor and the relationship between
following each meeting. All Directors have full access to the the Audit Committee, the auditor and management. The
whistleblowing reports and other Audit Committee papers. Committee encourages a culture of open communication
Management responded positively creating additional and debate and the Committee believes that it is able to
governance and oversight however a proactive review of ask questions on key issues and to challenge when it feels
all operational and financial areas by the regional internal more information is needed. The Committee also looks at
GOVERNANCE
External evidence of the quality of the audit is also vital
in assisting the Committee in its review of the effectiveness • permitted non-audit services, which are services that
of the audit. the auditor may be permitted to undertake subject
to the appropriate level of approval.
Factors considered to assess quality of the
external audit The aggregate fees incurred for permitted non-audit
Mindset and culture services relative to the audit fee should not exceed 70%
The ethical and professional principles adhered to by of the average audit fee over the previous three years,
the auditor; whether the auditor has any personal or with such cap applicable to both Group and UK audit fees.
commercial interests in the Group; and how they have The provision of permitted non-audit services will only be
demonstrated high standards of independence, integrity, approved by the Audit Committee if:
objectivity and challenge throughout the year.
• engagement of the auditor to provide the services does
Skills, character and knowledge not impair the independence or objectivity of the
The auditing skills of the audit team; level of knowledge external auditor;
of the automotive distribution and retail industry possessed • the skills and experience of the external auditor make
by the audit team; the auditor’s understanding of its it the most suitable supplier of the non-audit service;
obligations to users of the financial statements; and ability
• the auditor does not have a conflict of interest due
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
to challenge where appropriate whilst maintaining strong
to a relationship with another entity; and
relationships.
• the aggregate fees incurred for permitted non-audit
Quality control services relative to the audit fee do not exceed 70%
The processes the auditor has in place to identify and of the average audit fee over the previous three years.
address risks to the audit and assessing the steps taken
to complete the annual audit plan. Permitted non-audit services above a certain level
are approved on a case-by-case basis by the Audit
Feedback from business
Committee. The following non-audit fees incurred with
The Committee receives feedback from management
Deloitte were:
on the quality of the auditor’s delivery, communication and
interaction with the various finance teams across the Group, 2022 2021
£’000 £’000
which is communicated back to the external auditor.
Regulatory services 5,421 –
The auditor’s report to the Committee sets out the audit
plan, materiality, scoping, the risk assessment process, Permitted non-audit services 819 123
significant risks, other areas of focus, the purpose of the
report and responsibility statement. The Committee reviews The Group incurred fees of £5.4m relating to the audit
at each stage of the audit to ensure whether it is satisfied of the historical financial information for the acquisition
that the audit plan is appropriate, if the auditor is meeting of Derco, with the associated public opinion that was
its obligations, and to agree any changes to the audit if included in the circular to shareholders.
they arise. There were total costs of £0.8m in respect of permitted
Deloitte continually monitors its independence and ensures non-audit services, which included £0.6m in connection
that appropriate safeguards are in place including but not with Derco, namely the provision of a private comfort
limited to the rotation of senior partners and staff and the package to the Board and sponsors in relation to profit
involvement of other partners and staff to carry out reviews forecasts. This increased the ratio of permitted non-audit
of the work performed and to otherwise advise if necessary. services to audit fees to 0.23:1 for the Group and 0.59:1 for
the UK for 31 December 2022. Full details are shown in Note
After considering all of the above elements, the conclusion 3d of the notes to the financial statements on page 157.
of the Committee is that the auditor carried out its audit The Group remained within the Audit Committee approved
effectively and that the auditor is independent and ratio of audit to non-audit fees throughout 2022.
objective.
Audit fees paid to the auditor
Non-audit services Fees paid for services provided by Deloitte (three-year
Implementing a Non-Audit Services Policy (Policy) is also average) were:
key to ensuring the independence of the external auditor.
2022 2021
The Policy for non-audit services sets out the permitted and £’000 £’000
non-permitted non-audit services as well as the approval
Audit fees 3,524 3,365
levels required by the Audit Committee and is designed
* Till Vestring left the Board on 19 May 2022. Till missed one CSR Committee
meeting due to illness.
STRATEGIC REPORT
HSE culture and practices are well understood. demonstrated is a testament to the healthy corporate
culture within the organisation. Feedback from the forum
Workforce engagement was provided to the Board so they could hear the views
We have built upon our first employee forum on culture of the Group’s employees.
from 2021 and I was delighted to be able to hold an ALEX JENSEN
in-person employee session in Santiago during the Board’s CHAIR OF THE CSR COMMITTEE
overseas board visit.
Driving What Matters plan The Committee reviewed the global framework and priorities, and assessed performance
against targets for each of the key pillars: People, Planet, Places and Practices. In addition,
the Committee also considered the global communications plan for 2022 designed to foster
employee engagement on a wide range of key issues via global and regional townhalls,
leadership meetings, colleague events and regular mailings. The Committee reviewed the
GOVERNANCE
initiatives, and achievement of key performance indicators, under each of the Responsible
Business pillars:
People • Percentage of employees participating in the Inclusive Leadership Programme.
• Action plans in place to increase colleague experience scores of a positive work
environment, wellbeing and ways of working.
• Percentage of diverse shortlists submitted for senior recruitment.
• Percentage of progression into new roles (sideways or promotion) with 24 months of
completion of Women into Leadership programme.
• Percentage of interns benefitting from Early Careers programme.
Places • Number of partnerships with local road safety agencies to reduce employee accidents.
• Sponsorship of one programme to advance mobility for those living with disability per
market.
• Engagement with local non-governmental organisations to provide transport for
underprivileged families and communities.
Practices • Percentage of employees completing Code of Conduct training.
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
• Publication of external policy statements for anti-bribery and corruption, anti-money
laundering and counter terrorist financing, anti-trust, and data privacy.
Planet • Monitor reduction in Scope 1 and Scope 2 emissions.
• Review and assess Scope 3 footprint.
• Assess the climate change risks and opportunities and approve the TCFD disclosures.
Further information on the initiatives rolled out during the year, and the achievement
of targets, can be found in the Responsible Business Report on pages 37 to 42.
Workforce engagement An employee engagement session was attended by colleagues from a wide range of roles
within the business, including several employees who joined the Group via the Ditec
acquisition. The session began with an overview of the regional pulse survey results which
showed that career development and support received high scores, whereas pay and skills
scored lower.
A general discussion followed and several key themes emerged including evolution
of strategy, data & digital and diversity. There was a detailed discussion on the Derco
integration plan which will impact many employees in the region during 2023.
Feedback to the Board included:
• improvement in the cascading of important messages from the top down;
• greater clarity of the Group’s digital strategy; and
• keep up the momentum of the I&D initiatives.
In addition, the Remuneration Committee Chair, Jane Kingston held two remuneration-
focused forums for employees including a consultation on the proposed remuneration
policy. Further details can be found on page 97.
Health, Safety, and The Committee reviews progress against six HSE priorities at each meeting covering:
Environment (HSE)
• HSE risk profile reviews;
• EV safety procedures;
• cultural HSE survey;
• HSE due diligence programme;
• HSE contract management system; and
• mandatory HSE training.
DIRECTORS’ REPORT ON
REMUNERATION
Membership
JANE KINGSTON
Number of Ad hoc
CHAIR meetings held/ meetings held/
attendance attendance
DEAR SHAREHOLDER The main components of the policy are base salary, pension
and benefits, annual bonus, Performance Share Plan (PSP),
On behalf of the Board, I am pleased Co-Investment Plan (CIP), and Save As You Earn (SAYE), and
in-post and post-exit shareholding requirements.
to present the Directors’ Report on
Shareholder consultation
Remuneration (DRR) for the year ended
During the course of the remuneration policy review we
31 December 2022. The aim of this report consulted with 20 of our largest shareholders, representing
is to demonstrate how the Committee has over two-thirds of our issued share capital, as well as proxy
advisors. We met with or received feedback from 13
discharged its duties during the year and investors representing c.48% of our issued share capital
I hope you find it informative. as well as the proxy advisors. We also consulted with
employees to explain the remuneration policy and input
I would like to welcome Alex Jensen who joined the their views into this process. Please see page 99 for
Committee in May and to thank Till Vestring for his valued further information.
contribution over the years. Alex is also Chair of the CSR
Committee and her knowledge and guidance will be In general, shareholders gave us positive feedback that
of particular importance as we begin to consider the our remuneration policy is fit for purpose and pay is well
introduction of stretching ESG targets into our reward aligned with performance. Reviewing the overall
structure. remuneration structure, including the continued use of
both PSP and CIP; the Committee continues to believe
PROPOSED REMUNERATION POLICY (POLICY) it supports the Accelerate strategy, encouraging senior
The Committee undertook a review of the current leaders to buy the Group’s shares, demonstrating their
remuneration policy, and its implementation, to ensure long-term confidence (nearly two thirds of variable pay
that it continues to support the business, the Accelerate opportunity is based on long-term performance). The
strategy, and meets the expectations of shareholders and aggregate long-term opportunity (CIP and PSP) of 280% is
other stakeholders. During the review, the Committee within market range for comparable-sized companies and
also considered recent developments in market practice, is supported by the setting of stretching targets which have
the applicability of alternative long-term incentive demonstrated a good track record of aligning pay with
arrangements, and the range of performance measures performance.
available to Inchcape. We were also able to take feedback on our evolving
Our current policy has operated broadly unchanged approach to ESG metrics in our incentive framework,
since 2011. The policy has received strong support from together with an emerging nuance to pensions alignment
shareholders over this period, reinforced the evolution both of which are detailed in this report.
of our Ignite and Accelerate strategies and has delivered I would like to thank all our shareholders who responded
reward outcomes aligned with the performance of the for their constructive advice and suggestions, and support
business and the returns received by shareholders. We for the Group and its management.
believe that the current policy continues to meet these
objectives; as such we are proposing only minor changes
to the policy and its implementation at this time.
STRATEGIC REPORT
offering has been simplified and is now a standardised across the Group, as many features of the short and long
defined contribution plan (from a mix of defined benefit term arrangements for Executive Directors flow down the
and defined contribution arrangements). As such, the organisation. Our colleagues gave us helpful feedback
contribution rate for UK employees is now estimated to particularly on the implementation of our long term
be approx. 7% – 7.5% of salary. Our Group Chief Executive incentives, including the need for improved communications
(CEO) receives a cash allowance in lieu of pension of on progress vs three year PSP targets, and expressed interest
10% of salary. This was set on appointment in 2020 and in the development of a relevant carbon metric (and
was in line with the blended rate applicable to other UK whether this should be relative to the market/competitors
employees at the time. or absolute), and in our shareholders views on the
proposed policy.
As part of the policy review we explained the position
above to our shareholders and asked for their feedback. WIDER WORKFORCE REMUNERATION
Those shareholders we spoke to appreciated our situation, The Group continues to strengthen its processes to provide
and our desire not to reduce the CEO’s contribution rate internal governance and support to our businesses to
before the UK average has been determined. However, ensure a fair and consistent approach to pay and rewards.
they indicated that they would like a plan to achieve The Committee received regular updates and is pleased
alignment over time. Consequently, the Committee agreed to support management on the approach being taken to
GOVERNANCE
that under the new remuneration policy, new Executive workforce reward in a challenging economic environment.
Directors will be offered a maximum pension contribution We operate in many countries where inflation has been
rate of 7% of salary. Our incumbent CEO, Duncan Tait high during 2022 and careful consideration has been given
volunteered to freeze his allowance at the current £ value to inflationary forecasts and local market conditions when
as an interim step, and bring the pension contribution rate conducting the annual salary review process. In addition,
down to 7% of salary after 31 December 2023. the UK recognised that the current inflationary environment
has had a greater impact on certain colleagues so a
Reflecting our ESG priorities in our incentive framework one-off payment of £300 was paid in August 2022 to all
Our current remuneration policy provides flexibility (within UK colleagues below a certain band or with a salary
certain bounds) around the choice of performance below £50,000.
measures to be used for our incentive arrangements. In
BUSINESS PERFORMANCE AND REMUNERATION
flight PSP/CIP awards are currently based 40% on ROCE;
OUTCOMES FOR 2022
40% on cumulative EPS and 20% on cash conversion.
As detailed in the Strategic Report and Operating and
A core part of our Accelerate strategy is our Responsible Financial Review on pages 2 to 34, The Group delivered
Business framework; “Driving What Matters”, which focuses revenue of £8.1bn, adjusted profit before tax of £373m,
on four key pillars of Planet, People, Places and Practices. EPS of 72p (basic adjusted), and adjusted ROCE of 41%.
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
Under the Planet pillar we set science-based targets to
M&A adjustments to performance targets
reduce Scope 1 and 2 emissions last year, and this year
we have been embedding these targets within the Following the disposal of the Russian business and the
business. Accountability for delivering on this is currently acquisition of Derco in 2022, performance targets were
reflected in the strategic objective element of the annual adjusted for the 2022 bonus and 2020 PSP/CIP as well as the
bonus. See page 110. 2021 and 2022 PSP/CIP. This is consistent with the approach
the Committee has used previously for M&A activity. The
As part of its review of ESG metrics, the Committee adjusted targets can be found on pages 111 to 112.
considered whether carbon reduction targets should be
introduced into the PSP and CIP in 2023, given the Group’s 2022 bonus
focus on reducing its Scope 1 and 2 emissions, and we The 2022 bonus was based on a matrix of PBT and revenue,
spoke with shareholders about this during the policy review. with outcomes exceeding the stretch targets resulting in a
Whilst shareholders were broadly supportive of carbon payout at the maximum level for the financial elements of
reduction metrics, they cautioned the need to ensure the bonus. Strong progress was also made on the strategic
that any targets set are stretching, robust and reliable. objectives which account for 20% of the annual bonus
Reflecting on this feedback, and mindful that our opportunity. As a result, Duncan Tait received a bonus
approach and ambition on carbon reduction is likely to of 150% of salary. Please see pages 109 and 110 for
evolve further, we have decided to keep the carbon further details.
reduction target within the annual bonus for 2023. This will
enable us to set robust carbon reduction targets at a later 2020 PSP/CIP
date based on the latest available data, to continue to Due to the volatility in the share price in early 2020, the
drive performance improvements in this area, which we Committee reviewed the number of shares to be awarded
see as a key area of value for the business and a at the time of grant to ensure it would not result in a
differentiator in our proposition to the OEMs. However, considerably higher number of shares being granted
as with the current policy, we will retain flexibility to allow compared to the previous year (which would potentially
us to use ESG metrics for future PSP and CIP cycles. result in windfall gains on vesting). To mitigate this, a 10%
reduction was applied to the number of shares granted
ENGAGEMENT WITH THE WORKFORCE to Executive Directors, Group Executive Team (GET), and
In 2022, I chaired an employee forum focusing on other senior managers to ensure that the awards better
Executive and employee reward at Inchcape. The APAC reflected the shareholder experience.
forum consisted of a range of employees from the business The Committee also considered whether the outcome
and focused on the reward principles, incentive schemes at vesting was appropriate in the context of underlying
measures, reward structures for Executive Directors, business performance, including the amount attributable
senior leaders, management, and employees, and to share price appreciation over the period. The
why these differ. Committee concluded that share price performance has
£8.1bn 41%
cumulative EPS (40% of award) was 150p, the
three year average ROCE (40% of award) was
26% and the three year average cash
conversion (20% of award) was 97%, resulting Revenue Adjusted ROCE
in the 2020 LTIPs vesting at 60% of maximum.
OVERALL REMUNERATION
The Committee is satisfied that the total
remuneration received by the Executive
Directors in 2022 appropriately reflects the
Company’s performance over the year and,
as such, no discretion was exercised by the £2,113
incentive outcomes.
29%
JANE KINGSTON
CHAIR OF THE REMUNERATION COMMITTEE
STRATEGIC REPORT
Threshold Stretch
£6.7b £7.7b
Revenue*
Target Actual
£7.1b £8.0b
Threshold Stretch
£246m £301m
Adjusted PBT*
Target Actual
£274m £362.7m
* Targets and performance shown at constant currency rates during the year
GOVERNANCE
REMUNERATION POLICY SNAPSHOT
Bonus CIP
– reward achievement of strategic goals – reinforce long-term success and
facilitate share ownership
Pension
– to help plan for the future SAYE
– encourage share ownership
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
In-post shareholding Post-exit shareholding
– align executive and shareholder – reinforce long-term alignment of
experience executive and shareholder experience
SHAREHOLDER CONSULTATION
The views of our shareholders are very important to Outcomes from investor feedback included:
us and feedback and guidance are key inputs in
• comfort with both the PSP and CIP as it was felt that
formulating the remuneration policy.
they align with strategy and appropriately reward
At the start of the policy review process interviews were Executive Directors for performance;
held with Board members and senior executives to get • acknowledgement of the pension misalignment
their views on the current structure. This feedback was which has arisen since pensions were aligned at the
reported to the Committee who formulated the revised last policy review, with a preference that a clear plan
remuneration policy. A summary of the policy changes to align with the workforce be put in place; and
was sent to our largest shareholders who were invited • caution recommended when setting carbon reduction
to meet with the Chair of the Remuneration Committee targets to ensure they are robust, meaningful and
to give their views. appropriately stretching.
Responses were received from investors who were
generally supportive of the proposed policy and These comments were considered by the Committee
meetings were held with several shareholders to and incorporated into the final remuneration policy
discuss their views. as described in this report.
PART 1 —
DIRECTORS’
REMUNERATION POLICY
This section of the report sets out the remuneration policy that the Committee will put to
shareholders for approval at the Annual General Meeting to be held on 18 May 2023 and,
if approved, will be effective from that date.
The policy is fundamentally the same as the existing policy approved by shareholders at the 2020 AGM, with only minor
changes to the wording used to describe the policy to provide greater clarity around its implementation. This includes
the revised approach on executive pensions and clarity on the approach to benefit provision. In considering the shape
of the policy, the Committee considered how remuneration can best be structured to reinforce the Company’s short-
and long-term goals, consulted major shareholders and took into account developments in market practices and investor
guidance since the last policy was adopted in 2020.
This Committee has considered the remuneration policy in the context of provision 40 of the UK Corporate Governance
Code. See page 75 for further details.
• Clarity – The Committee regularly engages with shareholders, Executives, governance advisors and employees,
to explain the approach to remuneration
• Simplicity – The objective of the remuneration elements, and link to strategy, are laid out in the table below
• Risk – There is a mix of fixed and variable pay, and long and short term measures to mitigate risk. Incentive awards
are also subject to malus and clawback provisions.
• Predictability – The vesting of bonus and long-term incentives is based on targets linked to the business strategy.
The possible pay outcomes under various scenarios are given on page 104.
• Proportionality – The Committee assesses performance at the end of each period taking into account internal
and external context to ensure payouts are appropriate and to help avoid payment for poor performance
• Alignment to culture – There is an appropriate mix of financial and non-financial measures to reinforce the
Company’s purpose and values.
STRATEGIC REPORT
Co-investment To encourage Any bonus earned over 100% of salary will be paid in shares which will Executive Directors may
Plan (CIP) Executive share be automatically invested in the CIP. These shares can be withdrawn invest up to an overall
ownership and before the end of the three-year holding period only in very limited maximum of 50% of salary.
reinforce long- circumstances at the discretion of the Remuneration Committee. Maximum match of 2:1,
term success. Further voluntary investments may be made up to the investment limit. threshold of 0.5:1.
Matching shares are granted for each invested share whether Maximum matching award
automatic or voluntary, voluntary investment shares can be withdrawn is therefore 100% of salary
at any time but the entitlement to a match would be lost if the invested in any year, and threshold
shares are withdrawn before the end of the relevant three-year vesting matching award is 25%
period. of salary.
CIP awards normally vest after three years subject to meeting
performance measures linked to the Group’s strategic priorities,
which may vary year on year, and continued employment.
For awards granted to the Executive Directors, vested awards will be
subject to an additional two-year holding period.
Any dividends paid would accrue over the vesting period and would
be paid only on those shares that vest. Dividends can be paid in
cash or shares. Current practice is for dividends to be paid as shares.
GOVERNANCE
CIP awards granted are subject to malus and clawback provisions.
Save As You Earn To encourage UK employees are able to make monthly savings, in accordance Participation limits are
(SAYE) share ownership. with the terms of the HMRC approved plan. At the end of the savings those set by the UK tax
period, the funds are used to purchase shares under option. As this is authorities from time to
an all-employee scheme and Executive Directors participate on the time.
same terms as other employees, the acquisition of shares is not subject
to the satisfaction of a performance target.
Pension To provide Executive Directors are eligible to receive employer contributions to Executive Directors are
market the Company’s pension plan (which is a defined contribution plan) entitled to an employer
competitive or allowance in lieu of pension benefits. contribution or allowance
pension benefits The policy is for the Executive Directors’ pensions on appointment aligned to the rate
where it is cost- to be aligned with that of the workforce. applicable to employees
effective and in the country in which they
tax-efficient to are based. For UK based
do so. Executive Directors, this is
currently 7% of salary.
The incumbent CEO’s
pension will be capped at
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
£82,748, until 31 December
2023 after which his rate will
be 7% of salary.
Other benefits To provide Benefits currently include (but are not limited to): There is no formal
market • company cars; maximum prescribed value
competitive • medical care; and for benefits. It is anticipated
benefits where it • life assurance premiums. that the cost of benefits
is cost-effective Executive Directors may become eligible for other benefits in the will not normally exceed
and tax-efficient future where the Committee deems it appropriate. Where additional 5% of salary.
to do so. benefits are introduced for the wider workforce the Executive Director However, the Committee
may participate on broadly similar terms. retains the discretion to
Executive Directors may be reimbursed for all reasonable expenses approve a higher cost in
and the Company may settle any tax incurred in relation to these. exceptional circumstances
Where an Executive Director is required to relocate to perform their (e.g. relocation)
role, they may be provided with reasonable benefits as determined
by the Committee in connection with this relocation.
In-post To encourage Executive Directors are required to accumulate shares equivalent n/a
shareholding share ownership to a shareholding worth 200% of base salary. This is expected to be
guidelines and alignment of normally achieved within five years from the date of appointment.
executive interest
with those of
shareholders.
Post-exit To reinforce long- A departing Executive Director is required to maintain a shareholding n/a
shareholding term alignment for two years post-termination, set at the lower of the actual
guidelines of executive shareholding on exit and the in-post shareholding guideline.
interests with The post exit holding requirement applies to share-based incentive
those of awards granted to the Executive Directors (shares purchased through
shareholders own funds are excluded).
post-termination. Enforcement is facilitated through the vesting of share-based
incentive awards into nominee accounts.
Committee discretions
The Committee operates the Group’s various incentive plans in accordance with the relevant plan rules, the Listing Rules
and applicable legislation where relevant. To ensure effective operation of the plans, the Committee retains a number
of discretions which are consistent with standard market practice, and include (but are not limited to) the following:
• selecting the participants in the incentive plans;
• determining the timing of grant of incentives;
• determining the size of grants and/or payments of incentives (within the limits set out in the Policy and rules of each plan);
• selecting performance measures and their weightings, and setting of targets for the discretionary incentive plans from
year to year;
• determining the extent of incentive vesting based on the assessment of performance;
• overriding formulaic annual bonus outcomes, and PSP/CIP vesting outcomes, taking account of overall or underlying
Company performance;
• determining the ‘good leaver’ status for leavers and where relevant, the extent of vesting in the case of share-based
plans and the application of any post-vesting holding period;
• determining whether malus and clawback shall be applied to any award in the relevant circumstances and, if so,
the extent to which they shall be applied;
• determining the treatment of incentives in exceptional circumstances such as a change of control, in which the
Committee would act in the best interests of the Group and its shareholders;
• making appropriate adjustments required in certain circumstances (e.g. rights issues, corporate restructuring events,
variation of capital and special dividends); and
• application and enforcement of the in-post and post-exit shareholding guidelines.
The Committee also has the discretion to adjust the performance conditions in exceptional circumstances, provided the
new conditions are no tougher or easier than the original conditions. Any discretion exercised by the Committee in the
adjustment of performance conditions would be fully explained to shareholders in the relevant Annual Report on
Remuneration. If the discretion is material and upwards, the Committee would consult with major shareholders in advance.
STRATEGIC REPORT
experience, individual performance, salary levels in comparable companies (using remuneration surveys, where
appropriate) and the Company’s ability to pay.
Senior employees participate in an annual bonus scheme which has similar performance targets to those of the Executive
Directors. Below this level, local incentive schemes are in place for management and non-management employees.
Opportunities and performance conditions vary by country and organisational level, with business unit-specific metrics
incorporated where appropriate. Commission-based arrangements are also operated for certain roles.
Senior managers also receive PSP awards while participation in the CIP is limited to Executive Directors, Group Executive
Team members and the next level of Executives (c. 20 individuals). Performance conditions are consistent for all participants
while award sizes vary by organisational level. Explicit in-post and post-employment shareholding guidelines apply to
Executive Directors only, although share ownership is encouraged at lower levels.
All UK employees are eligible to participate in the SAYE scheme on the same terms.
Pension and benefits arrangements are tailored to local market conditions, and so various arrangements are in place for
different populations within the Group. The Group has calculated the average equivalent pension contribution across UK
employees currently to be 7% to 7.5% of salary. At the time of appointment of the current CEO the workforce pension was
assessed to be 10% of salary. As set out on page 101, future executive appointments to the Board will be provided with a
GOVERNANCE
pension allowance in line with the workforce rate and transitional arrangements are in place to align the CEO to the current
rate available UK employees after 31 December 2023.
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
The Chairman’s fee is determined by the Remuneration
Committee and the fees for other Non-Executive Directors are
determined by the Chairman and the Executive Directors.
Non-Executive Directors may elect to receive up to 20% of their
net fees as Company shares.
Fees paid to Non-Executive Directors are within the limits approved by shareholders. This limit, currently at an aggregate
of £1,200,000, was last approved by shareholders at the 2021 AGM.
Performance scenarios
The chart below shows the remuneration that the CEO could expect to obtain based on varying performance scenarios.
These illustrations are intended to provide further information to shareholders regarding the pay-for-performance
relationship. However, actual pay delivered will be influenced by actual changes in share price and the vesting periods
of awards. The CFO resigned in November 2022, and the recruitment process for a new executive is underway. Therefore
performance scenarios for this role are not given.
£5,908
62%
£4,692
52%
£2,216
29%
£956
STRATEGIC REPORT
When appointing a new Executive Director, the Committee may make use of any of the existing components of
remuneration, as follows:
Maximum annual
Component Approach grant value
Base salary The base salaries of new appointees will be determined by n/a
reference to the scope of the role, experience of the individual,
pay levels at organisations of a similar size, complexity and type,
pay and conditions elsewhere in the Group, implications for total
remuneration, internal relativities and the candidate’s current base
salary.
Pension New appointees will be eligible to receive employer contributions n/a
to the Company’s pension plan (which is a defined contribution
plan) or a cash allowance in lieu of pension benefits; contribution
rates (as a % of salary) to be aligned to those available at the time
of appointment to the majority of colleagues in the country in
which the Executive Director is based.
Benefits New appointees will be eligible to receive normal benefits n/a
GOVERNANCE
available to senior management, including (but not limited to)
company cars, medical care, life assurance and relocation
allowance.
Annual bonus The annual bonus described in the policy table will apply to 150% of salary
new appointees with the relevant maximum being pro-rated to
reflect the proportion of employment over the year. In the year of
appointment, the Committee retains the discretion to set different
performance measures, taking into account the responsibilities of
the individual, and the point in the financial year that they joined
the Company.
PSP New appointees will be granted awards on the same terms as other up to 300% of salary The combined
Executive Directors as described in the policy table. maximum is
CIP New appointees will be granted awards on the same terms as other 100% of salary intended not to
Executive Directors as described in the policy table. exceed 400% of
salary
Other The Committee will consider on a case by case basis if all or some n/a
of the variable remuneration forfeited on leaving a previous
employer will be ‘bought out’.
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
If the Committee decides to provide a ‘buyout’, the award will be
structured on a comparable basis, taking into account the method
of payment, any performance conditions attached, time to vesting
and, if applicable, the share price at the time of buyout.
The Committee retains the discretion to make use of the relevant
Listing Rule to facilitate the use of a share-based award.
Internal appointments
In cases of internal promotions to the Board, the Committee will determine remuneration in line with the policy for external
appointees as detailed above. Where an individual has contractual commitments made prior to their promotion to
Executive Director level, the Company will continue to honour these arrangements. Incentive opportunities for employees
below Board level are typically no higher than for Executive Directors.
Non-Executive Directors
In recruiting a new Non-Executive Director, the Committee will use the policy as set out in the table on page 103. A base
fee in line with the prevailing fee schedule would be payable for Board membership, with additional fees payable for
acting as Senior Independent Director or as Chair of the Audit, Remuneration and CSR Committees as appropriate.
Payment/vesting date
Component Circumstance Treatment (if relevant)
Annual bonus Resignation. Bonus will lapse. Not applicable.
Death, ill-health, The bonus will only be paid to the extent the targets set at the At the normal time
redundancy, sale beginning of the year have been achieved. unless the Committee
of the employer Unless the Committee determines otherwise, any bonus payment determines otherwise.
or business out of will be pro-rated for time served during the year.
the group or any At the discretion of the Committee, payments may be made in
other reason which cash only with no deferral.
the Committee
may, in its absolute
discretion permit (e.g.
retirement).
Change of control. The bonus will be paid only to the extent the targets set at the At the normal time
beginning of the year have been achieved. unless the Committee
Any bonus payment will be pro-rated for time served during the determines otherwise.
year.
Payment will usually be made in cash only with no deferral.
PSP and CIP Resignation. Unvested awards will lapse on date of leaving or such earlier Not applicable.
date as the Committee may determine following the giving of
notice. Any vested awards can be exercised.
Death, ill-health, Any unvested awards will be assessed for performance, and At the normal release
redundancy, sale unless the Committee determines otherwise, time pro-rated. date (save where
of the employer the Committee has
or business out of discretion to determine
the group or any otherwise or the rules
other reason which provide otherwise). The
the Committee two-year holding period
may, in its absolute will remain in force,
discretion permit (e.g. unless the Committee in
retirement). its absolute discretion,
determines otherwise.
Change of control. Any unvested awards will be assessed for performance, and At the time of change
unless the Committee determines otherwise, time pro-rated. of control.
In relation to the Save As You Earn (SAYE) plan, as a UK tax-advantaged plan, where an Executive Director leaves or a
change of control occurs, the treatment of any outstanding options will be in line with the plan rules and HMRC guidance.
Service contracts
The Company’s policy is for Executive Directors’ service contract notice periods to be no longer than 12 months, except
in exceptional circumstances. All current contracts contain notice periods of 12 months.
The Company may at its discretion, and in certain circumstances, pay a sum equal to the outstanding notice period.
Service contracts are available to view at the Company’s registered office.
GOVERNANCE
Proposed The Committee agreed the new remuneration policy to be put to shareholders at the 2023
remuneration policy AGM taking into account the views of shareholders, governance advisors, senior executives
and employees. The Committee gave careful consideration to the continued use of the
CIP, agreeing to retain the plan alongside the PSP as it believes the plans are well
understood in the business. The aggregate award opportunity is unchanged, is within
market range and is supported by stretching performance targets, and the purchase of
shares by executives under the CIP demonstrates confidence in our long-term strategy and
aligns their interests with those of shareholders.
Long-term The Committee considered the performance targets of the PSP and CIP, agreeing the
incentive targets same targets should be used for both the PSP and CIP as this aligns participants around
the core strategic objectives, ensures consistent behaviours and avoids unnecessary
complexity. During the year, the Committee:
• agreed the performance targets for the 2022 PSP/CIP;
• assessed and approved the achievement of performance targets for the 2020 PSP/CIP;
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
taking into account whether there were any windfall gains;
• monitored the targets for the in-flight PSP/CIP; and
• agreed the performance targets for the 2023 PSP/CIP.
M&A adjustments Following the disposal of the Russian business and the acquisition of Derco in 2022,
performance targets were adjusted for the 2022 bonus, 2020 PSP/CIP as well as the 2021
and 2022 PSP/CIP. This is consistent with the approach the Committee has used previously
for M&A activity. The adjusted targets can be found on pages 111 to 112.
2022 bonus The Committee approved the achievement of the performance targets for the 2022 bonus
plan not only against the formulaic outcome but taking into account the wider business
context. Please see pages 109 to 110 for details of the performance achieved in 2022 and
the resulting bonus outcomes.
2023 salary review The Committee took into consideration inflationary forecasts and local market conditions
when assessing the annual salary review process, noting that the current inflationary
environment has more impact on lower paid employees. After assessing the relative
impacts carefully, and taking into account the additional payment being given to
UK employees, the Committee agreed a 5% increase for the CEO, with the average
UK increase being 6%, in addition to a one-off cost of living payment.
GET Remuneration The Committee reviewed, and approved, the remuneration packages for members of the
GET taking into account pay for employees across the Group and in the relevant regional
markets, and benchmarking carried out by its remuneration advisors.
Pension Following a review of the UK pension offering, the Committee assessed the pension
contributions for Executive Directors. Please see page 97 for further details of alignment
of pension rates.
Wider workforce The Committee considered the reward landscape for the wider workforce including total
remuneration bonus outcomes, the achievement of regional financial targets, and the distribution of
performance outcomes for personal objectives.
Chairman’s fees The Committee approved a 4% fee increase for the Chairman.
a. Base salary/fees.
b. Taxable benefits comprise car allowance, medical cover and mileage allowance.
c. Payment for performance under the annual bonus, including amounts paid in shares.
d. The 2022 figure for the CEO includes the 2020 PSP and CIP which will vest in June 2023 based on performance over a three-year period from 1 January 2020
to 31 December 2022. These awards are subject to an additional two-year holding period and therefore will be released in 2025. The figures have been valued
using the three-month average share price from 1 October 2022 to 31 December 2022 of 789p. Actual performance against targets is given on page 111.
The value includes a movement of £665,321, which was due to an increase in share price over the period, and £88,712 in respect of dividend shares accrued
over the performance period. The figure will be revised in next year’s DRR to reflect the share price on the date of vesting.
e. Duncan Tait and Gijsbert de Zoeten received a pension allowance of 10% of salary. See page 112 for further details.
The Committee is mindful that the CEO’s single figure emoluments for FY22 is high relative to the prior two years, but this
reflects the first vesting under the PSP and CIP since his appointment three years ago, combined with strong underlying
performance warranting a maximum bonus payout.
Base salary
Salaries are reviewed annually and typically take effect from 1 April each year. The quantum of total Executive
remuneration was reviewed against relevant size and sector peers. In considering the level of increase to be awarded,
the Committee also took into account the remuneration arrangements for the wider workforce and, in particular, the salary
increases for other UK employees. Given the current inflationary environment and the increased variable opportunity
available to the senior executives, the Committee felt that it was appropriate to award a lower level of increase to the
Chief Executive Officer for 2023 than the average UK workforce rate.
The salaries for 2021, 2022 and 2023 are set out below:
01-Apr-21
(or date of
appointment % increase
Name if later) 01-Apr-22 01-Apr-23 in 2023
The Chairman and the Non-Executive Directors received a fee increase of 4% per annum. When considering the fee
increase, benchmarking and the current inflationary environment were taken into account. There is no change to the
additional fees for chairing a committee, which are £17,000 for the Chair of the Audit and Remuneration Committees
and £14,000 for the Chair of the CSR Committee.
STRATEGIC REPORT
sustainable growth and the financial measures, based on a matrix of revenue and profit before tax, are designed to provide
a balanced approach. The strategic objectives are selected each year to reinforce the Group’s strategic priorities and
include personal objectives linked to the delivery of the strategy.
The principles for setting the bonus framework are such that it:
• drives the desired behaviours underpinned by our performance drivers;
• may be easily cascaded through the organisation to reinforce alignment of our collective goals; and
• has clear measures and targets.
2022 bonus
For 2022, 80% of the bonus was based on financial performance via a matrix of revenue and profit before tax with the
remaining 20% of the bonus based on strategic objectives, therefore linking an individual’s bonus outcome to their
contribution to the Accelerate strategy. The maximum opportunity for the Executive Directors was 150% of salary, which
is payable for achieving stretch performance against all measures. Any bonus earned above 100% of salary is deferred
and invested into the CIP.
GOVERNANCE
Revenue and profit before tax are structured as a matrix such that failure to deliver threshold in either metric leads to
no bonus being achievable in the other.
• 10% of maximum for this element is payable for threshold performance.
• 50% of maximum is payable where both metrics achieve target performance.
• To achieve the maximum award, stretch performance would be required against both metrics.
• Intervening points are calculated using the matrix anchor points shown below.
Revenue
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
Threshold £6.7bn 10% 30% 60%
Targets
Actual Matrix outcome Matrix outcome
Measure Threshold Target Stretch performance % of maximum % of total bonus
Strategic
objective and
% weighting of Outcome % of
bonus Objective details Outcome salary
Digital Leadership Successfully deploy Digital Dealer Software was deployed to 56 Independent 15%
10% Digital Dealer software to dealers in 2022. Six OEMs were covered.
50 independent dealers
across three OEMs
Develop and deploy DXP The Digital Direct (DXP) Solution was deployed to one
direct to one market. major market in December 2022. Test scripts were
validated and aligned to the intended solution.
Build Vehicle Open 15 new bravoauto 22 bravoauto stores were opened in 2022 taking the 7.5%
Lifecycle strategy stores in five markets cumulative total to 30 stores as of 31 December 2022.
5%
Of the 22 stores – five were opened in H1 and 17 in H2.
The stores were opened in eight markets – Australia,
Belgium, Colombia, Estonia, Poland, Romania, Thailand,
and the UK.
Bring Planet Scope 1 and 2 reduced by A formal GHG Climate Reporting Process and 7.5%
commitments at least 9,000 tonnes Methodology is used to calculate annual carbon
to life
5% savings based on an agreed model including various
data sources including emissions, energy, natural gas,
company vehicles, purchased electricity and travel
indicators. The data confirmed the Group’s 2022 carbon
saving ambition had been met with a 9,800-tonne
adjusted outturn.
Agree plan for Scope 3 The Group Scope 3 footprint was calculated during the
with Board year and the findings used by the Board to develop its
approach to setting Scope 3 reduction targets.
Financial Strategic
targets targets Total Total
outcome (% of outcome (% of outcome (% of bonus
salary) salary) salary) £
Duncan Tait 120% 30% 150% £1,241,224
Any bonus earned above 100% of salary is deferred and invested into the CIP, and as a result one third of the total 2022
bonus for Duncan Tait will be subject to mandatory deferral into the CIP.
STRATEGIC REPORT
measured over three years to 31 December 2022. These awards are also subject to an additional post-vest two-year
holding period. The performance targets were set prior to the outbreak of the Covid-19 pandemic and no adjustments were
made for this. Consistent with the Committee’s previous approach for material M&A activity, the EPS targets were adjusted
for the disposal of the Russian business in 2022. No adjustment was made for the ROCE or cash conversion targets as the
impact was immaterial.
2020 PSP/CIP performance targets
Three-year EPS cumulative growth p.a. (40% weighting)* Vesting % Three-year average ROCE (40% weighting) Unexpired term
GOVERNANCE
55% to 70% 25%
70% 100%
Between 55% and 70% Straight line basis
* the pre-adjusted EPS targets were 169p – 191p.
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
Award Performance measure Wtg. Vesting outcome (% of element)
The Remuneration Committee considered the outcome in the context overall business performance. The Committee did
not exercise any discretion. As a result, the following awards will vest:
Duncan Tait
PSP 2 June 2020 251,342 150,805 100,537 2 June 2023 £1,189,853
CIP 26 June 2020 139,682 83,809 55,873 26 June 2023 £661,254
*Estimated value calculated using the three-month share price average from 1 October 2022 to 31 December 2022 of 789p.
As noted on page 97, the number of shares under award was reduced by 10% at the time of grant to reflect the volatility
in the share price at the time. The Committee reviewed the vesting outcome, taking into account the financial and share
price performance of the business over the period and was satisfied that given the upfront reduction in the award level,
no further adjustment was required at vesting.
* The pre-adjusted targets were EPS 184p – 208p and ROCE 23% – 28%.
Threshold level performance will result in 25% of the 2022 PSP and CIP awards vesting.
Share Number of
price shares/options Face value
Date of grant (p)1 awarded at grant2 Performance period Exercise period3
Duncan Tait
PSP 8 April 2022 650.00p 222,342 £1,445,223 Jan 2022 – Dec 2024 Apr 2025 – Apr 2026
CIP 6 May 2022 706.00p 116,711 £823,980 Jan 2022 – Dec 2024 May 2025 – Nov 2025
Three-year cumulative EPS (40% weighting) Vesting % Three-year average ROCE (40% weighting) Unexpired term
Pension
Duncan Tait received a pension contribution of 10% of salary during 2022. Since the policy was last approved in 2020, the
UK pension offering has been simplified and is now a standardised defined contribution plan (from a mix of defined benefit
and defined contribution arrangements). As such the contribution rate for UK employees is now estimated to be approx.
7% - 7.5% of salary. Consequently, the Committee agreed that under the new remuneration policy, new Executive Directors
will be offered a maximum pension contribution rate of 7% of salary. Duncan Tait volunteered to freeze his allowance at
the current £ value as an interim step, and bring the pension contribution rate down to 7% after 31 December 2023.
STRATEGIC REPORT
date of leaving if earlier.
GOVERNANCE
Till Vestring* 48,480 n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a
* Sarah Kuijlaars joined on 20 January 2022, Till Vestring left on 19 May 2022, Gijsbert de Zoeten resigned on 27 November 2022 and all unvested awards lapsed at
that date.
There have been no changes to the number of shares held by the Directors between 31 December 2022 and 22 March 2023.
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
Percentage change in Board remuneration
The table shows the percentage change in Board remuneration, compared with the average percentage change in
remuneration for senior management. For the purposes of this disclosure, remuneration comprises salary, benefits (excluding
pension) and annual bonus only.
Executive Directors
Duncan Tait n/a n/a n/a 2.5% 0% 100% 3.5% 0% 5.5%
Gijsbert de Zoeten 3% 0% - 100% 3.8% -90% 100% 3.5% 0% -100%
Non-Executive
Directors
Nigel Stein 2% 0% n/a 2.5% 0% n/a 3.5% 0% n/a
Jerry Buhlmann 0% n/a n/a 2.5% n/a n/a 3.5% n/a n/a
Alex Jensen 0% n/a n/a 2.5% n/a n/a 3.5% n/a n/a
Jane Kingston 0% n/a n/a 2.5% n/a n/a 3.5% n/a n/a
John Langston 0% n/a n/a 2.5% n/a n/a 3.5% n/a n/a
Till Vestring 0% n/a n/a 2.5% n/a n/a 3.5% n/a n/a
Nayantara Bali n/a n/a n/a 0% n/a n/a 3.5% n/a n/a
Sarah Kuijlaars n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a 3.5% n/a n/a
Average pay
based on
senior management 3.16% 0% - 82.91% 3.28% 0% 73.2% 5.78% 0% 9.5%
As Inchcape plc has no direct employees, employees representing the most senior Executives have been selected as this
group is large enough to provide a robust comparison, while also providing data that is readily available on a matched
sample basis. These employees also participate in bonus schemes of a similar nature to the Executive Directors and
therefore remuneration will be similarly influenced by Company performance.
For 2022, the employee at P50 is a Sales Representative who has a high variable pay mix. During the year, the pay mix for Sales
Representatives was reviewed with pay in 2023 rebalanced towards fixed pay. The Committee is satisfied that the overall
picture presented by the 2022 pay ratios is consistent with the reward policies for Inchcape’s UK employees. The Committee
takes into account these ratios when making decisions around the Executive Director pay packages, and Inchcape takes
seriously the need to ensure competitive pay packages across the organisation.
STRATEGIC REPORT
and share buybacks) from 2021 to 2022.
Relative importance of spend on pay (£m)
(+2%)
£475.1 £485.5
(+70%) (-14%)
£88.7 £80.5
£52.2 £69.5
GOVERNANCE
2021 2022
* The 2021 comparative figure has been restated due to an error in classification.
The Directors are proposing a final dividend for 2022 of 21.3p per share (2021: 22.5p).
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
300
250
200
150
100
50
2012 2013 2014 2015 2016 2017 2018 2019 2020 2021 2022
Group Chief
Executive 2013 2014 2015 2016 2017 2018 2019 2020 2021 2022
CEO single figure André Lacroix 4,400 5,265 2941 n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a
of remuneration Stefan Bomhard n/a n/a 2,906 1,403 3,006 2,430 1,522 4712 n/a n/a
(£’000)
Duncan Tait n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a 468 2,054 4,087
Annual bonus
outcome
(% of maximum) 48% 100% 56.8% 40.3% 67.6% 38.5% n/a 6 0% 100% 100%
LTI vesting 3
outcome
(% of maximum) 66% 68% n/a4 n/a 5 79.6% 58% 40% n/a7 n/a8 60 %
1. The amount for André Lacroix reflects remuneration received until he left the Group in March 2015.
2. The amount for Stefan Bomhard reflects remuneration received until he left the Group in June 2020.
3. LTI includes CIP, ‘normal’ PSP and ‘enhanced’ PSP.
4. Neither André Lacroix nor Stefan Bomhard received a vested award under the 2013 PSP or CIP. However, for those participants who did receive an award,
65.5% of the 2013 normal PSP vested and there was a 1.31 match for each share invested into the 2013 CIP.
5. Stefan Bomhard did not receive an award under the 2014 PSP or CIP. However, for those participants who did receive an award, 86.5% of the normal PSP vested
and there was a 1.73:1 match for each share invested into the CIP.
6. Stefan Bomhard did not receive a bonus in 2019.
7. Neither Stefan Bomhard nor Duncan Tait received a vested award under the 2018 PSP or CIP. However, for those participants who did receive an award,
28.5% of the 2018 PSP vested and there was a 0.57:1 match for each share invested into the 2018 CIP.
8. Duncan Tait did not receive an award under the 2019 PSP or CIP. However for those participants who did receive an award, 40% of the PSP vested and there
was a 0.8:1 match for each share invested into the 2019 CIP.
Shareholder context
The table below shows the advisory vote on the Remuneration Report at the 2022 AGM:
Total number % of
of votes votes cast
The table below shows the binding vote on the remuneration policy at the 2020 AGM:
Total % of
of votes votes cast
Withheld votes are not included in the final proxy figures as they are not recognised as a vote in law.
Other directorships
The Executive Directors are generally permitted to take one non-executive directorship as long as it does not lead to
conflicts of interest or undue time commitment and is approved in advance by the Nomination Committee and the Board.
Duncan Tait currently serves as a non-executive director on the board of Agilisys Ltd for which he received a fee of £25,000
during 2022.
JANE KINGSTON
CHAIR OF THE REMUNERATION COMMITTEE
STRATEGIC REPORT
DIRECTORS’ REPORT
The Directors’ Report for the year ended 31 December 2022 comprises pages 117 to 122 of this report (together with sections
incorporated by reference).
Information required in the Management Report under DTR 4.1.8R can be found in the following sections: a review of the
business and future developments on pages 2 to 57; principal risks and uncertainties on pages 59 to 67; a description of the
Board’s activities and the structure of its Committees is given on page 76; and, a description of the Group’s internal control
framework is given on pages 91 to 93;
GOVERNANCE
Corporate governance statement
The statement of compliance with the UK Corporate Governance Code 2018 (Code) is given on page 71. The Code is
published on the Financial Reporting Council’s website www.frc.org.uk. Information required under DTR 7 is given in the
Corporate Governance Report on pages 70 to 116.
Board of Directors
The Directors of the Company below were in office during the year and up to the date of signing the financial statements:
Nayantara Bali Byron Grote (joined January 2023) John Langston
Jerry Buhlmann Alexandra Jensen NIgel Stein
Juan Pablo Del Río (joined January 2023) Jane Kingston Duncan Tait
Gijsbert de Zoeten (resigned November 2022) Sarah Kuijlaars (joined January 2022) Till Vestring (left May 2022)
In accordance with the Code, all current Directors except for John Langston will stand for election or re-election at the
Annual General Meeting (AGM) on 18 May 2023. The Chairman has reviewed the performance of each Director and is
satisfied that each continues to be effective and demonstrates commitment to the role. The appointment and replacement
of Directors is governed by the Company’s Articles of Association (Articles), the Code, the Companies Act 2006 and related
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
legislation. The Articles are available on the Company’s website. The Articles were not amended during the year.
Subject to the Articles, the Code and relevant legislation, the business of the Company is managed by the Board which
may exercise all the powers of the Company.
Shareholders
Engagement with shareholders is important to the Company so that we are able to understand the key issues of
importance to them and get their views on the business. Any updates regarding the business, including presentations
by the Group Chief Executive, are available on the Group’s website so that all shareholders have access to the same
Company information at the same time. Further information on stakeholder engagement can be found on pages 20 to 22.
As our 20 largest shareholders own over 65% of the business, shareholder consultations, such as the remuneration policy, are
carried out with this group. Extending the consultation to all shareholders would not be cost effective, and shareholders not
involved in the consultation process are encouraged to use the AGM forum to express their views either by asking questions
or voting on the relevant resolutions.
Conflicts of interest
The Articles permit the Board to authorise any matter which would otherwise involve a Director breaching their duty under
the Companies Act 2006 to avoid conflicts of interest. When authorising a conflict of interest, the Board must do so without
the conflicted Director counting as part of the quorum. In the event that the Board considers it appropriate, the conflicted
Director may be permitted to participate in the debate but will be permitted neither to vote nor count in the quorum when
the decision is being agreed. The Directors are aware that it is their responsibility to inform the Board of any potential
conflicts as soon as possible and procedures are in place to facilitate disclosure.
Directors’ indemnity
A qualifying third-party indemnity (QTPI), as permitted by the Articles and sections 232 and 234 of the Companies Act 2006,
has been granted by the Company to each of the Directors of the Company.
Under the provisions of the QTPI, the Company undertakes to indemnify each Director against liability to third parties
(excluding criminal and regulatory penalties) and to pay Directors’ costs as incurred, provided that they are reimbursed to
the Company if the Director is found guilty or, in an action brought by the Company, judgment is given against the Director.
The indemnity has been in force for the year ended 31 December 2022 and until the date of approval of this report.
The Company may, by ordinary resolution, declare a dividend not exceeding the amount recommended by the Board.
Subject to the Companies Act 2006, the Board may pay interim dividends when the financial position of the Company,
in the opinion of the Board, justifies its payment.
Share capital
As at 31 December 2022, the Company’s issued share capital of £37,449,403 comprised 374,494,030 ordinary shares of 10p.
On 4 January 2023, 38,513,102 ordinary shares of 10p each in the capital of the Company were issued in connection with
the acquisition of the Derco group. Following the allotment of these shares, the issued share capital of the Company stood
at 413,007,132 ordinary shares.
Holders of ordinary shares are entitled to receive the Company’s Report and Accounts, to attend and speak at General
Meetings and to appoint proxies and exercise voting rights. The shares do not carry any special rights with regard to control
of the Company. The rights are set out in the Articles.
Directors’ interests
The table showing the beneficial interests, including family interests, in the ordinary shares of the Company of the persons
who were Directors at 31 December 2022 is shown in the Directors’ Report on Remuneration on page 113. There have been
no changes to the interests or number of shares held by each Director between 31 December 2022 and 22 March 2023.
STRATEGIC REPORT
of the Company following a takeover bid apart from certain of the Group’s third-party funding arrangements which would
terminate upon a change of control of the Company, such as the Group’s revolving credit facility agreement. Further
details are given in note 23 to the financial statements on page 185.
The Group’s relationships with its OEM brand partners are managed at Group level, but the relevant contracts are entered
into at a local level with day-to-day management being led by each operating business. Certain of the contracts may
terminate on a change of control of the local contracting company.
The Company does not have agreements with any Director or employee providing compensation for loss of office or
employment that occurs because of a takeover bid, except for provisions in the rules of the Company’s share schemes
which may result in options or awards granted to employees to vest on a takeover.
GOVERNANCE
The information required to be disclosed by LR 9.8.4R can be found on the pages set out below:
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
Business relationships
Having positive relationships with our OEM brand partners, our main suppliers, and our customers is imperative for the
long-term success of the Company. Our OEM brand partner relationships are key to every part of our value chain and
the length of these relationships, which are given on page 4, is testament to this strength.
We provide access to automotive ownership and support services throughout the customer journey and aim to deliver
the best experiences for customers in our industry globally. The Board and management engage with customers through:
• receiving daily reporting of customer feedback on www.reputation.com;
• analysing sales force customer journey management platform; and
• ongoing surveys at market level.
Financial instruments
The information required under Schedule 7 of the Large and Medium-sized Companies and Groups (Accounts and Reports)
Regulations 2008 in respect of financial instruments is given in note 24 to the financial statements on pages 187 to 195.
Political donations
The Company did not make any political donations in 2022 and does not intend to make any political donations in 2023.
Intensity ratio
The Group’s intensity ratio is revenue per tonne of CO2e. This allows for a fair comparison over time of CO2e emissions given
the growth trajectory envisaged for the Group and cyclical variations in business activity. As required under the SECR
regulations the following information relates to the energy consumed in our operations. The list of UK entities is given on
pages 219 to 228.
2022 2021
UK & Offshore Global UK & Offshore Global
These energy efficiency measures were developed further in 2022, which involved:
• Australia and all but one of our European markets have now switched to renewable electricity tariffs.
• The installation of solar panels and LED lightning across all of our UK sites.
• Installation of solar panels has started across Australia, Singapore and Thailand.
• Colombia and Peru have increased the number of electric and hybrid vehicles available in their fleets.
• Our markets in Greater China and Singapore have converted their fleets to include 70% and 30% low emission vehicles
respectively, and will continue this until the fleet only contains low emission vehicles.
STRATEGIC REPORT
teamwork, fresh thinking, a focus on delivery, and putting our customers at the centre of everything we do.
In support of this, our performance framework, called One Inchcape Values & Behaviours, sets out the values and
behaviours we all need to live by at Inchcape. The Company also has various employee policies in place covering a wide
range of issues, such as family friendly policies, employment rights and equal opportunities. Policies are implemented at
a local level and comply with any relevant legislation in that market. All policies are available on the Group’s intranet and
compliance is monitored at local level.
The Group’s bonus and long-term incentive schemes are designed to encourage involvement in the Company’s
performance. UK employees are eligible to join the SAYE scheme, which is offered annually. Further details can be found
in the Directors’ Report on Remuneration on pages 96 to 116.
Employee communication
Townhall meetings are held in each region on a regular basis and also following the release of any financial updates by
the Company. The townhall meetings provide employees with information on the Group’s performance and an opportunity
for consulting employees on new initiatives or other matters that concern them. The Group’s global intranet, iConnect,
also provides a means of communicating important issues to employees.
The employee experience survey is the primary tool for obtaining the views of employees and the results of the survey
GOVERNANCE
are reported to the CSR Committee on an annual basis. The Chair of the CSR Committee is the designated Director for
communicating the views of employees to the Board and she reports the findings to the Board following each meeting.
The consultation enables the Board to gain an understanding of how the employee experience is perceived and what
actions can be taken to enhance this experience so employees feel challenged, excited, engaged and supported in
their roles. Further details can be found in the CSR Committee Report on page 95.
Diversity
As required under LR9.8.6, the breakdown of the gender identity and ethnic background of those who were Directors of the
Company and executive management, as well as the gender identity of employees of the Company, as at 31 December
2022 is as follows:
Number
Gender identity Number of senior Number in Percentage Percentage
or sex as at 31 of Board Percentage positions on executive of executive Number of all of all
December 2022 members of the Board the Board* management management employees employees
Men 4 50% 4 62 78% 10,675 73%
Women 4 50% 0 17 22% 3,932 27%
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
Not specified/prefer
not to say 0 0% 0 0 0% 3 <1%
Number of
Number senior Number in Percentage
of Board Percentage positions on executive of executive
Ethnic background as at 31 December 2022 members of the Board the Board* management management
White British or other White 7 87.5% 4 34 43%
Mixed/Multiple Ethnic Groups 0 0% 0 0 0%
Asian/Asian British 1 12.5% 0 7 9%
Black/African/Caribbean/Black British 0 0% 0 0 0%
Other ethnic group, including Arab 0 0% 0 3 4%
Not specified/prefer not to say 0 0% 0 35 44%
The Board did not have at least one woman in the position of Chair, Chief Executive, Chief Financial Officer or Senior
Independent Director as at that date. The Nomination Committee is responsible for succession planning on the Board
and as such considers these targets during the recruitment process.
In 2022, we launched our first global HR system enabling our colleagues to self-identify their diversity information. This
involved a global review to assess what diversity questions are legally possible, culturally sensitive, and safe to include. The
review found that 24% of our markets can ask and collect ethnicity information from employees. The system was launched
in November 2022 with a series of communications encouraging colleagues to check and complete their profiles (including
ethnicity information) and each year we will roll-out communications and campaigns to encourage full disclosure in
markets where we can ask and collect ethnicity data.
Directors’ responsibilities
The Directors are responsible for preparing the Annual Report and the financial statements in accordance with applicable
law and regulation.
Company law requires the Directors to prepare financial statements for each financial year. Under that law the Group
financial statements have been properly prepared in accordance with United Kingdom adopted international accounting
standards and International Financial Reporting Standards (IFRSs) as issued by the International Accounting Standards
Board (IASB) and parent company financial statements in accordance with United Kingdom Generally Accepted
Accounting Practice (United Kingdom Accounting Standards, comprising FRS 101 ‘Reduced Disclosure Framework’,
and applicable law).
Under company law the Directors must not approve the financial statements unless they are satisfied that they give a true
and fair view of the state of affairs of the Group and parent company and of the profit or loss of the Group and parent
company for that period. In preparing the financial statements, the Directors are required to:
• select suitable accounting policies and then apply them consistently;
• state whether applicable United Kingdom Accounting Standards have been followed, subject to any material departures
disclosed and explained in the financial statements; and
• make judgements and accounting estimates that are reasonable and prudent; and prepare the financial statements
on the going concern basis unless it is inappropriate to presume that the Group and parent company will continue in
business.
The Directors are responsible for keeping adequate accounting records that are sufficient to show and explain the Group
and parent company’s transactions. The Directors are also responsible for disclosing with reasonable accuracy at any time
the financial position of the Group and parent company, and enabling them to ensure that the financial statements and
the Directors’ Remuneration Report comply with the Companies Act 2006 and, as regards the Group financial statements,
Article 4 of the IAS Regulation. The Directors are also responsible for safeguarding the assets of the Group and parent
company and hence for taking reasonable steps for the prevention and detection of fraud and other irregularities. The
Directors are responsible for the maintenance and integrity of the parent company’s website. Legislation in the United
Kingdom governing the preparation and dissemination of financial statements may differ from legislation in other
jurisdictions.
The Directors consider that the Annual Report and Accounts, taken as a whole, is fair, balanced and understandable and
provides the information necessary for shareholders to assess the Group and parent company’s performance, business
model and strategy. Each of the Directors, whose names and functions are listed in the Board of Directors, confirm that,
to the best of their knowledge:
• the parent company financial statements, which have been prepared in accordance with United Kingdom Generally
Accepted Accounting Practice (United Kingdom Accounting Standards, comprising FRS 101 ‘Reduced Disclosure
Framework’, and applicable law), give a true and fair view of the assets, liabilities, financial position and loss of the
Company;
• the Group financial statements, which have been properly prepared in accordance with United Kingdom adopted
international accounting standards and International Financial Reporting Standards (IFRSs) as issued by the International
Accounting Standards Board (IASB), give a true and fair view of the assets, liabilities, financial position and profit of the
Group; and
• the Directors’ Report includes a fair review of the development and performance of the business and the position
of the Group and parent company, together with a description of the principal risks and uncertainties that it faces.
The Directors considered the key messages contained in the Strategic Report along with the disclosures made throughout
to ensure that they are consistent, transparent and a true reflection of the business. The Directors also reviewed supporting
documentation which addresses specific statements made in the report and the evidence to support those statements.
Following this review, the Directors consider, when taken as a whole, that the Annual Report and Accounts is fair, balanced
and understandable and provides the information necessary for shareholders to assess the Company’s position and
performance, business model and strategy.
Going concern
Having assessed the principal risks and the other matters discussed in connection with the viability statement on page 67,
the Directors consider it appropriate to adopt the going concern basis of accounting in the financial statements for the
next 12 months.
TAMSIN WATERHOUSE
GROUP COMPANY SECRETARY
GOVERNANCE
STATEMENTS
124 Independent auditor’s report to the members
of Inchcape plc
136 Consolidated income statement
137 Consolidated statement of comprehensive income
138 Consolidated statement of financial position
139 Consolidated statement of changes in equity
140 Consolidated statement of cash flows
141 Accounting policies
152 Notes to the financial statements
206 Alternative performance measures
209 Five year record
210 Company statement of financial position
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
211 Company statement of changes in equity
212 Company accounting policies
215 Notes to the Company financial statements
OTHER INFORMATION
228 Shareholder information
The financial reporting framework that has been applied in the preparation of the Group financial statements is applicable
law and United Kingdom adopted international accounting standards. The financial reporting framework that has been
applied in the preparation of the Parent Company financial statements is applicable law and United Kingdom Accounting
Standards, including FRS 101 “Reduced Disclosure Framework” (United Kingdom Generally Accepted Accounting Practice).
GOVERNANCE
Materiality The materiality that we used for the Group financial statements was £26.8 million which was
determined on the basis of 1.7% of net assets and equates to 5.3% of pro forma adjusted profit before
tax from continuing operations of the enlarged Group incorporating Derco as outlined in Note 29
(Acquisition and Disposals) to the financial statements.
We changed the benchmark used in determining materiality in the current year to net assets from
statutory profit before tax and adjusting items including net acquisition costs, which was used in the
prior year. The Group completed its acquisition of the Derco Group on 31 December 2022, resulting
in an increase to the consolidated statement of financial position of the enlarged Group with no
corresponding increase to the consolidated income statement for the year then ended. Therefore
we have concluded the use of a profit based benchmark to be inappropriate in the current year.
Scoping The components which were either full or specified account balance scope in the current year
contributed 76% (2021: 76%) of the Group’s revenue, 76% (2021: 78%) of the Group’s adjusted profit
before tax from continuing operations and 80% (2021: 80%) of the Group’s net assets.
Significant The most significant changes in our approach relate to the acquisition of the Derco Group and the
changes in our disposal of the Group’s operations in Russia, which have been identified as new key audit matters.
approach We have removed UK Site impairment as a key audit matter due to the return to profitability of the
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
UK retail business.
Based on the work we have performed, we have not identified any material uncertainties relating to events or conditions
that, individually or collectively, may cast significant doubt on the Group’s and Parent Company’s ability to continue
as a going concern for a period of at least twelve months from when the financial statements are authorised for issue.
In relation to the reporting on how the Group has applied the UK Corporate Governance Code, we have nothing material
to add or draw attention to in relation to the directors’ statement in the financial statements about whether the directors
considered it appropriate to adopt the going concern basis of accounting.
Our responsibilities and the responsibilities of the directors with respect to going concern are described in the relevant
sections of this report.
GOVERNANCE
the distribution agreement.
In the current year, management performed annual impairment reviews on the Suzuki CGU and then
the Central America group of CGUs, which resulted in no further impairment or reversals. Current year
performance was better than budget resulting in a slight increase in forecast outlook, which was offset
by an increase in the discount rate in the current year, therefore headroom remained tight.
As noted on page 67, management’s financial planning process incorporates an Annual Operating
Plan (“AOP”) for the next financial year (2023), together with financial forecasts/models for the
remaining years based on external market benchmarks. When determining recoverable amount,
cash flows are discounted using a discount rate and long-term growth rate advised by management’s
external expert.
There continues to be uncertainty over market level performance in the short term given the ongoing
supplier constraints as a result of semi-conductor shortages and there is continuing uncertainty over the
strength and timing of the recovery of the market. Furthermore, there is ongoing uncertainty over wider
macro-economic factors, including rising interest rates and inflation which impact future forecasts.
Management’s forecast is reliant upon the continued supply of vehicles into the market. As noted
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
within Note 11 (Intangible Assets), the cash flows used within the impairment models are based on
assumptions which are key sources of estimation uncertainty and small movements in these
assumptions could lead to a further impairment or reversal.
Although the penetration of electric vehicles in each market is currently low, in Costa Rica as part of its
‘National Decarbonization Plan’ there are commitments to move to full electrification of the transport
network by 2050. Management consider that the impact of electrification within the forecast period
has been factored within the underlying market forecasts.
How the scope Our procedures in response to the key audit matter identified included:
of our audit
• Obtaining an understanding of relevant controls, including Group oversight and management
responded to the
review controls, over the preparation and use of cash flow forecasts in the impairment reviews;
key audit matter
• Assessing the integrity of the models used by management including reviewing their mechanical
accuracy;
• Assessing management’s historical forecasting accuracy by comparing budgets to actuals;
• Benchmarking management’s assumptions against reputable third-party industry growth forecasts,
publications, news articles, government legislation and economic data;
• Challenging management’s analysis of the impact of climate change through the use of our own
climate change specialists including challenge of the reasonableness of the assumptions applied
within the forecast period;
• Evaluating the competence, capabilities and objectivity of management’s expert who were
engaged to advise on the discount rate and long-term growth rate used;
• Engaging with our valuation specialists to independently evaluate the appropriateness of inputs
and the methodology used in determining the discount rates used;
• Assessing the impact of global supply chain constraints due to semi-conductor shortages on the
forecast cashflows;
• Performing sensitivities in order to challenge the reasonableness of management’s assumptions;
and
• Assessing the appropriateness of disclosures in Note 11 (Intangible Assets) and the associated
sensitivities applied.
Key observations Based on our audit procedures we are satisfied that the assumptions in the impairment models are
within an acceptable range.
We also consider the disclosures in the Critical accounting judgements and key sources of estimation
uncertainty within the Accounting Policies section and Note 11 (Intangible Assets) are appropriate.
GOVERNANCE
The sale consideration consisted of €75m, receivable over 5 years, with a call option to reacquire
the business in the future. There is judgement applied in: assessing the date on which control has
transferred and the measurement of the deferred consideration, which includes the credit risk
associated with the purchasers and the market risk of receiving cash from Russia given the sanctions
regimes in place. Reflecting the inherent uncertainty, no value has been ascribed to the deferred
consideration and call option on initial recognition.
In September 2022, the Group received the first instalment of €15m, and has been recorded within
Note 3b (Other operating income). There are uncertainties which remain on the ability to receive the
remaining €60m, and therefore the deferred consideration remains valued at £nil on the balance
sheet date.
How the scope Our procedures in response to the key audit matter identified included:
of our audit
• Obtaining an understanding of relevant controls, including management review controls, over
responded to the
the initial valuation of the deferred consideration and call option;
key audit matter
• Challenging the assumptions over the deferred consideration, which included assessing the
likelihood of expected cash flows and ability of the buyer to remit the proceeds and the discount
rate applied by comparison to independent, external market data;
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
• Assessing that the Russian business had been deconsolidated from the date control passed by
evaluating the relevant sale and purchase agreement (SPA);
• Considering contradictory evidence, including review of board minutes, to assess whether there
are any indicators that the Group had control over the Russian operations after 31 May 2022;
• Obtaining evidence to support the initial instalment received of €15m;
• Assessing the disposal against the criteria of IFRS 5 to evaluate whether it is appropriately classified
as a discontinued operation; and
• Evaluating the relevant disclosures regarding the disposal of the Russian business within Note 29b
(Acquisitions and Disposals).
Key observations Based on our audit procedures, we are satisfied that the Group’s disclosures in Note 29b (Acquisitions
and Disposals) in relation to the disposal of Russia operations were appropriate, including the
disclosure of uncertainties relating to the valuation of the deferred consideration.
We concluded that the judgements made were reasonable and supportable.
Materiality £26.8 million (2021: £14.6 million) £11.9 million (2021: £6.0 million)
Basis for Our materiality was determined on the basis Parent Company materiality equates to 1.0%
determining of 1.7% of net assets and equates to 5.3% of pro of net assets (2021: 1.0% of net assets).
materiality forma adjusted profit before tax from continuing
operations of the enlarged Group incorporating
Derco as outlined in Note 29 (Acquisitions and
Disposals) to the financial statements. In the
prior year, materiality was determined on the
basis of 5% of adjusted profit before tax
including net acquisition costs which equated
to 1.3% of net assets.
In making our judgement, we considered the
focus of the users of the financial statements
as well as a range of benchmark metrics such
as adjusted profit before tax from continuing
operations and revenue, before selecting 1.7%
of net assets as the benchmark for determining
materiality.
As discussed in Section 3 “Materiality” on page
125, we changed the benchmark used in
determining materiality in the current year to
net assets due to the enlarged balance sheet
of the Group from the Derco group acquisition.
Rationale for Net assets in the current year are £1,567.0 million, As the Parent Company is non-trading, operates
the benchmark which have increased from the 2021 position primarily as a holding company for the Group’s
applied £1,130.5 million due to the acquisition of the trading entities, and is not profit orientated, we
Derco group on 31 December 2022. consider the net asset position to be the most
appropriate benchmark to use.
Given the acquisition completed on 31
December, there was an increase to the
consolidated statement of financial position
but with no corresponding increase to the
consolidated income statement. We consider
it appropriate to change the benchmark used
in determining materiality in the current year
to net assets.
Net assets
£1,567m Group materiality
£27m
Performance 65% (2021: 70%) of Group materiality 70% (2021: 70%) of Parent Company materiality
materiality
Basis and In determining performance materiality, we considered the following factors:
rationale for
• our cumulative experience from prior year audits, including the low value of misstatements
determining
identified in prior periods and management’s willingness to correct any misstatements identified;
performance
• our risk assessment, including our understanding of the entity, its environment;
materiality
• our risk assessment arising from the consolidation of the newly acquired Derco group for the Group
financial statements; and
• our assessment of the Group and Parent Company’s overall control environments.
GOVERNANCE
6.3. Error reporting threshold
We agreed with the Audit Committee that we would report to the Committee all audit differences in excess of £1.3 million
(2021: £0.7 million), with a lower threshold of £0.9 million used for the legacy Inchcape group, as well as differences below
that threshold that, in our view, warranted reporting on qualitative grounds. We also report to the Audit Committee on
disclosure matters that we identified when assessing the overall presentation of the financial statements.
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
The significant components which were subject to full audit procedures were in Australia, Chile, Colombia, Ethiopia, Hong
Kong, Singapore and the UK. Russia was no longer a significant component due to the Group disposing of its operations
in Russia during the year.
Our components performed audits of specific account balances in Belgium, Bolivia, Costa Rica, Greece, Peru, Poland
and Romania. Due to the acquisition of the Derco group, our component scope increased to include the audit of specified
balance sheet items within the acquired Derco group, which covered Bolivia, Chile, Colombia and Peru.
In addition to the work performed at a component level, the Group audit team also performed audit procedures on the
Parent Company and consolidated financial statements, corporate activities such as treasury and pensions, goodwill and
indefinite-life intangible asset impairments, litigation provisions, the Group consolidation, going concern assessment and
financial statement disclosures. The Group audit team also performed analytical reviews on out-of-scope components.
The range of component materialities applied was £2.1 million to £13.5 million (2021: £2.3 million to £6.0 million). The reporting
units where we conducted our audit work accounted for 76% (2021: 76%) of the Group’s revenue, 76% (2021: 78%) of the
Group’s profit before taxation from continuing operations and 80% (2021: 80%) of the Group’s net assets.
12%
8% 8%
76% 76%
80%
Full audit scope and specified Full audit scope and specified Full audit scope and specified
audit procedures audit procedures audit procedures
Review at group level Review at group level Review at group level
GOVERNANCE
9. RESPONSIBILITIES OF DIRECTORS
As explained more fully in the directors’ responsibilities statement, the directors are responsible for the preparation of the
financial statements and for being satisfied that they give a true and fair view, and for such internal control as the directors
determine is necessary to enable the preparation of financial statements that are free from material misstatement, whether
due to fraud or error.
In preparing the financial statements, the directors are responsible for assessing the Group’s and the Parent Company’s
ability to continue as a going concern, disclosing as applicable, matters related to going concern and using the going
concern basis of accounting unless the directors either intend to liquidate the Group or the Parent Company or to cease
operations, or have no realistic alternative but to do so.
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
users taken on the basis of these financial statements.
A further description of our responsibilities for the audit of the financial statements is located on the FRC’s website at:
www.frc.org.uk/auditorsresponsibilities. This description forms part of our auditor’s report.
11. EXTENT TO WHICH THE AUDIT WAS CONSIDERED CAPABLE OF DETECTING IRREGULARITIES, INCLUDING FRAUD
Irregularities, including fraud, are instances of non-compliance with laws and regulations. We design procedures in line with
our responsibilities, outlined above, to detect material misstatements in respect of irregularities, including fraud. The extent
to which our procedures are capable of detecting irregularities, including fraud is detailed below.
11.1. Identifying and assessing potential risks related to irregularities
In identifying and assessing risks of material misstatement in respect of irregularities, including fraud and non-compliance
with laws and regulations, we considered the following:
• the nature of the industry and sector, control environment and business performance including the design of the Group’s
remuneration policies, key drivers for directors’ remuneration, bonus levels and performance targets;
• results of our enquiries of management, internal audit, in-house legal counsel and the audit committee about their own
identification and assessment of the risks of irregularities, including those that are specific to the Group’s sector;
• any matters we identified having obtained and reviewed the Group’s documentation of their policies and procedures
relating to:
– identifying, evaluating and complying with laws and regulations and whether they were aware of any instances
of non-compliance;
– detecting and responding to the risks of fraud and whether they have knowledge of any actual, suspected or
alleged fraud;
– the internal controls established to mitigate risks of fraud or non-compliance with laws and regulations;
• the matters discussed among the audit engagement team including significant component audit teams and relevant
internal specialists regarding how and where fraud might occur in the financial statements and any potential indicators
of fraud.
As a result of these procedures, we considered the opportunities and incentives that may exist within the organisation for
fraud and identified the greatest potential for fraud in the judgements related to Central America indefinite-life intangible
asset impairment and UK site impairment. In common with all audits under ISAs (UK), we are also required to perform
specific procedures to respond to the risk of management override.
We also obtained an understanding of the legal and regulatory frameworks that the Group operates in, focusing on
provisions of those laws and regulations that had a direct effect on the determination of material amounts and disclosures
in the financial statements. The key laws and regulations we considered in this context included the UK Companies Act,
Listing Rules, pensions legislation and tax legislation.
In addition, we considered provisions of other laws and regulations that do not have a direct effect on the financial
statements but compliance with which may be fundamental to the Group’s ability to operate or to avoid a material
penalty. These included environmental regulations.
11.2. Audit response to risks identified
As a result of performing the above, we identified the Central America indefinite-life intangible asset impairment as a
key audit matter related to the potential risk of fraud. The key audit matters section of our report explains the matter in
more detail and also describes the specific procedures we performed in response to the key audit matter.
In addition to the above, our procedures to respond to risks identified included the following:
• reviewing the financial statement disclosures and testing to supporting documentation to assess compliance with
provisions of relevant laws and regulations described as having a direct effect on the financial statements;
• enquiring of management, the audit committee and in-house legal counsel concerning actual and potential litigation
and claims;
• performing analytical procedures to identify any unusual or unexpected relationships that may indicate risks of material
misstatement due to fraud;
• reading minutes of meetings of those charged with governance, reviewing internal audit reports and reviewing
correspondence with HMRC;
• in relation to judgement in the UK site impairment, challenging management’s analysis and assumptions with the support
of our real estate and valuation specialists through comparison to external market data and considering contradictory
evidence; and performing sensitivities to challenge the reasonableness of management’s assumptions; and
• in addressing the risk of fraud through management override of controls, testing the appropriateness of journal entries
and other adjustments; assessing whether the judgements made in making accounting estimates are indicative of a
potential bias; and evaluating the business rationale of any significant transactions that are unusual or outside the normal
course of business.
We also communicated relevant identified laws and regulations and potential fraud risks to all engagement team members
including internal specialists and significant component audit teams, and remained alert to any indications of fraud or
non-compliance with laws and regulations throughout the audit.
GOVERNANCE
• the section of the annual report that describes the review of effectiveness of risk management and internal control
systems set out on page 91; and
• the section describing the work of the Audit Committee set out on page 89.
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
We have nothing to report in respect of these matters.
2022 20211
Continuing operations Notes £m £m
The notes on pages 141 to 205 are an integral part of these consolidated financial statements.
STRATEGIC REPORT
2022 20211
Notes £m £m
GOVERNANCE
– net fair value gains 26 8.7 18.5
– tax on cash flow hedges 2
17 (6.6) (2.8)
Investments held at fair value
– net fair value (losses)/gains 15 (1.5) 1.6
Deferred tax on taxation losses 17 0.4 –
Foreign currency translation
Exchange differences on translation of foreign operations 26 132.4 (104.2)
Exchange differences on translation of discontinued operations 26,29(b) 18.7 (0.1)
Recycling of foreign currency reserve 26 99.0 108.2
Adjustments for hyperinflation 26 48.6 –
299.7 21.2
Other comprehensive income for the year 288.0 79.0
Total comprehensive income for the year 281.8 200.9
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
Total comprehensive income attributable to:
– Owners of the parent 270.7 196.8
– Non-controlling interests 11.1 4.1
281.8 200.9
Total comprehensive income/(loss) attributable to owners of Inchcape plc arising from
– Continuing operations 405.2 163.3
– Discontinued operations (123.4) 37.6
1. Comparative amounts have been adjusted to reflect the classification of the remaining business in Russia as a discontinued operation.
2. Taxation in other comprehensive income in respect of cashflow hedges is comprised of a deferred tax charge of £9.3m (2021: charge of £0.5m) offset by
a current tax credit of £2.7m (2021: charge of £2.3m).
The notes on pages 141 to 205 are an integral part of these consolidated financial statements.
2022 2021
Notes £m £m
Non-current assets
Intangible assets 11 1,174.0 394.1
Property, plant and equipment 12 736.8 548.0
Right-of-use assets 13 419.2 261.4
Investments in joint ventures and associates 14 22.2 4.9
Financial assets at fair value through other comprehensive income 15 3.3 4.8
Derivative financial instruments 24 17.3 3.0
Trade and other receivables 16 53.4 45.4
Deferred tax assets 17 80.0 67.4
Retirement benefit asset 5 103.8 135.3
2,610.0 1,464.3
Current assets
Inventories 18 2,375.8 1,134.7
Trade and other receivables 16 816.8 324.1
Financial assets at fair value through other comprehensive income 15 0.2 0.2
Derivative financial instruments 24 36.9 24.6
Current tax assets 40.8 9.0
Cash and cash equivalents 19 1,064.2 596.4
Assets held for sale and disposal group 20 19.0 4.8
4,353.7 2,093.8
Total assets 6,963.7 3,558.1
Current liabilities
Trade and other payables 21 (2,898.0) (1,548.3)
Derivative financial instruments 24 (38.1) (31.9)
Current tax liabilities (88.2) (63.0)
Provisions 22 (56.6) (34.9)
Lease liabilities 13 (83.4) (56.5)
Borrowings 23 (546.3) (7.6)
(3,710.6) (1,742.2)
Non-current liabilities
Trade and other payables 21 (60.4) (63.2)
Provisions 22 (46.7) (23.4)
Derivative financial instruments 24 (1.4) –
Deferred tax liabilities 17 (255.3) (68.1)
Lease liabilities 13 (416.0) (267.6)
Borrowings 23 (895.6) (210.0)
Retirement benefit liability 5 (10.7) (53.1)
(1,686.1) (685.4)
Total liabilities (5,396.7) (2,427.6)
Net assets 1,567.0 1,130.5
Equity
Share capital 25 37.6 38.5
Share premium 146.7 146.7
Capital redemption reserve 143.0 142.1
Merger reserve 26 315.8 –
Other reserves 26 69.3 (227.1)
Retained earnings 27 820.4 1,008.7
Equity attributable to owners of the parent 1,532.8 1,108.9
Non-controlling interests 34.2 21.6
Total equity 1,567.0 1,130.5
The notes on pages 141 to 205 are an integral part of these consolidated financial statements. The consolidated financial
statements on pages 136 to 140 were approved by the Board of Directors on 22 March 2023 and were signed on its behalf by:
DUNCAN TAIT
GROUP CHIEF EXECUTIVE
STRATEGIC REPORT
Total
equity
Capital attributable Non- Total
Share Share redemption Merger Other Retained to owners of controlling shareholders’
capital Premium reserve reserve reserves earnings the parent interests equity
Notes £m £m £m £m £m £m £m £m £m
At 1 January 2021 39.4 146.7 141.2 – (248.2) 962.8 1,041.9 19.3 1,061.2
Profit for the year – – – – – 117.0 117.0 4.9 121.9
Other comprehensive
income/(loss) for the year – – – – 22.0 57.8 79.8 (0.8) 79.0
Total comprehensive
income for the year – – – – 22.0 174.8 196.8 4.1 200.9
Hedging gains and losses
transferred to inventory – – – – (0.9) – (0.9) – (0.9)
GOVERNANCE
Share-based payments,
net of tax 4,17 – – – – – 10.0 10.0 – 10.0
Share buyback
programme 25 (0.9) – 0.9 – – (80.5) (80.5) – (80.5)
Purchase of own shares
by the Inchcape
Employee Trust – – – – – (6.2) (6.2) – (6.2)
Transactions with non-
controlling interests – – – – – – – 1.2 1.2
Dividends:
– Owners of the parent 10 – – – – – (52.2) (52.2) – (52.2)
– Non-controlling
interests – – – – – – – (3.0) (3.0)
At 1 January 2022 38.5 146.7 142.1 – (227.1) 1,008.7 1,108.9 21.6 1,130.5
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(Loss)/profit for the year – – – – – (11.2) (11.2) 5.0 (6.2)
Other comprehensive
income/(loss) for the year – – – – 293.6 (11.7) 281.9 6.1 288.0
Total comprehensive
income/(loss) for the year – – – – 293.6 (22.9) 270.7 11.1 281.8
Hedging gains and losses
transferred to inventory – – – – 2.8 – 2.8 – 2.8
Written put option 29 – – – – – (13.6) (13.6) – (13.6)
Shares to be issued 29 – – – 315.8 – – 315.8 – 315.8
Non-controlling interests
on acquisition of
subsidiaries – – – – – – – 5.3 5.3
Share-based payments,
net of tax 4,17 – – – – – 10.2 10.2 – 10.2
Share buyback
programme 25 (0.9) – 0.9 – – (69.5) (69.5) – (69.5)
Purchase of own shares
by the Inchcape
Employee Trust – – – – – (3.8) (3.8) – (3.8)
Dividends:
– Owners of the parent 10 – – – – – (88.7) (88.7) – (88.7)
– Non-controlling
interests – – – – – – – (3.8) (3.8)
At 31 December 2022 37.6 146.7 143.0 315.8 69.3 820.4 1,532.8 34.2 1,567.0
The notes on pages 141 to 205 are an integral part of these consolidated financial statements. Share-based payments
include a net tax credit of £nil (2021: net tax credit of £1.6m (current tax charge of £nil and a deferred tax credit of £1.6m)).
2022 2021
Notes £m £m
The notes on pages 141 to 205 are an integral part of these consolidated financial statements.
STRATEGIC REPORT
GENERAL INFORMATION
Inchcape plc is a public company limited by shares, domiciled and incorporated in the UK, and registered in England and
Wales. The address of the registered office is 22a St James’s Square, London, SW1Y 5LP. The nature of the Group’s operations
and principal activities are set out in note 1 and on pages 1 to 68.
The Group consolidated financial statements have been prepared in accordance with UK-adopted International Financial
Reporting Standards (IFRS) and the Companies Act 2006 applicable to companies reporting under IFRS.
Accounting convention
The consolidated financial statements have been prepared under the historical cost convention, except for financial assets
at fair value through other comprehensive income, and those financial assets and financial liabilities (including derivative
instruments) held at fair value through profit or loss, which are measured at fair value.
Going concern
Based on the Group’s cash flow forecasts and projections, the Board is satisfied that the Group will operate within the level
of its committed facilities for the foreseeable future. For this reason, the Board continues to adopt the going concern basis in
GOVERNANCE
preparing its financial statements. In assessing whether the Group is a going concern, the ongoing implications of COVID-19
and the shortage of semi-conductor chips have been considered. In making this assessment, the Group has considered
available liquidity in relation to net debt and committed facilities, the Group’s latest forecasts for 2023 and 2024 cash flows,
together with adjusted scenarios. The forecasts used reflect the latest view on the economic impact of COVID-19 on the
markets in which the Group operates, with a key emphasis on the latest Group forecasts including the newly acquired
Derco business, for 2023 and 2024.
Committed bank facilities, Private Placement borrowings amounting to £910m, of which £210m was drawn at 31 December
2022, and a new debt facility of £600m, comprised of a £250m term loan, and a £350m bridge facility, are subject to the
same interest cover covenant based on an adjusted EBITA measure to interest on consolidated borrowings measured on
a trailing 12-month basis at June and December.
The latest Group forecasts for 2023 and 2024 indicate that the Group is expected to be compliant with this covenant
throughout the forecast period and have sufficient liquidity to continue operating throughout that period.
A range of sensitivities has been applied to the forecasts to assess the Group’s compliance with its covenant requirements
over the forecast period. These sensitivities included:
• a one-month period of Covid-19 restrictions in 2023, similar in nature and impact to those seen in the first half of 2021,
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
impacting all of the Group’s markets simultaneously;
• a reduction in New and Used vehicle revenue due to a shortage of semi-conductor chips, reducing gross profit from
May 2023 to April 2024;
• a general liquidity reduction impacting working capital from December 2022;
• with no mitigating actions applied in relation to the sensitivities described above.
In a scenario where all of the above sensitivities occur at the same time, the Group has modelled the possibility of the
interest cover covenant being breached in 2023 and 2024. With the interest cover covenant measured on a trailing
12-month basis, the sensitised forecasts indicate that the Group is not expected to breach any covenants and would be
compliant with the interest cover requirements throughout the forecast period. Additionally, under these circumstances,
the Group expects to have sufficient funds to meet cash flow requirements.
Therefore, the board concluded that the Group will be able to operate within the level of its committed facilities for the
foreseeable future. The directors consider it appropriate to adopt the going concern basis of accounting in preparing
the financial statements for the year ending 31 December 2022.
BASIS OF CONSOLIDATION
The consolidated financial statements comprise the financial statements of the parent company (Inchcape plc) and all of
its subsidiary undertakings (defined as those where the Group has control), together with the Group’s share of the results of
its joint ventures (defined as those where the Group has joint control) and associates (defined as those where the Group has
significant influence but not control). The results of subsidiaries are consolidated and the Group’s share of results of its joint
ventures and associates is equity accounted for as of the same reporting date as the parent company, using consistent
accounting policies.
The results of newly acquired subsidiaries are consolidated using the acquisition method of accounting from the date on
which control of the net assets and operations of the acquired company are effectively transferred to the Group. Similarly,
the results of subsidiaries disposed of cease to be consolidated from the date on which control of the net assets and
operations is transferred out of the Group.
The Group treats transactions with non-controlling interests as transactions with equity owners of the Group. For purchases
from non-controlling interests, the difference between any consideration paid and the relevant share acquired of the
carrying value of net assets of the subsidiary is recorded in equity. Gains or losses on disposals to non-controlling interests
are also recorded in equity.
Investments in joint ventures and associates are accounted for using the equity method, whereby the Group’s share of
post-acquisition profits or losses is recognised in the consolidated income statement, and its share of post-acquisition
movements in shareholders’ equity is recognised in shareholders’ equity. If the Group’s share of losses in a joint venture
or associate equals or exceeds its investment in the joint venture or associate, the Group does not recognise further losses,
unless it has contractual obligations or made payments on behalf of the joint venture or associate.
Intercompany balances and transactions and any unrealised profits arising from intercompany transactions are eliminated
in preparing the consolidated financial statements.
In accordance with IAS 1 Presentation of Financial Statements, the Group Consolidated Income Statement for the year
ended 31 December 2022 has been changed to present the results of the Group on a continuing operations basis, with
a single amount reported for the total results for discontinued operations. The total for discontinued operations comprises
the post-tax profit or loss of discontinued operations and the post-tax loss on disposal (see note 29).
GOVERNANCE
CLIMATE CHANGE
In preparing the Group’s financial statements consideration has been given to the impact of both physical and transition
climate related risks, as described in the Task Force on Climate-Related Financial Disclosures (TCFD) section on page 44.
Based on the TCFD recommendations, in 2022, the Group performed an assessment of the five most critical climate related
risks and opportunities that were considered to have a potential financial impact on the financial statements.
Climate scenario analysis was used as a tool to identify and assess a potential range of future outcomes, by capturing
different assumptions about policies and physical climate conditions. Scenario analysis was applied to the five most
material risks and opportunities, being the transition risk of misalignment, increased carbon tax, aftersales revenues, margin
pressure risk, and physical risks (due to the direct impacts to property and inventories from extreme weather conditions).
There is inherent uncertainty over the assumptions used within these scenarios and how they will impact the Group’s
operations, cash flows and profit projections.
The policy, technology and market changes in response to climate change are still developing, and consequently the
financial statements cannot capture all possible future outcomes as these are not yet known.
The climate-related estimates and assumptions were applied primarily to going concern, impairment of non-financial
assets, property plant and equipment, indefinite life intangible assets and provisions.
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
REVENUE AND OTHER INCOME
Revenue is measured at the fair value of consideration receivable, net of any discounts, rebates, trade allowances,
incentives, or amounts collected on behalf of third parties. It is recognised to the extent that the transfer of promised goods
or services to a customer has been satisfied and the revenue can be reliably measured. Revenue excludes sales-related
taxes and intra-group transactions. In practice this means that:
Revenue from sale of goods
Revenue from the sale of goods is recognised when the obligation to transfer the goods to the customer has been satisfied
and the revenue can reliably be measured. The obligation to transfer goods to the customer is considered to have been
satisfied when the vehicles or parts are invoiced and physically dispatched or collected. Consideration received in
advance of transfer of goods is recognised as deferred revenue on the balance sheet and is subsequently recognised
as revenue when the transfer of goods occurs.
Revenue from rendering of services
Revenue from the rendering of services to the customer is considered to have been satisfied when the service has been
undertaken.
Group acts as an agent
Where the Group acts as an agent on behalf of a principal in relation to finance, insurance and similar products, the
associated commission income is recognised within revenue in the period in which the related finance or insurance
product is sold and receipt of payment can be assured.
Sales with a repurchase commitment
Where a vehicle is sold to a customer subject to a repurchase commitment and the possibility of the buyback being
exercised by the customer is highly likely, the transaction is recognised as a lease transaction with the Group acting as a
lessor. Consequently, such vehicles are recognised within ‘property, plant and equipment’ in the consolidated statement
of financial position at cost and are depreciated to their residual value over the period of the repurchase commitment.
The difference between the initial amounts received from the customer and the repurchase commitment is recognised as
deferred income in the consolidated statement of financial position and is released to the consolidated income statement
on a straight-line basis over the life of the arrangement. The repurchase commitment, which reflects the price at which the
vehicle will be bought back, is held within ‘trade and other payables’, according to the date of the commitment.
Where a vehicle is sold to a customer subject to a repurchase commitment and the possibility of the buyback being
exercised by the customer is not highly likely, revenue is recognised in full when the vehicle is sold, less the expected value
of the buyback payments to be made which is recorded as a liability in the consolidated statement of financial position.
Similarly, an estimate of the value of the vehicles to be returned is deducted from cost of sales and recognised as an asset
in the consolidated statement of financial position.
COST OF SALES
Cost of sales includes the expense relating to the estimated cost of self-insured product warranties offered to customers.
These warranties form part of the package of goods and services provided to the customer when purchasing a vehicle and
are not a separable product.
The Group receives income in the form of various incentives which are determined by our brand partners. The amount we
receive is generally based on achieving specific objectives, such as a specified sales volume, as well as other objectives
including maintaining brand partner standards which may include, but are not limited to, retail centre image and design
requirements, customer satisfaction survey results and training standards. Where incentives are based on a specific sales
volume or number of registrations, the related income is recognised as a reduction in cost of sales when it is reasonably
certain that the income has been earned. This is generally the later of the date the related vehicles are sold or registered
or when it is reasonably certain that the related target will be met. Where incentives are linked to retail centre image and
design requirements, customer satisfaction survey results or training standards, they are recognised as a reduction in cost
of sales when it is reasonably certain that the incentive will be received for the relevant period.
SHARE-BASED PAYMENTS
The Group operates various share-based award schemes. The fair value at the date at which the share-based awards are
granted is recognised in the consolidated income statement (together with a corresponding credit in shareholders’ equity)
on a straight-line basis over the vesting period, based on an estimate of the number of shares that will eventually vest. At
the end of each reporting period, the Group revises its estimates of the number of awards that are expected to vest. The
impact of any revision is recognised in the consolidated income statement with a corresponding adjustment to equity.
For equity-settled share-based awards, the services received from employees are measured by reference to the fair value
of the awards granted. With the exception of the Group Save As You Earn scheme, the vesting of all share-based awards
under all schemes is solely reliant upon non-market conditions, therefore no expense is recognised for awards that do not
ultimately vest. Where an employee or the Company cancels an award, the charge for that award is recognised as an
expense immediately, even though the award does not vest.
FINANCE INCOME
Finance income is recognised when it is probable that the economic benefits will flow to the Group and the amount
of income can be measured reliably. It is accrued on a time basis by reference to the principal outstanding and at the
effective interest rate applicable.
FINANCE COSTS
Borrowing costs which are directly attributable to the acquisition, construction or production of a qualifying asset are
capitalised as part of the cost of that asset from the first date on which the expenditure is incurred for the asset and until
such time as the asset is ready for its intended use. A Group capitalisation rate is used to determine the magnitude of
borrowing costs capitalised on each qualifying asset. This rate is the weighted average of Group borrowing costs, excluding
those borrowings made specifically for the purpose of obtaining a qualifying asset. All other borrowing costs are recognised
as an expense in the period in which they are incurred.
INCOME TAX
The charge for current income tax is based on the results for the period as adjusted for items which are not taxed or are
disallowed. It is calculated using tax rates that have been enacted or substantively enacted by the end of the reporting
period.
GOVERNANCE
Deferred tax liabilities are recognised for taxable temporary differences arising on investments in subsidiaries, joint ventures
and associates, except where the Group is able to control the reversal of the temporary difference and it is probable that
the temporary difference will not reverse in the foreseeable future.
Deferred tax is calculated at the tax rates that are expected to apply to the period when the asset is realised or the liability
is settled using rates enacted or substantively enacted at the end of the reporting period. Deferred tax is charged or
credited in the consolidated income statement, except when it relates to items credited or charged directly to
shareholders’ equity, in which case the deferred tax is also dealt with in shareholders’ equity.
Deferred tax assets and liabilities are only offset where there is a legally enforceable right of offset and there is an intention
to settle balances net.
The measurement of deferred tax liabilities and assets reflects the tax consequences that would follow from the manner
in which the Group expects, at the end of the reporting period, to recover or settle the carrying amount of its assets
and liabilities.
ADJUSTING ITEMS
The Group makes certain adjustments to the statutory profit measures in order to derive certain alternative performance
measures. Certain items which are material are presented as adjusting items within their relevant consolidated income
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
statement category. The separate reporting of adjusting items helps provide additional useful information regarding the
Group’s business performance and is used by management to facilitate internal performance analysis.
Management applies an adjusting items policy that is regularly discussed and approved by the Audit Committee. The
policy applied in identifying adjusting items is balanced when assessing gains and losses, clearly disclosed and applied
consistently from one year to the next.
Adjusting items are deemed to be those items that, in the judgement of the Group, need to be disclosed separately by virtue
of their nature, size or incidence. In determining the facts and circumstances, management considers key factors such as:
• where the same category of items recurs each year and in similar amounts (for example, restructuring costs),
consideration is given as to whether such amounts should be included as part of underlying profit:
• where significant items are likely to be finalised over more than one year, the effect of such items is applied uniformly; and
• ensuring the treatment of favourable and unfavourable transactions are treated consistently.
Items that may be considered adjusting in nature include gains or losses on the disposal of businesses, restructuring of
businesses, acquisition costs, asset impairments, recognition of monetary gains or losses on hyperinflation and the tax
effects of these items. Any reversal of an amount previously recognised as an adjusting item would also be recognised
as an adjusting item in a subsequent period.
Gains and losses on disposal of a business include the carrying amount of goodwill relating to the business sold except for
goodwill arising on business combinations on or before 31 December 1997 which has been deducted from shareholders’
equity and remains indefinitely in shareholders’ equity.
The residual values and useful lives of all assets are reviewed at least at the end of each reporting period and adjusted
if necessary.
LEASES
The Group assesses whether a contract is, or contains a lease at inception of the contract. A lease conveys the right to
direct the use and obtain substantially all of the economic benefits of an identified asset for a period of time in exchange
for consideration.
GOVERNANCE
lease term. The lease term includes the noncancellable period of lease together with any extension or termination options
that are reasonably certain to be exercised.
Payments associated with short-term leases and all leases of low-value assets (under £5,000) are recognised on a straight-
line basis as an expense in profit or loss. Short-term leases are leases with a lease term of 12 months or less. Low-value assets
comprise largely small items of office equipment.
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
indicate that the carrying amount may not be recoverable. Any impairment losses are included within ‘net operating
expenses’ in the consolidated income statement.
In addition, goodwill is not subject to amortisation but is tested at least annually for impairment. An impairment loss is
recognised for the amount by which the asset’s carrying amount exceeds its recoverable amount, the latter being the
higher of the asset’s fair value less costs to sell and value in use. Value in use calculations are performed using cash flow
projections, discounted at a pre-tax rate which reflects the asset specific risks and the time value of money. Impairment
losses are recognised on goodwill within the cash generating unit.
Non-financial assets, other than goodwill, which have previously been impaired, are reviewed for possible reversal of the
impairment at each reporting date. Impairment of inventories are considered separately. Impairment losses are recognised
against goodwill within the cash generating units before non-financial assets are impaired.
INVENTORIES
Inventories are stated at the lower of cost and net realisable value. Cost comprises expenditure incurred in bringing
inventories to their present location and condition. Net realisable value represents the estimated selling price less all
estimated costs of completion and costs to be incurred in marketing, selling and distribution. Used vehicles are carried
at the lower of cost or fair value less costs to sell, generally based on external market data available for used vehicles.
Vehicles held on consignment are included within inventories as the Group is considered to have the risks and rewards
of ownership. The corresponding liability is included within ‘trade and other payables’.
Inventory can be held on deferred payment terms. All costs associated with this deferral are expensed in the period
in which they are incurred.
An inventory provision is recognised in situations where net realisable value is likely to be less than cost (such as
obsolescence, deterioration, fall in selling price). When calculating the provision, management considers the nature and
condition of the inventory, as well as applying assumptions around anticipated saleability, determined on conditions that
exist at the end of the reporting period. With the exception of parts, generally net realisable value adjustments are applied
on an item-by-item basis.
TRADE RECEIVABLES
Trade receivables are amounts due from customers for goods sold or services performed in the ordinary course of business.
These are recognised as current assets if collection is due in one year or less. If collection is due in over a year, they are
presented as non-current assets.
Trade receivables are recognised initially at fair value and subsequently measured at amortised cost using the effective
interest method, less provision for impairment. A provision for impairment is established based on an expected credit loss
model under IFRS 9 Financial Instruments. The amount of the provision is the difference between the asset’s carrying amount
and the expected value of the amounts to be received.
The provision for impairment of receivables is based on lifetime expected credit losses. Lifetime expected credit losses are
calculated by assessing historic credit loss experience, adjusted for factors specific to the receivable and company. The
amount of the loss is recognised in the consolidated income statement within ‘net operating expenses’. When a trade
receivable is not collectible, it is written off against the allowance account for trade receivables. Subsequent recoveries
of amounts previously written off are credited against ‘net operating expenses’ in the consolidated income statement.
TRADE PAYABLES
Trade payables are obligations to pay for goods or services that have been acquired in the ordinary course of business.
These are classified as current liabilities if payment is due in one year or less. If payment is due at a later date, they are
presented as non-current liabilities.
Trade payables are recognised initially at fair value and subsequently measured at amortised cost using the effective
interest method.
Trade payables include the liability for vehicles held on consignment, with the corresponding asset included within
inventories.
BORROWINGS
Borrowings are recognised initially at fair value, net of transaction costs incurred, and are subsequently stated at amortised
cost. Any difference between the proceeds (net of transaction costs) and the redemption value is recognised in the
consolidated income statement over the period of the borrowings, using the effective interest method.
PROVISIONS
Provisions are recognised when the Group has a present obligation in respect of a past event, when it is more likely than
not that an outflow of resources will be required to settle the obligation and where the amount can be reliably estimated.
Provisions are discounted when the time value of money is considered to be material, using an appropriate risk-free rate
on government bonds.
LITIGATION PROVISION
A litigation provision is recognised when a litigation case is outstanding at the end of the reporting period and there is
a likelihood that the legal claim will be settled.
RESTRUCTURING PROVISION
A restructuring provision is recognised when a detailed formal plan for the restructuring has been developed and a valid
expectation has been raised in those affected that it will carry out the restructuring by starting to implement the plan or
GOVERNANCE
announcing its main features to those affected by it. The measurement of a restructuring provision includes only the direct
expenditures arising from the restructuring which are those amounts that are both necessarily entailed by the restructuring
and not associated with ongoing activities of the Group.
SEGMENTAL REPORTING
Segment information is reported in accordance with IFRS 8 Operating Segments, which requires segmental reporting to
be presented on the same basis as the internal management reporting. The Group’s operating segments are countries or
groups of countries and the market channels, Distribution and Retail. These operating segments are then aggregated into
reporting segments to combine those with similar characteristics. The accounting policies of the reportable segments are
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
the same as the Group’s accounting policies described in this note. Comparative amounts have been reclassified as
explained in note 1.
FINANCIAL INSTRUMENTS
The Group classifies its financial assets in the following categories: measured at amortised cost; measured at fair value
through profit and loss; and measured at fair value through other comprehensive income. Classification and subsequent
remeasurement depends on the Group’s business model for managing the financial asset and its cash flow characteristics.
Assets that are held for collection of contractual cash flows, where those cash flows represent solely payments of principal
and interest, are measured at amortised cost.
Measured at amortised cost includes non-derivative financial assets and liabilities with fixed or determinable payments that
are not quoted in an active market. Financial assets are included in current assets, except where the maturity date is more
than 12 months after the end of the reporting period. They are initially recorded at fair value and subsequently recorded at
amortised cost. Financial liabilities are included in current liabilities, except where the maturity date is more than 12 months
after the end of the reporting period.
Measured at fair value through profit and loss includes derivative financial assets and liabilities, which are further explained
below. They are classified according to maturity date, within current and non-current assets and liabilities respectively.
Measured at fair value through other comprehensive income includes certain financial assets at fair value such as bonds
and equity investments. These financial assets are included in current assets and liabilities, except where the maturity date
is more than 12 months after the end of the reporting period. Financial assets at fair value through other comprehensive
income are classified as non-current assets unless management intends to dispose of them within 12 months of the end
of the reporting period and are held at fair value.
OFFSETTING
Netting in the consolidated statement of financial position only occurs to the extent that there is the legal ability and
intention to settle net. As such, bank overdrafts are presented in current liabilities to the extent that there is no intention
to offset with the cash balance.
SHARE CAPITAL
Ordinary shares are classified as equity. Where the Group purchases the Group’s equity share capital (treasury shares),
the consideration paid is deducted from shareholders’ equity until the shares are cancelled, reissued or disposed of.
Where such shares are subsequently sold or reissued, any consideration received is included in shareholders’ equity.
DIVIDENDS
Final dividends proposed by the Board of Directors and unpaid at the year-end are not recognised in the consolidated
financial statements until they have been approved by the shareholders at the Annual General Meeting. Interim dividends
are recognised when they are paid.
GOVERNANCE
These assumptions are subject to a review on an annual basis and are determined in conjunction with an external actuary.
The use of different assumptions could have a material effect on the value of the relevant liabilities and could result in a
material change to amounts recognised in the income statement over time. Key assumptions and sensitivities for post-
employment benefit obligations are disclosed in note 5.
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
are only included in the lease term if the lease is reasonably certain to be extended (or not terminated).
The Group has several retail, distribution and office property lease contracts that include extension and termination options.
The Group applies judgement in evaluating whether it is reasonably certain whether or not to exercise the option to renew
or terminate the lease. All relevant factors are considered that create an economic incentive for it to exercise either the
renewal or termination, including: whether there are significant penalties to terminate (or not extend); whether any
leasehold improvements are expected to have a significant remaining value; historical lease durations; the importance of
the underlying asset to the Group’s operations; and the costs and business disruption required to replace the leased asset.
The assessment is reviewed if a significant event or a significant change in circumstances occurs which affects this
assessment and that is within the control of the lessee. Refer to note 13 for additional disclosures relating to leases.
ADJUSTING ITEMS
The Directors believe that adjusted profit and earnings per share measures provide additional useful information to
shareholders on the performance of the business. These measures are consistent with how business performance is
measured internally by the Board and Executive Committee. The operating profit before adjusting items and profit before
tax and adjusting items measures are not recognised profit measures under IFRS and may not be directly comparable with
such profit measures used by other companies. The classification of adjusting items requires significant management
judgement after considering the nature and intentions of a transaction. The Group’s definitions of adjusting items are
outlined within the Group accounting policies and note 2 provides further details on current year adjusting items and their
adherence to Group policy.
1 SEGMENTAL ANALYSIS
The Group has four reportable segments which have been identified based on the operating segments of the Group that
are regularly reviewed by the chief operating decision-maker, which has been determined to be the Executive Committee,
in order to assess performance and allocate resources. Operating segments are then aggregated into reporting segments
to combine those with similar economic characteristics.
In 2022, following the acquisition of the Derco Group based in the Americas region, the distribution business based in Africa
is now reported and reviewed alongside existing distribution businesses in Europe, forming a combined segment of Europe
& Africa.
The Group reports the performance of its reporting segments after the allocation of central costs. These represent costs
of Group functions.
The following summary describes the operations of each of the Group’s reportable segments:
Distribution APAC Exclusive distribution, sales and marketing activities of New Vehicles and Parts.
Europe & Africa
Sale of New and Used Vehicles together with logistics services where the Group
Americas
may also be the exclusive distributor, alongside associated Aftersales activities
of service, body shop repairs and parts sales.
Retail Sale of New and Used Vehicles, together with associated Aftersales activities
of service, body shop repairs and parts sales in the UK and Europe.
Distribution
Europe & Total
APAC Africa Americas Distribution Retail Total
2022 £m £m £m £m £m £m
Revenue
Total revenue 2,341.5 2,047.5 1,479.8 5,868.8 2,263.9 8,132.7
Results
Adjusted operating profit 163.1 90.0 110.2 363.3 47.5 410.8
Operating adjusting items (10.5)
Operating profit from continuing operations 400.3
Share of loss after tax of joint ventures and associates (0.6)
Profit before finance and tax 399.7
Finance income 21.6
Finance costs (88.2)
Profit before tax from continuing operations 333.1
Tax (98.2)
Profit for the year from continuing operations 234.9
The Group’s reported segments are based on the location of the Group’s assets. Revenue earned from sales is disclosed by
origin and is not materially different from revenue by destination. Revenue is further analysed as follows:
2022 £m
UK 2,029.1
Australia 1,136.4
Rest of the world 4,967.2
Group 8,132.7
The Group’s non-current assets by location comprise intangible assets, property, plant and equipment, right-of-use assets,
joint ventures and associates, and are analysed as follows:
2022 £m
UK 298.9
Rest of the world 2,053.3
Group 2,352.2
GOVERNANCE
Segment assets include net inventory, receivables and derivative assets. Segment liabilities include payables, provisions
and derivative liabilities.
Distribution
Europe & Total
APAC Africa Americas Distribution Retail Total
2022 from continuing operations £m £m £m £m £m £m
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
– Property, plant and equipment 8.0 6.7 7.9 22.6 9.9 32.5
– Leased vehicles, rental machinery and equipment 4.2 3.5 0.2 7.9 – 7.9
– Right-of-use assets 28.7 6.3 13.0 48.0 7.1 55.1
Amortisation of intangible assets 8.4 6.0 6.6 21.0 2.1 23.1
(Reversal of impairment)/impairment of property, plant
and equipment (0.5) – 0.4 (0.1) (9.0) (9.1)
Impairment of right-of-use assets 0.9 0.2 – 1.1 0.8 1.9
Net provisions charged to the consolidated income
statement 21.9 20.3 10.3 52.5 6.4 58.9
Net provisions include inventory, trade receivables impairment and other liability provisions.
Revenue
Total revenue 2,146.9 1,598.6 926.2 4,671.7 2,229.2 6,900.9
Results
Adjusted operating profit 127.8 62.6 55.6 246.0 35.4 281.4
Operating adjusting items (100.1)
Operating profit from continuing operations 181.3
Share of profit after tax of joint ventures and associates –
Profit before finance and tax 181.3
Finance income 11.2
Finance costs (43.7)
Profit before tax from continuing operations 148.8
Tax (64.6)
Profit for the year from continuing operations 84.2
The Group’s reported segments are based on the location of the Group’s assets. Revenue earned from sales is disclosed
by origin and is not materially different from revenue by destination. Revenue is further analysed as follows:
2021 £m
UK 1,894.3
Australia 1,003.6
Rest of the world 4,003.0
Group 6,900.9
The Group’s non-current assets by location comprise intangible assets, property, plant and equipment, right-of-use assets,
joint ventures and associates, and are analysed as follows:
2021 £m
UK 275.1
Rest of the world 933.3
Group 1,208.4
Distribution
Europe & Total
APAC Africa Americas Distribution Retail Total
2021 £m £m £m £m £m £m
Segment assets include net inventory, receivables and derivative assets. Segment liabilities include payables, provisions
and derivative liabilities.
GOVERNANCE
– Property, plant and equipment 7.7 5.3 5.5 18.5 8.7 27.2
– Leased vehicles, rental machinery and equipment 2.0 0.2 0.3 2.5 – 2.5
– Right-of-use assets 25.3 5.6 8.3 39.2 8.1 47.3
Amortisation of intangible assets 11.5 13.2 3.3 28.0 4.0 32.0
Impairment of goodwill – – 12.9 12.9 – 12.9
Reversal of impairment of distribution agreements – – (12.9) (12.9) – (12.9)
Impairment of other intangible assets 0.1 – 0.1 0.2 – 0.2
Impairment/(reversal of impairment) of property, plant
and equipment – 0.4 0.3 0.7 (2.6) (1.9)
Impairment of right-of-use assets 0.3 0.6 – 0.9 0.2 1.1
Impairment of assets held for sale – – 1.5 1.5 – 1.5
Net provisions charged to the consolidated income
statement 10.7 4.7 6.3 21.7 3.4 25.1
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
Net provisions include inventory, trade receivables impairment and other liability provisions.
2 ADJUSTING ITEMS
2022 2021
From continuing operations £m £m
Other asset impairment reversals (see notes 12 and 13) 9.9 2.9
Disposal of businesses (see note 29) 1.4 (67.3)
Restructuring costs – (12.2)
Acquisition and integration costs (41.7) (3.4)
Accelerated amortisation (SaaS) (12.6) (20.1)
Other income 12.8 –
Gain on pension indexation 19.7 –
Total adjusting items in operating profit (10.5) (100.1)
Adjusting items in finance costs:
Net monetary loss on hyperinflation (29.6) –
Total adjusting items before tax (40.1) (100.1)
Tax on adjusting items (see note 8) (0.9) (1.5)
Total adjusting items (41.0) (101.6)
Other asset impairment reversals of £9.9m primarily relate to property, plant & equipment and right-of-use assets in the
UK and Australia. They have been reported as an adjusting item which is consistent with the reporting of the original
impairment charge.
During the year operating costs of £41.7m have been incurred in connection with the acquisition and integration of
businesses. These costs have been reported as adjusting items to better reflect the underlying performance of the business.
These primarily relate to the acquisitions of the Derco group and ITC/Simpson Motors in the Caribbean. For more details
on acquisitions made during the year, please refer to note 29.
In 2021, the Group started to migrate the Group’s existing ERP applications to a cloud-based solution. This was a strategic
decision to consolidate and upgrade the systems, improve speed and performance and facilitate centralised support
following the transformation of the Information Technology organisational structure. The new solution was determined to
be Software as a Service (SaaS) and therefore the existing software assets no longer fall to be treated as an asset under
IAS 38 Intangible Assets, once the migration to the new solution has occurred. Consequently, the useful life of the existing
assets was reassessed and the impact accounted for prospectively as a change in an estimate. This change resulted in
a significant increase in the amortisation recognised for software costs. Accordingly, the incremental amortisation of
£12.6m (2021: £20.1m) has been disclosed as an adjusting item.
2022 2021
From continuing operations £m £m
Sale of goods includes the sale of new and used vehicles and the sale of parts where they are sold directly to the customer.
Provision of services includes financial services, as well as labour and parts provided in servicing vehicles.
b. Analysis of net operating expenses
Net operating Net operating
expenses expenses before Net operating
before Adjusting Net operating adjusting items expenses
adjusting items items expenses 2021 Adjusting items 2021
2022 2022 2022 (restated)1 2021 (restated)1
From continuing operations £m £m £m £m £m £m
1. The 2021 comparative figures above for distribution costs and administrative expenses contains a reclassification restatement of £29.5m between the line items
resulting from a prior year error.
GOVERNANCE
Reversal of impairment of property, plant and equipment (9.1) (1.9)
Impairment of right-of-use assets 1.9 1.1
Impairment of assets held for sale – 1.5
Impairment of trade receivables 6.1 2.6
Profit on sale of property, plant and equipment and intangibles (2.1) (5.0)
Profit on the sale of property, plant and equipment in 2022 mainly relates to the sale of surplus assets in APAC (2021: profit
on sale of property, plant and equipment of surplus assets in the UK and APAC).
d. Auditor’s remuneration
During the year the Group (including its overseas subsidiaries) obtained the following services from the Group’s auditor
at costs as detailed below:
2022 2021
£m £m
Fees payable to the Company’s auditor and its associates for the audit of the parent
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
company and the consolidated financial statements 2.7 0.6
Fees payable to the Company’s auditor and its associates for other services:
– The audit of the Company’s subsidiaries 4.6 2.9
– Audit related assurance services 5.4 0.1
– All other services 0.8 0.1
Total fees payable to the Company’s auditor 13.5 3.7
Audit fees – firms other than the Company’s auditor 0.1 0.1
e. Staff costs
2021
2022 (restated)1
From continuing operations £m £m
1. The 2021 comparative figures above have been restated due to an error in classification.
Other pension costs correspond to the current and past service cost and contributions to the defined contribution schemes
(see note 5). Included in other pension costs is a £19.7m past service credit as a result of changing the basis of indexation for
the Inchcape Motors Pension Scheme from the Retail Prices Index (RPI) to the Consumer Prices Index (CPI).
Information on Directors’ emoluments and interests which forms part of these audited consolidated financial statements
is given in the Directors’ Report on Remuneration which can be found on pages 96 to 116 of this document. Information
on compensation of key management personnel is set out in note 32b.
Following the acquisition of the Derco group, total employees of the Group have increased by approximately 4,800
employees.
Weighted
average Performance Save As You Other
2022 exercise price* Share Plan Earn Plan Share Plans
GOVERNANCE
Lapsed £5.17 (1,361,774) (262,301) (327,664)
Outstanding at 31 December £4.92 5,107,941 2,056,778 1,370,709
Exercisable at 31 December £4.59 166,168 45,291 11,895
Weighted
average Performance Save As You Other
2021 exercise price* Share Plan Earn Plan Share Plans
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
* The weighted average exercise price excludes nil cost awards made under the Performance Share Plan and Other Share Plans.
The weighted average remaining contractual life for the awards outstanding at 31 December 2022 is 1.4 years (2021:
2.3 years).
The range of exercise prices for options outstanding at the end of the year was £3.77 to £7.31 (2021: £3.77 to £7.31). See note
25 for further details.
The fair value of options granted under the Save As You Earn Plan and Other Share Plans is estimated as at the date of grant
using a Black-Scholes option pricing model, taking into account the terms and conditions upon which the options were
granted. The fair value of nil cost awards granted under the Performance Share Plan and Other Share Plans is the market
value of the related shares at the time of grant. The following table lists the main inputs to the model for awards granted
during the years ended 31 December 2022 and 31 December 2021:
Performance Share Plan Save As You Earn Plan Other Share Plans
2022 2021 2022 2021 2022 2021
* The weighted average exercise price excludes nil cost awards made under the Performance Share Plan and Other Share Plans.
No options were granted under the Executive Share Option Plan in 2022 or 2021.
The expected life and volatility of the options are based upon historical data.
GOVERNANCE
United Kingdom in this note. The latest triennial actuarial valuation for this scheme was carried out at 31 March 2018 and
determined in accordance with the advice of the Scheme Actuary based on the projected unit credit method. The
actuarial valuation determined that the duration of the liabilities was approximately 12 years and that the scheme was
approximately 77% funded on a prudent funding basis. To make good the funding deficit of £16.2m, it has been agreed
that deficit contributions of £1.5m p.a. would be paid by means of an annual lump sum for 10 years, ending with the
payment due in July 2029. The first payment at this new level was paid on 1 July 2020. Additional contributions in respect
of expenses of £0.2m per annum will also be made. The 31 March 2021 triennial actuarial valuation is currently ongoing.
b. Overseas schemes
There are a number of smaller defined benefit schemes overseas, the most significant being the Inchcape Motors Limited
Retirement Scheme in Hong Kong. In general, these schemes offer a lump sum on retirement with no further obligation to
the employee and assets are held in trust in separately administered funds. These schemes are typically subject to triennial
valuations. The overseas defined contribution schemes are principally linked to local statutory arrangements.
c. Defined contribution plans
The total expense recognised in the consolidated income statement is £13.2m (2021: £11.3m). There are no outstanding
contributions at 31 December 2022 (2021: nil).
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
d. Defined benefit plans
As the Group’s principal defined benefit schemes are in the UK, these have been reported separately from the overseas
schemes. For the purposes of reporting, actuarial updates have been obtained for the Group’s material schemes and these
updates are reflected in the amounts reported in the following tables.
e. Recognition of Pension Surplus ‘IFRIC 14’
The Group is not required to recognise any additional liabilities in relation to funding plans, or limit the recognition of any
surpluses, as the Group retains an unconditional right to any future economic benefits available by way of future refunds
or reduction in contributions.
The principal weighted average assumptions used by the actuaries were:
Assumptions regarding future mortality experience are set based on published statistics and experience. For the UK
schemes, the average life expectancy of a pensioner retiring at age 65 is 22.7 years (2021: 22.6 years) for current pensioners
and 24.0 years (2021: 23.9 years) for current non pensioners. Most of the overseas schemes only offer a lump sum on
retirement and therefore mortality assumptions are not applicable.
The amounts recognised in the consolidated statement of comprehensive income are as follows:
Actuarial (losses)/gains on
liabilities:
– Experience (losses)/gains (19.9) (3.7) 1.7 0.7 (18.2) (3.0)
– Changes in demographic
assumptions 0.2 (6.5) – – 0.2 (6.5)
– Changes in financial
assumptions 312.3 38.6 1.7 1.7 314.0 40.3
Actuarial (losses)/gains on assets:
– Experience (losses)/gains (302.4) 26.7 (5.7) 0.7 (308.1) 27.4
(9.8) 55.1 (2.3) 3.1 (12.1) 58.2
GOVERNANCE
At 31 December 95.7 82.0 (2.6) 0.2 93.1 82.2
Changes in the present value of the defined benefit obligation are as follows:
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
– Changes in financial
assumptions 312.3 38.6 1.7 1.7 314.0 40.3
Benefits paid 32.8 35.5 4.9 4.8 37.7 40.3
Plan settlements – – – 0.3 – 0.3
Effect of foreign exchange rate
changes – – (4.1) 0.1 (4.1) 0.1
At 31 December (571.9) (898.5) (35.9) (37.9) (607.8) (936.4)
Changes in the fair value of the defined benefit asset are as follows:
The investments shown as quoted equities and bonds are held through funds where the underlying investments of the fund
are quoted. Investment funds and other assets include equities, bonds, property, derivatives and liability driven investments.
Virtually all the equities and bonds held within the investment funds have prices in active markets. Derivatives, property and
liability driven investments can be classified as level 2 instruments.
The schemes had no directly held employer related investment during the reporting period. The schemes’ investment
managers may potentially hold a small investment in Inchcape plc either through index weightings or stock selection
(less than 0.5% of their respective fund values).
The following disclosures relate to the Group’s defined benefit plans only.
f. Risk management
Asset volatility
Scheme liabilities are calculated on a discounted basis using a discount rate which is set with reference to corporate
bond yields. If scheme assets underperform this yield, then this will create a deficit. The combined schemes hold assets as
defensive assets (liability driven investment solutions, absolute return bonds and annuity policies) which mitigate significant
changes in yields, and active monitoring plans are in place to identify opportunities to increase the proportion of such
assets further when economically possible.
As the schemes mature, the Trustee reduces investment risk by increasing the allocation to defensive assets, which are
designed to better match scheme liabilities. However, the Trustee believes that due to the long-term nature of the scheme
liabilities, a level of continuing growth asset investment is an appropriate element of the long-term investment strategy.
Inflation risk
The majority of the Group’s defined benefit obligations are linked to inflation. Higher inflation will lead to higher liabilities,
although in the majority of cases there are caps on the level of inflationary increases to be applied to pension obligations.
The Group’s investment strategy across the schemes is to mitigate inflation risk through holding inflation-linked assets.
Life expectancy
Where relevant, the plans’ obligations are to provide a pension for the life of the member, so realised increases in life
expectancy will result in an increase in the plans’ benefit payments. Future mortality rates cannot be predicted with
certainty. All of the schemes conduct scheme-specific mortality investigations annually, to ensure the Group has a
clear understanding of any potential increase in liability due to pensioners living for longer than assumed.
g. Sensitivity analysis
The disclosures above are dependent on the assumptions used. The table below demonstrates the sensitivity of the defined
benefit obligation to changes in the assumptions used for the UK schemes. Changes in assumptions have an immaterial
effect on the overseas schemes.
Impact on the defined benefit obligation
United Kingdom
2022 2021
£m £m
The above analysis is based on a change in an assumption while holding all other assumptions constant. In practice, this is
unlikely to occur, and changes in some of the assumptions may be correlated. The above variances have been used as
they are believed to be reasonably possible fluctuations.
6 FINANCE INCOME
GOVERNANCE
2022 2021
From continuing operations £m £m
7 FINANCE COSTS
2022 2021
From continuing operations £m £m
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
Stock holding interest (see note 21) 18.8 14.1
Net monetary loss on hyperinflation 29.6 –
Other finance costs 11.5 5.8
Total finance costs 88.2 43.7
In 2022, in accordance with IAS 29 Financial Reporting in Hyperinflationary Economies, the results and financial position
of the Group’s operations in Ethiopia have been restated to the purchasing power or inflationary measuring unit current
at 31 December 2022. Therefore, finance costs include the loss on hyperinflation in respect of monetary items, which is
also treated as an adjusting item.
8 TAX
This note only provides information about corporate income taxes under IFRS. The Group operates in over 40 markets
and territories across the world. The Group pays and collects many different taxes in addition to corporate income taxes
including: payroll taxes, value added and sales taxes, property taxes, product-specific taxes and environmental taxes.
Such taxes borne by the Group are included in profit before tax.
2022 2021
From continuing operations £m £m
Current tax:
– UK corporation tax – 0.1
– Overseas tax 110.5 74.5
110.5 74.6
Adjustments to prior year liabilities:
– UK – –
– Overseas (5.5) (6.1)
Current tax 105.0 68.5
Deferred tax (see note 17) (6.8) (3.9)
Total tax charge 98.2 64.6
Details of the adjusting items for the year can be found in note 2. Not all of the adjusting items will be taxable or deductible
for tax purposes. Therefore, the tax charge on adjusting items represents the total of the current and deferred tax on only
those elements that are assessed as taxable or deductible.
a. Factors affecting the tax expense for the year
The effective tax rate for the year is 29.5% (2021: 43.4%). The effective tax rate on adjusted profit before tax is 26.1% (2021:
25.4%). The weighted average tax rate is 22.7% (2021: 27.1%). The weighted average tax rate comprises the average statutory
rates across the Group, weighted in proportion to accounting profits and losses before tax. The weighted average tax rate
is higher than the UK corporation tax rate primarily due to the geographic profile of the Group.
During the year, there was a net profit generated by the legal entities within the UK group and thus brought forward losses
were utilised. However, given current forecasts, no net deferred tax asset is recognised for the remaining losses and other
temporary differences within the UK.
The total tax charge in the current year also includes the impact of IAS 29 Financial Reporting for Hyperinflationary
Economies in relation to the financial position of Ethiopia (see note 2).
The table below explains the differences between the expected tax charge at the weighted average tax rate and the
Group’s total tax charge.
2022 2021
From continuing operations £m £m
GOVERNANCE
Rules relating to global minimum taxation, expected to apply from 2024, which will impact the future taxation of large
multinationals such as Inchcape. The Group will continue to monitor the development and future implementation of these
rules. However, at this time and as currently drafted, they are not expected to have a material impact on the Group.
The Group has published its approach to tax on www.inchcape.com covering its tax strategy and governance framework
in accordance with Schedule 19 Finance Act 2016.
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
Adjusted earnings from continuing operations 270.9 180.9
2022 2021
number number
Weighted average number of fully paid ordinary shares in issue during the year 377,146,960 391,136,363
Weighted average number of fully paid ordinary shares in issue during the year:
– Held by the Inchcape Employee Trust (749,751) (553,006)
Weighted average number of fully paid ordinary shares for the purposes of basic EPS 376,397,209 390,583,357
Dilutive effect of potential ordinary shares 44,733,701 4,506,362
Adjusted weighted average number of fully paid ordinary shares in issue during the year for
the purposes of diluted EPS 421,130,910 395,089,719
Basic earnings/(loss) per share is calculated by dividing the Basic earnings/(loss) for the year by the weighted average
number of fully paid ordinary shares in issue during the year, less those shares held by the Inchcape Employee Trust and
repurchased as part of the share buyback programme.
10 DIVIDENDS
The following dividends were paid by the Group:
2022 2021
£m £m
Interim dividend for the six months ended 30 June 2022 of 7.5p per share (30 June 2021: 6.4p
per share) 28.0 25.1
Final dividend for the year ended 31 December 2021 of 16.1p per share (31 December 2020:
6.9p per share) 60.7 27.1
88.7 52.2
A final proposed dividend for the year ended 31 December 2022 of 21.3p per share is subject to approval by shareholders
at the Annual General Meeting and has not been included as a liability as at 31 December 2022.
The Group has sufficient distributable reserves to pay dividends to its ultimate shareholders. Distributable reserves are
calculated on an individual legal entity basis and the ultimate parent company, Inchcape plc, currently has adequate
levels of realised profits within its retained earnings to support dividend payments. At 31 December 2022, Inchcape plc’s
company-only distributable reserves were £520.9m. On an annual basis, the distributable reserve levels of the Group’s
subsidiary undertakings are reviewed and dividends paid up to Inchcape plc where it is appropriate to do so.
GOVERNANCE
Effect of foreign exchange rate changes (12.5) (24.2) (4.4) (41.1)
At 1 January 2022 552.1 257.0 216.6 1,025.7
Businesses acquired (see note 29) 139.9 592.9 25.6 758.4
Business sold (83.7) – (28.6) (112.3)
Additions – – 4.3 4.3
Disposals – – (1.3) (1.3)
Retirements – – (94.7) (94.7)
Effect of foreign exchange rate changes 39.4 28.0 10.3 77.7
At 31 December 2022 647.7 877.9 132.2 1,657.8
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
Impairment (charge)/reversal for the year (12.9) 12.9 (0.2) (0.2)
Business sold 30.6 – 4.1 34.7
Disposals – – 2.4 2.4
Reclassifications – – 0.4 0.4
Retirements – – 2.2 2.2
Effect of foreign exchange rate changes 5.0 (0.1) 3.0 7.9
At 1 January 2022 (435.8) (18.0) (177.8) (631.6)
Amortisation charge for the year (note 3) – – (23.1) (23.1)
Business sold 83.7 – 27.5 111.2
Disposals – – 0.9 0.9
Retirements – – 94.7 94.7
Effect of foreign exchange rate changes (25.3) (2.2) (8.4) (35.9)
At 31 December 2022 (377.4) (20.2) (86.2) (483.8)
Net book value at 31 December 2022 270.3 857.7 46.0 1,174.0
Net book value at 31 December 2021 116.3 239.0 38.8 394.1
1. Indefinite-life intangible assets comprise distribution agreements and acquired brands for which there is no foreseeable limit to the period over which they are
expected to generate net cash inflows.
2. Included in computer software and other is acquired customer relationships.
There were no impairment charges or reversals during the year (2021: £0.2m). At 31 December 2022, computer software
under development was £6.2m (2021: £17.5m).
Goodwill and indefinite-life intangible assets
Goodwill acquired in a business combination has been allocated to the cash generating units (CGUs) or group of CGUs
(hereafter collectively referred to as ‘CGU groups’) that are expected to benefit from the synergies associated with that
business combination.
Indefinite-life intangible assets, principally distribution agreements acquired in a business combination, are also allocated
to the CGU groups that are expected to benefit from the cash flows associated with the relevant agreements.
2022 2021
Goodwill CGU group £m £m
1. From 2022, the goodwill arising from the acquisition of the Ditec business has been included in this CGU group (see note 29a).
2022 2021
Distribution agreements CGU group £m £m
1. From 2022, the distribution rights to Porsche, Volvo and Jaguar Land Rover that were acquired as part of the acquisition of the Ditec business have been
included in this CGU group (see note 29a).
In accordance with the Group’s accounting policy, goodwill and other indefinite-life intangible assets are tested at
least annually for impairment and whenever events or circumstances indicate that the carrying amount may not be
recoverable. Impairment tests were performed for all CGU groups during the year ended 31 December 2022. The
recoverable amounts of the Group’s Americas – Derco CGU groups, including its identified assets and liabilities, were
determined based on fair value less costs of disposal due to the acquisition date coinciding with the reporting date.
The recoverable amounts of all CGU groups were determined based on the higher of the fair value less costs to sell and
value in use calculations. The recoverable amount is determined firstly through value in use calculations. Where this is
insufficient to cover the carrying value of the relevant asset being tested, fair value less costs to sell is also determined.
Site-based assets (property, plant and equipment and right-of-use assets) are first tested for impairment individually before
being included in the impairment tests as a component of the carrying value of a CGU group. If the carrying amount of
a CGU group exceeds its recoverable amount, an impairment loss is recognised and allocated between the assets of the
CGU group to reduce the carrying amount. This allocation is initially applied to the carrying amount of goodwill allocated
to the CGU group. If a further impairment charge still remains, then this is allocated to other assets in the CGU group on
a pro-rata basis.
The value in use calculations mainly use cash flow projections based on five-year financial projections prepared by
management. The key assumptions for these projections are those relating to volumes, revenue, gross margins, overheads,
the level of working capital required to support trading and capital expenditure.
Forecast revenue is based on past experience and expectations for near-term growth in the relevant markets. Key
assumptions used to determine revenue are expectations of market size, represented by Total Industry Volume (“TIV”), Units
in Operation (“UIO”) and market share, based on external sources where appropriate. Operating profits are forecast based
on historical experience of gross and operating margins, adjusted for the impact of changes to product mix and cost-
saving initiatives that had been implemented at the reporting date. Cash flows are forecast based on operating profit
adjusted for the level of working capital required to support trading and capital expenditure. The assumptions used in
the value in use calculations are based on past experience, recent trading and forecasts of operational performance
in the relevant markets including expectations about continuing relationships with key brand partners.
GOVERNANCE
Key inputs include benchmark risk free rates, inflation differentials, equity risk premium, country risk premium and a risk
adjustment (beta) calculated by reference to comparable companies with similar retail and distribution operations.
The Group applies post-tax discount rates to post-tax cash flows as the valuation calculated using this method closely
approximates to applying pre-tax discount rates to pre-tax cash flows.
Key assumptions used
Pre-tax discount rates and long-term discount rates used in the value in use calculations for each of the Group’s significant
CGU groups are shown below:
Goodwill:
Americas –
Hino/Subaru/ Central
Americas – JLR/Volvo/ America –
2022 Baltics Daimler Porsche Suzuki
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
Central
Americas – Americas – America –
2021 Baltics Daimler Hino/Subaru Suzuki
Americas – Central
Baltics – Americas – Americas – Americas – JLR/Volvo/ America –
2022 BMW Daimler Hino Subaru Porsche Suzuki Caribbean
Pre-tax discount rate (%) 8.1 15.8 13.4 12.2 11.8 14.1 13.6
Long-term growth rate (%) 1.9 3.2 3.1 3.0 3.0 2.6 3.0
Americas – Central
Baltics – Americas – Americas – Americas – JLR/Volvo/ America –
2021 BMW Daimler Hino Subaru Porsche Suzuki Caribbean
Impairment Impairment
Increase/(decrease) in charge credit
assumption £m £m
Other CGUs
The Group’s value in use calculations are sensitive to a change in the key assumptions used. However, with the exception of
the Group’s business in the Baltics, a reasonably possible change in a key assumption will not cause a material impairment
of goodwill or indefinite-life intangible assets in any of the other CGU groups. The value in use calculations for the distribution
agreement in the Baltics currently exceed the carrying value by 25%. A 1.1% increase in the discount rate or a 2.0% reduction
in the long-term growth rate, while holding all other assumptions constant, would eliminate this headroom.
GOVERNANCE
Retirement of fully depreciated assets (6.0) (1.2) (7.2) – (7.2)
Reclassified to assets held for sale (1.4) (0.4) (1.8) – (1.8)
Effect of foreign exchange rate changes (17.7) (7.5) (25.2) 0.2 (25.0)
At 1 January 2022 675.1 254.1 929.2 22.3 951.5
Opening balance hyperinflation adjustment 20.3 13.9 34.2 – 34.2
Businesses acquired (see note 29) 82.7 33.8 116.5 59.6 176.1
Businesses sold (see note 29) (63.4) (42.5) (105.9) – (105.9)
Additions 17.2 46.4 63.6 12.9 76.5
Disposals (8.8) (25.6) (34.4) – (34.4)
Transferred to/from inventory – – – (9.7) (9.7)
Retirement of fully depreciated assets – (2.7) (2.7) – (2.7)
Reclassified to/from assets held for sale (19.5) (2.6) (22.1) – (22.1)
Effect of foreign exchange rate changes 41.1 24.4 65.5 2.8 68.3
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
At 31 December 2022 744.7 299.2 1,043.9 87.9 1,131.8
2022 2021
£m £m
Land and buildings include properties with a net book value of £5.3m (2021: £4.3m) that are let to third parties on a short-
term basis.
Impairment of computer software, property, plant and equipment and right-of-use assets
Computer software, property, plant and equipment and right-of-use assets are reviewed for impairment if events or
circumstances indicate that the carrying value may not be recoverable. When an impairment review is carried out, the
recoverable value is determined based on the higher of value in use calculations, which require estimates to be made of
future cash flows, or fair value less costs of disposal. Impairment triggers were identified in a limited number of markets and
tests for impairment were carried out, where appropriate. As part of the assessment, the Group also assessed whether there
was any indication that previously recognised impairment losses for an asset no longer exists or may have decreased which
would result in an impairment reversal being recognised.
The approach to test computer software, property, plant and equipment and right-of-use assets for impairment was
consistent with the approach used to test goodwill and other indefinite-life intangible assets. The value in use calculations
use cash flow projections based on five-year financial forecasts prepared by management. The key assumptions for these
forecasts are those relating to volumes, revenue, gross margins, overheads, the level of working capital required to support
trading and capital expenditure. Where the value in use calculations did not support the carrying value of an asset, an
estimate for fair value less costs of disposal was determined by obtaining property valuations for the relevant locations.
The results of the testing indicated that net impairment reversals totalling £7.2m were required against site and other assets,
principally in relation to UK and Australia (2021: £0.6m UK and Australia).
2022 2021
£m £m
Included within the asset net impairment reversal of £9.1m is an impairment reversal of £9.7m and an impairment charge
of £0.6m. The impairment reversal primarily arose in the UK and Australia, where, based on the recovery of site-based assets
after the impact of Covid-19, the calculated recoverable amount exceeded the impaired carrying value for several sites.
Impairment reversals have been reported as adjusting items which is consistent with the treatment of the original
impairments (see note 2).
The presence of potential physical risks arising from climate change to the Group’s key operational sites in the short to
medium term has been reviewed and no assets have been impaired as a result of this exercise.
GOVERNANCE
Lease payments at or before commencement date 2.4 – 2.4
Derecognition (31.9) (2.5) (34.4)
Remeasurement 27.7 – 27.7
Effect of foreign exchange rate changes (17.9) (0.3) (18.2)
At 1 January 2022 596.2 2.4 598.6
Opening balance hyperinflation adjustment 1.0 – 1.0
Businesses acquired 149.4 0.3 149.7
Business sold (25.1) – (25.1)
Additions 33.0 1.4 34.4
Lease payments at or before commencement date 0.2 – 0.2
Derecognition (22.4) (1.2) (23.6)
Remeasurement 24.9 – 24.9
Reclassified to assets held for sale 0.4 – 0.4
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
Effect of foreign exchange rate changes 42.8 0.2 43.0
At 31 December 2022 800.4 3.1 803.5
2022 2021
£m £m
Lease liabilities
Current 83.4 56.5
Non-current 416.0 267.6
At 31 December 499.4 324.1
2022 2021
£m £m
GOVERNANCE
At 31 December 22.2 4.9
2022 2021
£m £m
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
2022 2021
£m £m
Revenue – 0.1
Expenses (1.7) (0.3)
Loss before tax (1.7) (0.2)
Tax 0.5 0.1
Loss after tax of joint ventures and associates (1.2) (0.1)
2022 2021
£m £m
During the year, the Group invested £6.2m in Inchcape Financial Services Australia Pty Ltd, a captive finance company.
As at 31 December 2022, no guarantees were provided in respect of joint ventures and associates’ borrowings (2021: £nil).
Analysed as:
2022 2021
£m £m
2022 2021
£m £m
‘Equity securities’ includes a 15% equity interest in Hino Motors Manufacturing Company SAS.
‘Other’ includes debentures that are not subject to interest rates and do not have fixed maturity dates. They are valued
by reference to traded market values.
GOVERNANCE
Other receivables includes buyback and indemnity assets, interest, sublease and sundry receivables. These relate to
premiums receivable from insurance companies, and rental and utilities deposits. The breakdown of other receivables
is as follows:
Current Non-current
2022 2021 2022 2021
£m £m £m £m
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
Trade receivables representing amounts due from customers, including finance houses, OEMs, third-party dealers and
insurance companies are split by reporting segment as follows:
2022 2021
£m £m
2022 2021
£m £m
The expected credit loss for accrued income and other receivables is not significant.
Trade receivables are non-interest bearing and are generally on credit terms of 30 to 60 days. Trade receivables are only
written off where there is no reasonable expectation of recovery.
The concentration of credit risk with respect to trade receivables is very limited due to the Group’s broad customer base
across a number of geographic regions and the default loss percentage incurred by the Group has customarily been low
even if there have been significant changes in economic conditions experienced in markets in which the Group operates.
Trade receivables include amounts due from a number of finance houses in respect of vehicles sold to customers on finance.
As a consequence, the risk associated with trade receivable balances past due but not impaired is not expected to
be significant and as such does not contribute to a significant allowance for expected credit losses of receivables
being recognised.
The allowance for expected credit losses for trade receivables and accrued income is based on an expected credit loss
model that calculates the expected loss applicable to the receivable balance over its lifetime. For the Group, the simplified
approach under IFRS 9 Financial Instruments is applied to all trade receivables and accrued income. Under this approach,
the provision required against receivables is calculated by considering the cash shortfall that would be incurred in various
default scenarios for prescribed future periods. Default rates are calculated initially by considering historical loss experience
and applied to trade receivables within a provision matrix. The matrix approach allows application of different default rates
to different groups of customers with similar characteristics. These groups will be determined by a number of factors including:
the nature of the customer, the payment method selected and where relevant, the sector in which they operate. The
characteristics used to determine the groupings of receivables are the factors that have the greatest impact on the likelihood
of default. The rate of default increases once the balance is 30 days past due and subsequently in 30-day increments.
Management considers the carrying amount of trade and other receivables to approximate to their fair value. Long-term
receivables have been discounted where the time value of money is considered to be material.
GOVERNANCE
statement (discontinued
operations) – – – 0.9 – 0.7 – (0.1) 1.5
(Charged)/credited to equity
and other comprehensive
income (13.1) (0.5) 1.6 12.7 – – – – 0.7
Businesses acquired – – – – – 0.1 – – 0.1
Business sold – – – (0.4) 0.1 (0.3) – – (0.6)
Effect of foreign exchange
rate changes (0.1) (0.2) – (0.6) (0.5) (2.1) 6.5 (0.7) 2.3
At 1 January 2022 (23.6) 1.2 4.8 18.3 18.8 25.5 (61.5) 15.8 (0.7)
Adjustments for
hyperinflation – – – – (4.0) (0.1) – (0.2) (4.3)
(Charged)/credited to
the consolidated income
statement (continuing
operations) (4.5) (0.2) 1.1 0.4 (4.1) 12.1 0.4 1.6 6.8
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(Charged)/credited to
the consolidated income
statement
(discontinued operations) – – – (0.3) (0.1) 1.2 – (0.1) 0.7
Credited/(charged) to equity
and other comprehensive
income 0.4 (9.3) – 0.4 – – – – (8.5)
Businesses acquired – (0.1) – 2.0 (19.5) 9.2 (157.4) (0.9) (166.7)
Business sold – – – (1.3) 0.2 1.8 – (0.1) 0.6
Effect of foreign exchange
rate changes – 0.1 0.1 0.7 0.1 2.8 (7.3) 0.3 (3.2)
At 31 December 2022 (27.7) (8.3) 6.0 20.2 (8.6) 52.5 (225.8) 16.4 (175.3)
Analysed as:
2022 2021
£m £m
Measured at relevant local statutory rates, the Group has an unrecognised deferred tax asset of £45m (2021: £39m) relating
to tax relief on trading losses. The unrecognised asset represents £174m (2021: £160m) of losses which exist within legal entities
where forecast taxable profits are not probable in the foreseeable future. Unrecognised tax losses totalling £7.3m (2021:
£3.1m) will expire within 5 years and £3.9m (2021: £nil) will expire in more than 5 years.
The Group has unrecognised deferred tax assets of £44m (2021: £44m) relating to capital losses. The asset represents
£177m (2021: £177m) of losses at the UK standard rate. The key territory holding the losses is the UK.
The Group has unrecognised deferred tax assets of £20m (2021: £26m) relating to other deductible temporary differences.
The deferred tax asset on tax trading losses of £20.2m (2021: £18.3m) relates to territories and entities where future taxable
profits are considered probable.
The net deferred tax asset relating to the UK group of companies remains unrecognised as at 31 December 2022. Therefore,
no deferred tax charges or credits are recorded in the consolidated income statement or consolidated statement of other
comprehensive income in relation to temporary differences arising in the period for these companies (2021: the deferred tax
charge on UK pension actuarial movements through other comprehensive income was offset by recognition of a deferred
tax credit on losses).
18 INVENTORIES
2022 2021
£m £m
Vehicles held on consignment which are in substance assets of the Group amount to £60.1m (2021: £55.5m). These have
been included in ‘finished goods and merchandise’ with the corresponding liability included within ‘trade and other
payables’. Payment becomes due when title passes to the Group, which is generally the earlier of a period of up to six
months from delivery or the date of sale.
An amount of £57.7m (2021: £48.4m) has been provided against the gross cost of inventory at the year end. The cost of
inventories recognised as an expense in the year is £6,846.4m (2021: £6,278.1m). The write-down of inventory to net realisable
value recognised as an expense during the year was £1.8m (2021: expense of £0.9m). All of these items have been included
within ‘cost of sales’ in the consolidated income statement.
Cash and cash equivalents are generally subject to floating interest rates determined by reference to short-term
benchmark rates applicable in the relevant currency or market (primarily SONIA or the local equivalent). At 31 December
2022, the weighted average floating rate was 3.0% (2021: 0.4%).
£91.4m (2021: £71.8m) of cash and cash equivalents is held in Ethiopia where prior approval is required to transfer funds
abroad and currency may not be available locally to effect such transfers.
At 31 December 2022, short-term deposits have a weighted average period to maturity of 5 days (2021: 10 days).
Assets classified as held for sale and disposal group 19.0 4.8
Assets held for sale relate to surplus properties in the United Kingdom and Australia which are actively marketed with a view
to sale.
In 2021, assets held for sale were stated net of an impairment charge of £1.5m which was reported as a non-adjusting
charge in the income statement following the subsequent write-down of the asset to fair value less costs to sell.
GOVERNANCE
Other payables include a dividend liability of £208.3m due to the former owners of the Derco group which represents the
amount due in respect of a pre-completion dividend that remained unpaid at the balance sheet date and is due to be
paid in four instalments during 2023. Other payables also include a liability of £59.8m which represents a contractual liability
to minority shareholders in Derco group companies that was settled in early January 2023.
The Group finances the purchase of new vehicles for sale and a portion of used vehicle inventories using vehicle funding
facilities provided by various lenders including the captive finance companies associated with brand partners. Such
arrangements generally are uncommitted facilities, have a maturity of 180 days or less and the Group is normally required
to repay amounts outstanding on the earlier of the sale of the vehicles that have been funded under the facilities or the
stated maturity date. Related cash flows are reported within cash flows from operating activities within the consolidated
statement of cash flows.
Vehicle funding facilities are subject to SONIA-based (or similar) interest rates. The interest incurred under these
arrangements is included within finance costs and classified as stock holding interest (see note 7). At 31 December 2022,
amounts outstanding under vehicle funding facilities and on which interest was payable were subject to a weighted
average interest rate of 3.7% (2021: 1.3%).
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
Management considers the carrying amount of trade and other payables to approximate to their fair value. Long-term
payables have been discounted where the time value of money is considered to be material.
Included within deferred income are the following balances:
2022 2021
£m £m
Revenue recognised in 2022 that was included in deferred revenue at the beginning of the year was £77.1m (2021: £47.8m).
Extended warranties
Certain Group companies provide extended warranties to customers over and above those provided by the manufacturer
and act as the principal in the supply of the warranty service. The periods covered are up to six years and/or specific
mileage limits. A proportion of revenue is allocated to the extended warranty obligation and deferred to the balance
sheet. The revenue is subsequently recognised over time along with the costs incurred in fulfilling any warranty obligations.
Service packages
Certain Group companies provide service packages to customers as part of the total vehicle package. Where the Group
acts as principal, the value of the additional services is separately identified, deducted from revenue and recognised
as deferred income on the balance sheet. It is subsequently recognised as revenue when the service is provided or the
package expires.
Other services
Certain Group companies provide other services as part of the total vehicle package (e.g. roadside assistance, fuel
coupons etc). Where the Group acts as principal, the value of the additional services is separately identified, deducted
from revenue and recognised as deferred income on the balance sheet. It is subsequently recognised as revenue over the
period to which the service relates. Included within other services is £54.3m that relates to amounts received from customers
for goods not yet delivered.
22 PROVISIONS
Product
warranty Leasehold Litigation Other Total
£m £m £m £m £m
Inflation and expected future movements in prices have been considered in calculating provisions where relevant.
Analysed as:
2022 2021
£m £m
Product warranty
Certain Group companies provide assurance warranties as part of the sale of a vehicle. These are not separable products.
The warranty periods covered are up to five years and/or specific mileage limits. Provision is made for the expected cost
of labour and parts based on historical claims experience and expected future trends. These assumptions are reviewed
regularly.
Leasehold
The Group is committed to certain leasehold premises for which it no longer has a commercial use. These are principally
located in the UK, Australia and Hong Kong. Provision has been made to the extent of the estimated future net cost,
excluding the lease liability recognised under IFRS 16 Leases. This includes taking into account existing subtenant
arrangements. The category also includes the future obligation relating to dilapidations of certain premises. The expected
utilisation period of these provisions is generally over the next 10 years.
Litigation
This includes a number of litigation provisions in respect of claims that have been brought against various Group
companies. The claims are generally expected to be concluded within the next three years.
Other
This category principally includes provisions relating to uncertain non-income taxes and provisions relating to restructuring
activities of £2.5m (2021: £4.7m). Acquisition and disposal related provisions total £6.1m (2021: £3.5m), of which there is an
offsetting indemnity asset recognised in trade and other receivables. Restructuring provisions relate to the estimated costs
associated with transformation projects, including the establishment of back-office services. These provisions are expected
to be utilised within three years.
Climate change
The group has reviewed its provisions and concluded that no adjustments need to be made for climate change risks,
nor that any new provisions need to be recognised for climate-related matters.
GOVERNANCE
Private Placement – – 210.0 3.0% 210.0 – 210.0
625.0 4.0% 270.6 5.2% 895.6 – 895.6
Total borrowings 702.2 4.2% 739.7 7.5% 1,441.9 – 1,441.9
Bank overdrafts include £14.1m (2021: £7.6m) held in cash pooling arrangements which have not been offset in the
consolidated statement of financial position (see note 24b).
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
Private Placement – – 210.0 3.0 210.0 – 210.0
Total borrowings 7.6 – 210.0 3.0 217.6 – 217.6
Interest payments on floating rate financial liabilities are determined by reference to short-term benchmark rates applicable
in the relevant currency or market (primarily SONIA or the local equivalent).
At 31 December 2022, the committed funding facilities of the Group comprised a syndicated revolving credit facility of
£700m (2021: £700m), sterling Private Placement loan notes totalling £210m (2021: £210m), a bridge facility of £350m (2021:
£nil) and a term facility of £250m (2021: £nil). At 31 December 2022, the bridge and term facilities were fully drawn and the
syndicated revolving credit facility was undrawn (2021: undrawn).
In July 2022, the Group entered into a facilities agreement with two banks comprising a £350m bridge facility and a £250m
term loan facility. The bridge facility has an initial term of 12 months commencing from 29 December 2022, but the term is
extendable at Inchcape’s option by up to 12 months. The term loan has a term of 2 years commencing from 29 December
2022. The term and bridge facilities were fully drawn as at 31 December 2022 and have been disclosed as non-current
borrowings.
In February 2019, the Group entered into a syndicated revolving credit facility of £700m with an initial expiry date of
February 2024 and options, at lender discretion, to extend until 2026. Lenders approved the first extension option in February
2020 resulting in the £700m commitment extending to 2025. Lenders with total commitments of £620m approved the second
extension option in February 2021, resulting in £620m of commitments being further extended to 2026.
The Group’s bank loans are not secured by any term deposits placed under a standby letter of credit and related facility
arrangements (2021: £nil secured). The Group’s bank overdrafts are secured by related offsetting cash balances held under
pooling arrangements. The Group’s remaining borrowings are unsecured.
In December 2016, the Group concluded a Private Placement transaction raising £210m to refinance existing US dollar
Private Placement borrowings which matured in May 2017. The amounts drawn under these facilities are as follows:
Maturity date May 2024 May 2027 May 2027 May 2029
The £210m sterling Private Placement loan notes are held at amortised cost. They have a fair value of £204.5m (2021:
£222.0m) calculated from discounted cash flow techniques obtained using discount rates from observable market data,
which is a level 2 valuation technique. The fair values of the Group’s other borrowings are not considered to be materially
different from their book value.
23 BORROWINGS CONTINUED
The table below sets out the maturity profile of the Group’s existing borrowings that are exposed to interest rate risk.
Less than 1 Between 1 and Between 2 and Between 3 and Between 4 and Greater than 5 Total interest
year 2 years 3 years 4 years 5 years years bearing
2022 £m £m £m £m £m £m £m
Fixed rate
Bank loans 469.1 58.5 0.4 0.4 0.4 0.9 529.7
Private Placement – 70.0 – – 100.0 40.0 210.0
469.1 128.5 0.4 0.4 100.4 40.9 739.7
Floating rate
Bank overdrafts 14.1 – – – – – 14.1
Bank loans 63.1 625.0 – – – – 688.1
77.2 625.0 – – – – 702.2
Less than 1 Between 1 and Between 2 and Between 3 and Between 4 and Greater than 5 Total interest
year 2 years 3 years 4 years 5 years years bearing
2021 £m £m £m £m £m £m £m
Fixed rate
Private Placement – – 70.0 – – 140.0 210.0
Floating rate
Bank overdrafts 7.6 – – – – – 7.6
GOVERNANCE
Measured
at fair value Measured
Measured at through other at fair value
amortised comprehensive through profit
cost income or loss Total
2022 £m £m £m £m
Financial assets
Financial assets at fair value through other
comprehensive income – 3.5 – 3.5
Trade and other receivables 520.5 – – 520.5
Derivative financial instruments – 23.9 30.3 54.2
Cash and cash equivalents 1,064.2 – – 1,064.2
Total financial assets 1,584.7 27.4 30.3 1,642.4
Financial liabilities
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
Trade and other payables (2,581.2) – – (2,581.2)
Derivative financial instruments – (15.0) (24.5) (39.5)
Lease liabilities (499.4) – – (499.4)
Borrowings (1,441.9) – – (1,441.9)
Total financial liabilities (4,522.5) (15.0) (24.5) (4,562.0)
(2,937.8) 12.4 5.8 (2,919.6)
Measured
at fair value Measured
Measured at through other at fair value
amortised comprehensive through profit
cost income or loss Total
2021 £m £m £m £m
Financial assets
Financial assets at fair value through other
comprehensive income – 5.0 – 5.0
Trade and other receivables 273.7 – – 273.7
Derivative financial instruments – 7.4 20.2 27.6
Cash and cash equivalents 596.4 – – 596.4
Total financial assets 870.1 12.4 20.2 902.7
Financial liabilities
Trade and other payables (1,346.8) – – (1,346.8)
Derivative financial instruments – (10.5) (21.4) (31.9)
Lease liabilities (324.1) – – (324.1)
Borrowings (217.6) – – (217.6)
Total financial liabilities (1,888.5) (10.5) (21.4) (1,920.4)
(1,018.4) 1.9 (1.2) (1,017.7)
Gross amounts
Related amounts not set
of financial Net amounts of
off in the statement of
liabilities financial assets
financial position
set off in the presented in
Gross amounts statement the statement Cash
of financial of financial of financial Financial collateral Net
assets position position instruments received amount
£m £m £m £m £m £m
As at 31 December 2022
Derivative financial assets 54.2 – 54.2 (19.4) – 34.8
Cash and cash equivalents 1,064.2 – 1,064.2 (14.1) – 1,050.1
1,118.4 – 1,118.4 (33.5) – 1,084.9
As at 31 December 2021
Derivative financial assets 27.6 – 27.6 (16.5) – 11.1
Cash and cash equivalents 596.4 – 596.4 (7.6) – 588.8
624.0 – 624.0 (24.1) – 599.9
Net amounts
Related amounts not set
Gross amounts of financial
off in the statement of
of financial liabilities
financial position
assets set off in presented in
Gross amounts the statement the statement Cash
of financial of financial of financial Financial collateral Net
liabilities position position instruments paid amount
£m £m £m £m £m £m
As at 31 December 2022
Derivative financial liabilities (39.5) – (39.5) 19.4 – (20.1)
Bank overdrafts (14.1) – (14.1) 14.1 – –
(53.6) – (53.6) 33.5 – (20.1)
As at 31 December 2021
Derivative financial liabilities (31.9) – (31.9) 16.5 – (15.4)
Bank overdrafts (7.6) – (7.6) 7.6 – –
(39.5) – (39.5) 24.1 – (15.4)
For the financial assets and liabilities subject to enforceable netting arrangements or similar agreements above, each
agreement between the Group and the counterparty allows for net settlement of the relevant financial assets and
liabilities. If the parties subject to the agreement do not elect to settle on a net basis, financial assets and liabilities will
be settled on a gross basis. However, each party to the netting agreement will have the option to settle all such amounts
on a net basis in the event of a default of the other party.
GOVERNANCE
US dollar to sterling exchange rate are recorded directly in equity;
• changes in the carrying value of financial instruments not in hedging relationships only affect the consolidated income
statement; and
• all other changes in the carrying value of derivative financial instruments designated as hedges are fully effective with
no impact on the consolidated income statement.
d. Interest rate risk and sensitivity analysis
The Group’s interest rate policy has the objective of minimising net interest expense and protecting the Group from material
adverse movements in interest rates.
Instruments approved for the purpose of hedging interest rate risk include interest rate swaps, forward rate agreements
and options. The Group’s exposure to the risk of changes in market interest rates arises primarily from the floating rate interest
payable on the Group’s bank borrowings, supplier-related finance and the returns available on surplus cash.
Interest rate risk table
The following table demonstrates the sensitivity of the Group’s profit before tax to a reasonably possible change in interest
rates on bank borrowings, supplier related finance and cash balances as at 31 December 2022 with all other variables
held constant.
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
Increase Effect on profit
in basis before tax
points £m
2022
Sterling 100 (9.9)
Euro 100 (0.4)
Chilean peso 250 (3.2)
Australian dollar 100 1.3
US dollar 100 1.4
2021
Sterling 75 (5.7)
Euro 50 0.6
Russian rouble 500 (1.1)
Australian dollar 100 2.8
US dollar 75 0.8
Increase/
(decrease) in Effect on
exchange equity
rate £m
2022
Yen +10% 2.5
Yen -10% 3.7
2021
Yen +10% –
Yen -10% –
f. Credit risk
The amount due from counterparties arising from cash deposits and the use of financial instruments creates credit risk.
The Group monitors its credit exposure to its counterparties via their credit ratings (where applicable) and through its policy
of limiting its exposure to any one party to ensure that they are within Board approved limits and that there are no
significant concentrations of credit risk.
Group policy is to deposit cash and use financial instruments with counterparties with a long-term credit rating of A or
better, where available. The notional amounts of financial instruments used in interest rate and foreign exchange
management do not represent the credit risk arising through the use of these instruments. The immediate credit risk of these
instruments is generally estimated by the fair value of contracts with a positive value. Credit limits are reviewed regularly.
2022 2021
Derivative Cash Short-term Derivative Cash Short-term
assets at bank deposits assets at bank deposits
Credit rating of counterparty £m £m £m £m £m £m
GOVERNANCE
BBB- 0.8 5.5 72.7 – 4.1 0.1
BB+ 1.6 – – 0.7 – –
BB- – 13.8 – – – –
B – 0.4 – – 9.5 –
B- – – – – 5.8 0.4
CCC+ – – – – 1.2 –
No rating* 4.2 87.0 74.4 1.4 32.5 59.5
54.2 640.7 423.5 27.6 501.8 94.6
* Counterparties in certain markets in which the Group operates do not have a credit rating.
For those counterparties which do not have a credit rating, where possible the Group works with partner banks with a local
presence to provide additional assurance. Additionally, the Group proactively repatriates cash through cash-pooling
arrangements, loans between Group companies and dividends as well as regularly monitoring the spread of counterparties
in-country, notably in Ethiopia.
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
No credit limits were exceeded during the reporting period and management does not expect any losses from non-
performance by these counterparties.
The maximum exposure to credit risk for cash at bank, receivables and other financial assets is represented by their
carrying amount.
Total cash at bank of £640.7m (2021: £501.8m) includes cash in the Group’s regional pooling arrangements which are offset
against borrowings for interest purposes. Netting of cash and overdraft balances in the consolidated statement of financial
position only occurs to the extent that there is the legal ability and intention to settle net. As such, overdrafts are presented
in current liabilities to the extent that there is no intention to offset with the cash balance.
Trade receivables include amounts due from a number of finance houses in respect of vehicles sold to customers on
finance arranged through the Group. An independent credit rating agency is used to assess the credit standing of
each finance house. Limits for the maximum outstanding with each finance house are set accordingly.
Between Between
Less than 3 to 12 1 to 5 Greater than
3 months months years 5 years Total
2022 £m £m £m £m £m
Financial assets
Cash and cash equivalents 1,058.7 5.5 – – 1,064.2
Trade and other receivables 444.2 42.7 28.1 5.6 520.6
Financial assets at fair value through other
comprehensive income 0.2 – – 3.3 3.5
Derivative financial instruments 1,216.5 911.6 352.2 – 2,480.3
2,719.6 959.8 380.3 8.9 4,068.6
Financial liabilities
Interest bearing loans and borrowings (171.6) (448.4) (911.9) (42.6) (1,574.5)
Lease liabilities (23.3) (67.4) (245.8) (213.8) (550.3)
Trade and other payables (1,991.7) (561.5) (27.9) (0.1) (2,581.2)
Derivative financial instruments (1,211.5) (940.9) (348.8) – (2,501.2)
(3,398.1) (2,018.2) (1,534.4) (256.5) (7,207.2)
Net outflows (678.5) (1,058.4) (1,154.1) (247.6) (3,138.6)
Between Between
Less than 3 to 12 1 to 5 Greater than
3 months months years 5 years Total
2021 £m £m £m £m £m
Financial assets
Cash and cash equivalents 593.1 3.3 – – 596.4
Trade and other receivables 200.2 45.5 26.3 6.0 278.0
Financial assets at fair value through other
comprehensive income – 0.2 – 4.8 5.0
Derivative financial instruments 1,097.4 1,135.0 126.5 – 2,358.9
1,890.7 1,184.0 152.8 10.8 3,238.3
Financial liabilities
Interest bearing loans and borrowings (7.6) (6.3) (90.1) (144.1) (248.1)
Lease liabilities (17.0) (48.0) (170.2) (149.8) (385.0)
Trade and other payables (1,085.0) (249.8) (11.7) (0.3) (1,346.8)
Derivative financial instruments (1,099.7) (1,145.4) (124.4) – (2,369.5)
(2,209.3) (1,449.5) (396.4) (294.2) (4,349.4)
Net outflows (318.6) (265.5) (243.6) (283.4) (1,111.1)
2022 2021
Level 1 Level 2 Level 3 Total Level 1 Level 2 Level 3 Total
£m £m £m £m £m £m £m £m
GOVERNANCE
Assets
Derivatives used for hedging – 54.2 – 54.2 – 27.6 – 27.6
Financial assets at fair value
through other comprehensive
income 0.9 – 2.6 3.5 0.5 – 4.5 5.0
0.9 54.2 2.6 57.7 0.5 27.6 4.5 32.6
Liabilities
Derivatives used for hedging – (39.5) – (39.5) – (31.9) – (31.9)
Level 1 represents the fair value of financial instruments that are traded in active markets and is based on quoted markets
price at the end of the reporting period.
The fair value of financial instruments that are not traded in an active market (level 2) is determined by using valuation
techniques which include the present value of estimated future cash flows. These valuation techniques maximise the use
of observable market data where it is available and rely as little as possible on entity specific estimates.
Level 3 primarily represents the Group’s equity interest in Hino Motors Manufacturing Company SAS (see note 15). Fair value
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
is based on discounted free cash flows, using the projection of annual income and expenses mainly based on historical
financial figures.
Derivative financial instruments are carried at their fair values. The fair value of forward foreign exchange contracts and
foreign exchange swaps represents the difference between the value of the outstanding contracts at their contracted rates
and a valuation calculated using the spot rates of exchange prevailing at 31 December 2022.
The Group’s derivative financial instruments comprise the following:
Assets Liabilities
2022 2021 2022 2021
£m £m £m £m
The ineffective portion recognised in the consolidated income statement that arises from fair value hedges amounts to
£nil (2021: £nil). The ineffective portion recognised in the consolidated income statement that arises from cash flow hedges
amounts to £nil (2021: £nil).
Derivative financial instruments
The Group principally uses forward foreign exchange contracts to hedge purchases in a non-functional currency against
movements in exchange rates. The cash flows relating to these contracts are generally expected to occur within 12 months
(2021: 12 months) of the end of the reporting period.
Net fair value gains and losses recognised in the hedging reserve in shareholders’ equity (see note 26) on forward foreign
exchange contracts as at 31 December 2022 are expected to be released to the consolidated income statement within
12 months of the end of the reporting period (2021: 12 months).
1. Outstanding deals predominantly relate to our business in Australia which purchases vehicles in Japanese yen.
2. Includes hedging derivatives for both actual and highly probable forecasted purchases. The movement presented in OCI only covers hedging derivatives
relating to highly probable forecasted purchases.
As at 31 December 2022, the accumulated balance of the cash flow hedge reserve was a loss of £2.8m (2021: loss of £6.2m).
The above changes in fair value of hedging instruments will include hedge positions taken up for future foreign currency
exposures and will also include amounts that would have been reclassified from the hedge reserve to the balance sheet
as at 31 December 2022.
i. Capital management
The Group’s capital structure consists of equity and debt. Equity represents funds raised from shareholders and debt
represents funds raised from banks and other financial institutions. The primary objective of the Group’s management of
debt and equity is to ensure that it maintains a strong credit rating and healthy capital ratios in order to finance the Group’s
activities, both now and in the future, and to maximise shareholder value.
The Group manages its capital structure and makes adjustments to it in light of changes in economic conditions. Due to
the impact of Covid-19, some limited exceptions to policy are in place, to reflect the significant amount of cash the Group
currently holds, to increase the counterparty risk limits set for certain counterparties.
To maintain or adjust the capital structure, the Group may adjust the dividend payment to shareholders, return capital to
shareholders or issue new shares. The Directors consider the Group’s capital structure and dividend policy at least twice
a year prior to the announcement of results, taking into account the Group’s ability to continue as a going concern and
the requirements of its business plan.
2022 2021
The committed bank facilities and Private Placement borrowings are subject to the same interest cover covenant based on
an adjusted EBITA measure to interest on consolidated borrowings. The Group is required to maintain a ratio of not less than
three to one and was compliant with this covenant throughout the year.
The Group monitors Group leverage by reference to three tests: Adjusted EBITA interest cover, the ratio of net debt to EBITDA
and the ratio of net debt to market capitalisation. The leverage tests are measured excluding the impact of IFRS 16 Leases.
2022 2021
GOVERNANCE
Adjusted EBITA interest cover (times)* 459.3 114.4
Net debt to EBITDA (times)** n/a n/a
Net debt/market capitalisation (percentage)*** 28.6% n/a
Net debt as at 31 December 2022 includes debt used to acquire the Derco group together with acquired debt. As the
acquisition completed on 31 December 2022 and did not contribute to EBITDA in the year, then the ratio has been reported
as not applicable.
25 SHARE CAPITAL
a. Allotted, called up and fully paid up
2022 2021 2022 2021
Number Number £m £m
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(nominal value of 10.0p each)
At 1 January 383,851,938 393,274,393 38.5 39.4
Cancelled under share buyback (9,357,908) (9,422,455) (0.9) (0.9)
At 31 December 374,494,030 383,851,938 37.6 38.5
Option price
Number of ordinary shares of 10.0p each Exercisable until (£)
Included within the retained earnings reserve are 344,009 (2021: 349,149 shares) ordinary shares in the Company held by
the Inchcape Employee Trust, a general discretionary trust whose beneficiaries include current and former employees of
the Group and their dependants. The book value of these shares at 31 December 2022 was £2.7m (2021: £2.6m). The market
value of these shares at both 31 December 2022 and 22 March 2023 was £2.8m and £3.0m respectively (31 December 2021:
£3.2m; 24 February 2022: £2.5m).
26 OTHER RESERVES
Fair value
through OCI Translation Hedging Total other
Merger reserve reserve reserve reserve reserves
£m £m £m £m £m
At 1 January 2021 – (2.4) (225.7) (20.1) (248.2)
Cash flow hedges:
– net fair value gains – – – 18.0 18.0
– reclassified and reported in inventories – – – (0.9) (0.9)
– tax on cash flow hedges – – – (2.8) (2.8)
Investments held at fair value:
– net fair value gains – 1.6 – – 1.6
Transfers – 0.7 (0.3) (0.4) –
Exchange differences on translation of foreign
operations – – (102.9) – (102.9)
Exchange differences on translation of
discontinued operations – – (0.1) – (0.1)
Recycling of foreign currency reserve – – 108.2 – 108.2
At 1 January 2022 – (0.1) (220.8) (6.2) (227.1)
Cash flow hedges:
– net fair value gains – – – 7.4 7.4
– reclassified and reported in inventories – – – 2.8 2.8
– tax on cash flow hedges – – – (7.1) (7.1)
Investments held at fair value:
– net fair value losses – (1.5) – – (1.5)
Deferred tax on taxation losses – – – 0.3 0.3
Shares to be issued 315.8 – – – 315.8
Exchange differences on translation of foreign
operations – – 130.9 – 130.9
Exchange differences on translation of
discontinued operations – – 18.7 – 18.7
Recycling of foreign currency reserve – – 99.0 – 99.0
Adjustments in respect of hyperinflation – – 45.9 – 45.9
At 31 December 2022 315.8 (1.6) 73.7 (2.8) 385.1
27 RETAINED EARNINGS
GOVERNANCE
2022 2021
£m £m
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
At 31 December 820.4 1,008.7
2022 2021
£m £m
Cash and cash equivalents as per the statement of financial position 1,064.2 596.4
Borrowings – disclosed as current liabilities (546.3) (7.6)
Add back: amounts treated as debt financing 532.2 –
Cash and cash equivalents as per the statement of cash flows 1,050.1 588.8
Debt financing
Amounts to be treated as debt financing (532.2) –
Borrowings – disclosed as non-current liabilities (895.6) (210.0)
Lease liabilities (499.4) (324.1)
Debt financing (1,927.2) (534.1)
Net (debt)/funds (877.1) 54.7
Add back: lease liabilities 499.4 324.1
Adjusted (net debt)/net cash (377.7) 378.8
Total
£m
GOVERNANCE
Investments in joint ventures and associates 11.0
Financial assets at fair value through other comprehensive income 0.1
Trade and other receivables 2.6
Deferred tax assets 10.1
Current assets
Inventories 796.2
Trade and other receivables 316.2
Derivative financial instruments 4.6
Current tax assets 34.2
Cash and cash equivalents 94.9
Current liabilities
Trade and other payables (562.8)
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
Current tax liabilities (21.0)
Provisions (5.6)
Lease liabilities (19.5)
Borrowings (531.6)
Non-current liabilities
Provisions (4.0)
Deferred tax liabilities (173.5)
Lease liabilities (118.3)
Borrowings (85.5)
Net identifiable assets 592.5
Goodwill 130.6
Net assets acquired 723.1
Consideration comprises
Shares issued 315.8
Cash consideration 407.3
Total consideration 723.1
1. G
iven the proximity of the acquisition prior to the year end, the fair values of assets and liabilities acquired, as stated above, are provisional values.
2022
Cash outflow to acquire businesses, net of cash and overdrafts acquired £m
Provisional goodwill of £130.6m arose on the acquisition and is attributable to the anticipated future cash flows of the
acquired business and synergies expected to arise following integration with the Group’s existing businesses in South
America. Specifically, the goodwill represents the premium paid to expand the Group’s presence in this important market
and to create a scale Distribution platform across South America with attractive growth prospects. This provides a platform
to deliver growth and improved returns far quicker than would have been achievable through organic expansion. None of
the goodwill is expected to be deductible for tax purposes.
Intangible assets (not including goodwill) with provisional fair values of £559.1m were recognised at the date of acquisition,
including distribution agreements (£516.8m), brands (£19.2m) and customer relationships (£13.1m). The distribution
agreement and customer relationship intangible assets were valued using the multi period excess earnings (MEEM)
approach, while the brands were valued using the relief from royalty approach.
Right-of-use assets of £124.0m and lease liabilities of £137.8m have been recognised at the date of acquisition. The lease
liabilities are valued based on the assumption that the lease start date is equal to the acquisition date and discounting
future lease payments by the incremental borrowing rate at the acquisition date. The right-of-use asset is measured at
the same amount as the lease liability, adjusted to reflect terms which are favourable or unfavourable compared to
market terms.
The fair value of trade and other receivables includes trade receivables of £125.1m and £67.3m of other taxation assets.
The gross contractual amount receivable for trade receivables was £129.3m and the best estimate at the acquisition date
of the contractual cash flows not expected to be collected was £4.2m. The gross contractual amount receivable for other
taxation assets was equal to its fair value.
If the Derco Group had been acquired on 1 January 2022, the approximate revenue of the Group for the year ended
31 December 2022 would have been £10,380m and adjusted profit before tax would have been £510m. This information has
been estimated based on management information of the acquired businesses prior to the date of acquisition, adjusted
for known accounting policy differences and the impact of drawing down the related financing facilities from 1 January
2022. This pro forma information does not represent the results of the combined Group that actually would have occurred
had the acquisition taken place on 1 January 2022 and should not be taken to be representative of future results.
Other acquisitions
On 28 March 2022, to expand its distribution footprint in the Americas, the Group acquired 70% of Comercializadora Ditec
Automoviles S.A., acquiring the distribution rights to Porsche, Volvo and Jaguar Land Rover in Chile, for total consideration
of £15.0m. Distribution agreements with a provisional fair value of £28.0m were recognised at the date of acquisition.
Provisional goodwill of £2.7m arose on the acquisition. None of the goodwill is expected to be deductible for tax purposes.
On 29 April 2022, the Group acquired the entire share capital of ITC Group, a distributor of Suzuki, Mercedes-Benz, Subaru
and Chrysler brands in the Caribbean, from the Simpson Group. The total cash consideration paid was £61.4m. Distribution
agreements with a provisional fair value of £28.9m were recognised at the date of acquisition. Provisional goodwill of £0.1m
arose on the acquisition. These businesses were acquired to further expand the Group’s footprint with both existing and
new OEM partners and using our distribution business as a platform to capture more of a vehicle’s lifecycle value. Ditec
and ITC Group contributed £221.4m of revenue and £11.6m of profit before tax for the year ended 31 December 2022.
During the year, the Group also acquired businesses in Guam and the UK. The total cost of these acquisitions was £18.1m
and goodwill of £6.5m has been recognised.
GOVERNANCE
Trade and other payables (41.5) (14.6) – (56.1)
Borrowings (4.5) – – (4.5)
Lease liabilities (27.1) (8.8) – (35.9)
Provisions – (1.3) – (1.3)
Other liabilities (2.9) (0.9) – (3.8)
Net identifiable assets 17.6 61.3 11.6 90.5
Less: Non-controlling interests (5.3) – – (5.3)
Goodwill 2.7 0.1 6.5 9.3
Net assets acquired 15.0 61.4 18.1 94.5
Consideration comprises
Cash consideration 14.2 62.8 18.1 95.1
Amounts payable to/(receivable from) seller 0.8 (1.4) - (0.6)
Total consideration 15.0 61.4 18.1 94.5
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
1. G
iven these acquisitions are still in the measurement period, the fair values of assets and liabilities acquired, as stated above, are provisional values.
2022
Cash outflow to acquire businesses, net of cash and overdrafts acquired £m
The non-controlling interest has a written put option over its 30% equity ownership in the Ditec business. This permits the
holder to sell their shares to the Group at a price determined by an EBITDA driven formula during a three year period
post-acquisition. The amount that may become payable under the option on exercise is initially recognised at the present
value of the redemption amount within trade and other payables with a corresponding charge directly to equity. The
charge to equity is recognised separately as written put options over non-controlling interests. The liability is subsequently
remeasured through equity for any subsequent charges in value. In the event that the option expires unexercised, the
liability is derecognised with a corresponding adjustment to equity. At 31 December 2022, the put option value is estimated
as £14.1m.
Measurement period adjustments
During the year, adjustments have been made to decrease the fair value of assets and liabilities acquired in business
combinations in 2021 by £0.2m in addition to the increase in cash consideration of £0.5m.
2022 2021
£m £m
2022 2021
£m £m
GOVERNANCE
used heavy equipment vehicles, including Freightliner, Mercedes-Benz and Hyundai, in Guam and Micronesia for a total
cash consideration of £26.8m, including the settlement of £12.7m of debt acquired. The business was acquired to expand
the Group’s footprint into commercial vehicles in the region. Provisional goodwill of £16.5m arose on the acquisition. The
goodwill is expected to be deductible for tax purposes.
In 2021, the Group acquired inventory assets from Star Motors SA de CV, a company registered in El Salvador, as well as the
Daimler Trucks North America distribution rights in Ecuador and the distribution rights to Daimler vans in Colombia. The total
cost of these acquisitions was £2.3m.
In 2021, the Group continued to reduce its retail operations and disposed of its Toyota and Audi retail business in St
Petersburg, Russia, generating disposal proceeds of £109.6m. In Belgium, the Group disposed of three retail sites, generating
disposal proceeds of £1.9m and two sites in the UK, generating disposal proceeds of £10.1m. The Group also disposed of its
Retail business in Luxembourg in January 2021 for £4.5m.
None of these disposals were material enough to be shown as discontinued operations on the face of the consolidated
income statement as they did not represent a major line of business or geographical area of operations.
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
2022 2021
£m £m
Letters of credit act as a guarantee, from one of the Group’s banking relationships to another bank, for payments made
by the Group to a specified third party.
The Group also has, in the ordinary course of business, commitments under foreign exchange instruments relating to the
hedging of transactional exposures (see note 24).
Franked Investment Income Group Litigation Order
Inchcape is a participant in an action in the United Kingdom against HMRC in the Franked Investment Income Group
Litigation Order (“FII GLO”). As at 31 December 2022, there were 17 corporate groups in the FII GLO. The action concerns
the treatment for UK corporation tax purposes of profits earned overseas and distributed to the UK. As previously reported,
the Supreme Court has returned the test case to the High Court to establish when the claimant in the test case could have
reasonably discovered its mistake about the UK tax treatment of such profits. The case has now been listed to be heard
by the High Court in November 2023. As at 31 December 2022, no further receipts have been recognised in relation to
the balance of Inchcape’s claim in the FII GLO due to the uncertainty of the eventual outcome, given that the test case
has not yet been completed nor has Inchcape’s specific claim been heard by the Courts.
31 COMMITMENTS
a. Capital commitments
Contracts placed for future capital expenditure at the balance sheet date but not yet incurred are as follows:
2022 2021
£m £m
b. Lease commitments
Operating lease commitments – Group as lessee
Future minimum lease payments for short-term leases under non-cancellable operating leases are as follows:
2022 2021
£m £m
2022 2021
£m £m
2022 2021
£m £m
c. Repurchase commitments
The Group has entered into agreements with certain customers to repurchase vehicles for a specified value at a
predetermined date as follows:
2022 2021
£m £m
Repurchase commitments represent the total repurchase liability on all vehicles where the Group has a repurchase
commitment. These commitments are largely expected to be settled over the next three years. £20.0m (2021: £18.4m)
of the above repurchase commitments are included within ‘trade and other payables’ in the consolidated statement
of financial position.
All of the transactions arise in the ordinary course of business and are on an arm’s length basis. The amounts outstanding
are unsecured and will be settled in cash. There have been no guarantees provided or received for any related party
receivables. The Group has not raised any provision for doubtful debts relating to amounts owed by related parties.
GOVERNANCE
(2021: £nil).
b. Compensation of key management personnel
The remuneration of the Board of Directors and the Executive Committee was as follows:
2022 2021
£m £m
The remuneration of the Directors and other key management is determined by the Remuneration Committee having
regard to the performance of individuals and market trends. Further details of emoluments paid to the Directors are
included in the Directors’ Report on Remuneration.
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
33 FOREIGN CURRENCY TRANSLATION
The main exchange rates used for translation purposes are as follows:
* At 31 December
Note 1: In 2022, the results for Ethiopia are translated at the closing rate, rather than the average rate, as required by IAS 21
The Effects of Changes in Foreign Exchange Rates for hyperinflationary foreign operations.
Note 2: Average rates for the Russian rouble represent the average rates for the 5-month period ending 31 May 2022,
and the closing rates for the Russian rouble are as at the date of disposal of Russian operations.
Organic growth Organic growth is defined as sales growth in operations A measure of underlying business performance
that have been open for at least a year at constant which excludes the impact of acquisition and
foreign exchange rate. disposals in the period.
2022 2021
GOVERNANCE
APM – Adjusted profit before tax (from continuing operations) £m £m
Restated Restated
2022 2022 2021 2021
APM – Free cash flow (from continuing operations)
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
£m £m £m £m
2022 2021
APM – Return on capital employed (from continuing operations) £m £m
2022 2021
APM – Adjusted (net debt)/net cash £m £m
2022 2021
APM – Adjusted earnings per share (from continuing operations) £m £m
STRATEGIC REPORT
The information presented in the table below is prepared in accordance with IFRS, as in issue and effective at that year
end date.
GOVERNANCE
Profit/(loss) before finance and tax 399.7 181.3 (93.0) 448.9 175.0
Net finance costs before adjusting items (37.0) (32.5) (36.6) (47.1) (48.1)
Adjusting finance costs (29.6) – – – (13.9)
Profit/(loss) before tax 333.1 148.8 (129.6) 401.8 113.0
Tax before tax on adjusting items (97.3) (63.1) (33.7) (75.6) (79.1)
Tax on adjusting items (0.9) (1.5) 24.2 2.5 5.5
Profit/(loss) after tax 234.9 84.2 (139.1) 328.7 39.4
(Loss)/profit from discontinued operations (241.1) 37.7 – – –
Non-controlling interests (5.0) (4.9) (2.9) (5.8) (7.0)
(Loss)/profit for the year attributable to
owners of the parent (11.2) 117.0 (142.0) 322.9 32.4
Basic:
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
– (Loss)/profit for the year attributable to owners
of the parent (11.2) 117.0 (129.6) 401.8 113.0
– (Loss)/earnings per share (pence) (3.0)p 30.0p (36.0)p 79.0p 7.8p
Adjusted (before adjusting items):
– Adjusted profit from continuing operations 270.9 180.9 127.5 326.3 350.6
– Adjusted earnings per share (pence) 72.0 46.3p 23.1p 59.9p 63.8p
Dividends per share – interim paid and final
proposed (pence) 28.8p 22.5p 6.9p 26.8p 26.8p
Equity attributable to owners of the parent 1,532.8 1,108.9 1,041.9 1,278.3 1,338.4
Non-controlling interests 34.2 21.6 19.3 20.3 23.3
Total equity 1,567.0 1,130.5 1,061.2 1,298.6 1,361.7
2022 2021
Notes £m £m
Non-current assets
Intangible assets 3 – 2.6
Property, plant and equipment 4 – 0.6
Investment in subsidiaries 5 2,347.1 1,565.3
Deferred tax assets 10 9.8 8.5
Trade and other receivables 6 210.4 210.4
2,567.3 1,787.4
Current assets
Current tax assets 9.6 5.3
Trade and other receivables 6 7.0 6.1
Cash and cash equivalents 7 3.9 0.9
20.5 12.3
Total assets 2,587.8 1,799.7
Current liabilities
Trade and other payables 8 (52.3) (53.7)
(52.3) (53.7)
Non-current liabilities
Trade and other payables 8 (561.5) (900.3)
Borrowings 9 (810.0) (210.0)
(1,371.5) (1,110.3)
Total liabilities (1,423.8) (1,164.0)
Net assets 1,164.0 635.7
Equity
Share capital 12 37.6 38.5
Share premium 146.7 146.7
Capital redemption reserve 143.0 142.1
Merger reserve 315.8 –
Retained earnings 520.9 308.4
Total shareholders’ funds 1,164.0 635.7
The Company reported a profit for the financial year ended 31 December 2022 of £364.3m (2021: loss of £33.7m). The
financial statements on pages 210 to 227 were approved by the Board of Directors on 22 March 2023 and were signed on
its behalf by:
DUNCAN TAIT
GROUP CHIEF EXECUTIVE
STRATEGIC REPORT
Capital
Share Share redemption Merger Retained
capital premium reserve reserve earnings Total
Notes £m £m £m £m £m £m
GOVERNANCE
the Inchcape Employee Trust – – – – (6.2) (6.2)
Share-based payments, net of
tax – – – – 8.4 8.4
At 1 January 2022 38.5 146.7 142.1 – 308.4 635.7
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
tax – – – – 10.2 10.2
Shares to be issued – – – 315.8 – 315.8
At 31 December 2022 37.6 146.7 143.0 315.8 520.9 1,164.0
GENERAL INFORMATION
These financial statements are prepared for Inchcape plc (the Company) for the year ended 31 December 2022. The
Company is the ultimate parent entity of the Inchcape Group (the Group) and acts as the holding company of the Group.
The parent company financial statements present information about the company as a separate entity and not about the
Group.
BASIS OF PREPARATION
These financial statements were prepared in accordance with Financial Reporting Standard 101 Reduced Disclosure
Framework (FRS 101).
The financial statements are prepared under the historical cost convention in accordance with the Companies Act 2006.
As permitted by Section 408 of the Companies Act 2006, no separate profit and loss account or statement of
comprehensive income is presented for the Company.
The Company does not have any critical accounting judgements. The valuation of the Company’s investments is a key
source of estimation uncertainty. The Company’s net assets were lower than its market capitalisation on 31 December 2022
and the estimates of the recoverable amounts of the individual investments were in excess of their carrying values. As a
result, no impairment has been reflected. Other sources of estimation uncertainty most applicable to the Company do
not give rise to a significant risk of material adjustment to the carrying value of the Company’s assets and liabilities.
The Directors of Inchcape plc manage the Group’s risks at a group level rather than an individual business unit or company
level. Further information on these risks and uncertainties, in the context of the Group as a whole, are included within the
Group disclosures on pages 59 to 66.
In preparing these financial statements, the Company applies the recognition, measurement and disclosure requirements
of international accounting standards in conformity with the requirements of the Companies Act 2006, but makes
amendments where necessary in order to comply with Companies Act 2006 and has set out below where advantage
of the FRS 101 disclosure has been taken:
• Paragraphs 45(b) and 46 to 52 of IFRS 2, ‘Share-based payment’ (details of the number and weighted average exercise
price of share options, and how the fair value of goods and services received was determined);
• IFRS 7, ‘Financial Instruments: Disclosures’;
• Paragraphs 91 to 99 of IFRS 13, ‘Fair value measurement’ (disclosure of valuation techniques and inputs used for fair value
measurement of assets and liabilities);
• Paragraph 38 of IAS 1, ‘Presentation of financial statements’ comparative information requirements in respect of:
– paragraph 73(e) of IAS 16, ‘Property, plant and equipment’;
– paragraph 118(e) of IAS 38, ‘Intangible assets’ (reconciliations between the carrying amount at the beginning and
end of the period);
• The following paragraphs of IAS 1, ‘Presentation of financial statements’:
– 10(d) (statement of cash flows),
– 10(f) (a statement of financial position as at the beginning of the preceding period when an entity applies an
accounting policy retrospectively or makes a retrospective restatement of items in its financial statements, or when
it reclassifies items in its financial statements),
– 16 (statement of compliance with all IFRS),
– 38A (requirement for minimum of two primary statements, including cash flow statements),
– 38B-D (additional comparative information),
– 40A-D (requirements for a third statement of financial position),
– 111 (cash flow statement information), and
– 134-136 (capital management disclosures)
• IAS 7, ‘Statement of cash flows’;
• Paragraph 30 and 31 of IAS 8, ‘Accounting policies, changes in accounting estimates and errors’ (requirement for
the disclosure of information when an entity has not applied a new IFRS that has been issued but is not yet effective);
• Paragraph 17 of IAS 24, ‘Related party disclosures’ (key management compensation); and
• The requirements in IAS 24, ‘Related party disclosures’ to disclose related party transactions entered into between
two or more members of a group.
FOREIGN CURRENCIES
Transactions in foreign currencies are translated into the functional currency at the rates of exchange prevailing at
the dates of the individual transactions. Monetary assets and liabilities in foreign currencies are translated into sterling
at closing rates of exchange and differences are taken to the income statement. Non-monetary assets and liabilities
that are measured in terms of historical cost in a foreign currency are translated using the exchange rate at the date
of the transaction. Non-monetary assets and liabilities denominated in foreign currencies that are stated at fair value
are retranslated to the functional currency at foreign exchange rates ruling at the dates the fair value was determined.
Foreign exchange differences arising on translation are recognised in the profit and loss account.
FINANCE COSTS
GOVERNANCE
Finance costs consist of interest payable on the Private Placement borrowing. Costs are recognised as an expense,
calculated using the effective interest rate method, in the period in which they are incurred.
INVESTMENTS
Investments in subsidiaries are stated at cost, less provisions for impairment.
IMPAIRMENT
The Company’s accounting policies in respect of impairment of property, plant and equipment, intangible assets and
financial assets are consistent with those of the Group. The carrying values of investments in subsidiary undertakings are
reviewed at each reporting date to determine whether there is any indication of impairment. If any such indication exists,
then the asset’s recoverable amount is estimated.
The Company’s impairment policies in relation to financial assets are consistent with those of the Group, with additional
consideration given to amounts owed by Group undertakings. Any provision for impairment of receivables is based on
lifetime expected credit losses. Lifetime expected credit losses are calculated by assessing historical credit loss experience,
adjusted for factors specific to the receivable and company.
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
OTHER INTANGIBLE ASSETS
Intangible assets, when acquired separately from a business (including computer software), are carried at cost less
accumulated amortisation and impairment losses. Costs comprise purchase price from third parties as well as internally
generated development costs where relevant. Amortisation is provided on a straight-line basis to allocate the cost of
the asset over its estimated useful life, which in the case of computer software is between five and eight years. Software
customisation and configuration costs relating to software not controlled by the Group are expensed over the period
such services are received.
DEFERRED TAX
Deferred income tax is accounted for using the liability method in respect of temporary differences arising from differences
between the tax bases of assets and liabilities and their carrying amounts in the financial statements.
Deferred tax liabilities are recognised for all taxable temporary differences and deferred tax assets are recognised to the
extent that it is probable that taxable profits will be available against which deductible temporary differences can be
utilised. Such assets and liabilities are not recognised if the temporary difference is due to goodwill arising on a business
combination, or to an asset or liability, the initial recognition of which does not affect either taxable or accounting income.
Deferred tax liabilities are recognised for taxable temporary differences arising on investments in subsidiaries, except where
the Company is able to control the reversal of the temporary difference and it is probable that the temporary difference
will not reverse in the foreseeable future.
Deferred tax is calculated at the tax rates that are expected to apply to the period when the asset is realised or the
liability is settled using rates enacted or substantively enacted at the end of the reporting period. Deferred tax is charged
or credited in the income statement, except when it relates to items credited or charged directly to shareholders’ equity,
in which case the deferred tax is also dealt with in shareholders’ equity.
Deferred tax assets and liabilities are only offset where there is a legally enforceable right of offset and there is an intention
to settle balances net.
SHARE CAPITAL
Ordinary shares are classified as equity.
Where the Company purchases its own equity share capital (treasury shares), the consideration paid is deducted from
shareholders’ funds until the shares are cancelled, reissued or disposed of. Where such shares are subsequently sold or
reissued, any consideration received is included in shareholders’ funds.
DIVIDENDS
Final dividends proposed by the Board of Directors and unpaid at the year-end are not recognised in the financial
statements until they have been approved by the shareholders at the Annual General Meeting. Interim dividends are
recognised when they are paid.
SHARE-BASED PAYMENTS
The Company operates various share-based award schemes. The fair value at the date at which the share-based awards
are granted is recognised in the income statement (together with a corresponding credit in shareholders’ equity) on a
straight-line basis over the vesting period, based on an estimate of the number of shares that will eventually vest. At the end
of each reporting period, the Company revises its estimates of the number of awards that are expected to vest. The impact
of any revision is recognised in the income statement with a corresponding adjustment to equity.
For equity-settled share-based awards, the services received from employees are measured by reference to the fair value
of the awards granted. With the exception of the Save As You Earn scheme, the vesting of all share-based awards under all
schemes is solely reliant upon non-market conditions, therefore no expense is recognised for awards that do not ultimately
vest. Where an employee cancels a Save As You Earn award, the charge for that award is recognised as an expense
immediately, even though the award does not vest.
The issue of shares by the Company to employees of its subsidiaries represents additional capital contributions. When these
costs are recharged to the subsidiary undertaking, the investment balance is reduced accordingly.
FINANCIAL INSTRUMENTS
The Company’s policies on the recognition, measurement and presentation of financial instruments under IFRS 7 are the
same as those set out in the Group’s accounting policies on pages 141 to 151.
FINANCIAL GUARANTEES
Where the Company enters into financial guarantee contracts to guarantee the indebtedness of other companies within
its Group, the Company considers these to be insurance arrangements and accounts for them as such. In this respect, the
Company treats the guarantee contract as a contingent liability until such time as it becomes probable that the Company
will be required to make a payment under the guarantee.
STRATEGIC REPORT
1 AUDITOR’S REMUNERATION
The Company incurred £0.1m (2021: £0.1m) in relation to UK statutory audit fees for the year ended 31 December 2022.
2 DIRECTORS’ REMUNERATION
2022 2021
£m £m
Further information on Executive Directors’ emoluments and interests is given in the Directors’ Report on Remuneration
which can be found on pages 96 to 116.
GOVERNANCE
3 INTANGIBLE ASSETS
Computer
software
£m
Cost
At 1 January 2022 25.9
Retirement of fully amortised assets (25.9)
At 31 December 2022 –
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
At 31 December 2022 –
Net book value at 31 December 2022 –
Net book value at 31 December 2021 2.6
Cost
At 1 January 2022 1.8
Retirement of fully depreciated assets (1.8)
At 31 December 2022 –
5 INVESTMENT IN SUBSIDIARIES
2022 2021
£m £m
Cost
At 1 January 1,696.0 1,696.0
Additions 781.8 –
Dissolution (75.9) –
At 31 December 2,401.9 1,696.0
Provisions
At 1 January (130.7) (130.3)
Dissolution 75.9 –
Impairment – (0.4)
At 31 December (54.8) (130.7)
Net book value 2,347.1 1,565.3
The Directors believe that the carrying value of the individual investments is supported by their underlying net assets.
During 2022, as part of the acquisition of the Derco group, the Company increased its investment in Inchcape International
Holdings Limited and Indigo Chile Holdings SpA.
Inchcape Finance (Ireland) Limited, a subsidiary of the company, was dissolved on 10 January 2022, and an impairment
charge of £0.4m was recognised against the Company’s investment in this subsidiary in 2021.
Amounts owed by Group undertakings that are due within one year consist of current account balances that are interest free
and repayable on demand, as well as intercompany loans that bear interest at rates linked to source currency base rates.
Amounts owed by Group undertakings that are due after more than one year bear interest at rates linked to source
currency base rates.
2022 2021
£m £m
Amounts owed to Group undertakings are repayable between one and five years and bear interest at rates linked to
source currency base rates.
In December 2016, the Group concluded a Private Placement transaction raising £210m to refinance existing US dollar
Private Placement borrowings which matured in May 2017. The amounts drawn under these facilities are as follows:
Maturity date May 2024 May 2027 May 2027 May 2029
Amount drawn £70m £30m £70m £40m
GOVERNANCE
Fixed rate coupon 2.85% 3.02% 3.12% 3.10%
In July 2022, the Group entered into a facilities agreement with two banks comprising a £350m bridge facility and a £250m
term loan facility. The bridge facility has an initial term of 12 months commencing from the 29 December 2022, but the term
is extendable at Inchcape’s option by up to 12 months. The term loan has a term of 2 years commencing from 29 December
2022. The term and bridge facilities were fully drawn as at 31 December 2022 and have been disclosed as non-current
borrowings.
10 DEFERRED TAX
Tax losses
Net deferred tax asset/(liabilities) £m
At 1 January 2021 –
Credited to the income statement 8.5
At 1 January 2022 8.5
Credited to the income statement 1.3
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
At 31 December 2022 9.8
Deferred tax assets recognised are supported by those future taxable profits of the UK tax group, headed by the Company,
which are associated with the reversal of taxable temporary differences.
11 GUARANTEES
The Company is party to composite cross guarantees between banks and its subsidiaries. The Company’s exposure under
these guarantees at 31 December 2022 was £3.9m (2021: £0.9m), equal to the carrying value of its cash and cash
equivalents at the end of the period (see note 7).
In addition, the Company has given performance guarantees in the normal course of business in respect of the obligations
of Group undertakings amounting to £147.0m (2021: £119.0m).
12 SHARE CAPITAL
a. Allotted, called up and fully paid up
2022 2021 2022 2021
Number Number £m £m
Option price
Number of ordinary shares of 10.0p each Exercisable until (£)
Included within the retained earnings reserve are 344,009 ordinary shares (2021: 349,149 ordinary shares) in the Company
held by the Inchcape Employee Trust, a general discretionary trust whose beneficiaries include current and former
employees of the Group and their dependants. The book value of these shares at 31 December 2022 was £2.7m (2021:
£2.6m). The market value of these shares at both 31 December 2022 and 22 March 2023 was £2.8m and £3.0m respectively
(31 December 2021: £3.2m; 24 February 2022: £2.5m).
e. Issue of shares after the balance sheet date
On 4 January 2023, 38,513,102 ordinary shares of 10p each in the capital of the Company were issued in connection with the
acquisition of the Derco group. As at 31 December 2022, the acquisition had completed and, as at that date, the shares
that were issued on 4 January 2023 represented a liability to issue a fixed number of shares in exchange for fixed financial
assets. As such, they have been accounted for as an equity instrument.
f. Share-based remuneration
During the year, Inchcape plc had two employees, the Group Chief Executive and the former Chief Financial Officer.
The terms and conditions of the Company’s share-based payment plans are detailed in the Directors’ Report on
Remuneration.
The charge arising from share-based transactions during the year was £0.7m (2021: charge of £1.2m), all of which is
equity-settled.
The weighted average exercise price of shares exercised during the period was £nil (2021: £0.10).
The weighted average remaining contractual life for the share options outstanding at 31 December 2022 is 1.3 years (2021:
2.3 years) and the weighted average exercise price for options outstanding at the end of the year was £4.79 (2021: £3.77).
13 DIVIDENDS
The following dividends were paid by the Company:
2022 2021
£m £m
Interim dividend for the six months ended 30 June 2022 of 7.5p per share
(30 June 2021 of 6.4p per share) 28.0 25.1
Final dividend for the year ended 31 December 2021 of 16.1p per share
(31 December 2020 of 6.9p per share) 60.7 27.1
88.7 52.2
A final proposed dividend for the year ended 31 December 2022 of 21.3p per share is subject to approval by shareholders
at the Annual General Meeting and has not been included as a liability as at 31 December 2022.
Argentina
Torre Catalinas Plaza, Av. Eduardo Madero 900 Piso 17, Buenos Aires
Distribuidora Automotriz Argentina SA 100%
Inchcape Argentina SA 100%
Australia
GOVERNANCE
Level 2, 4 Burbank Place, Baulkham Hills, NSW 2153
AutoNexus Pty Ltd 100%
Bespoke Automotive Australia Pty Ltd 100%
Inchcape Australia Ltd (i) 100%
Trivett Automotive Retail Pty Ltd 100%
Inchcape European Automotive Pty Ltd (ii) 100%
SMLB Pty Ltd 100%
Subaru (Aust) Pty Ltd 90%
TCH Unit Trust 100%
Trivett Automotive Group Pty Ltd 100%
Trivett Bespoke Automotive Pty Ltd 100%
Trivett Classic Garage Pty Ltd 100%
Trivett Classic Group Finance Pty Ltd 100%
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
Trivett Classic Holdings Pty Ltd (iii) 100%
Trivett Classic Pty Ltd (iv) 100%
Trivett Motorcycles Pty Ltd 100%
Trivett Pty Ltd 100%
Trivett Tyres Pty Ltd 100%
Inchcape Finance Australia Pty Limited 100%
Inchcape Corporate Services Australia Pty Limited 100%
Barbados
International Trading Centre, Warrens, St. Michael, Barbados, BB22026
Inchcape Caribbean Inc (formerly Interamericana Trading Corporation) 100%
Inchcape (Barbados) Inc (formerly Simpson Motors Limited) 100%
Belgium
Leuvensesteenweg 369, 1932 Sint-Stevens-Woluwe
Autoproducts NV 100%
Car Security NV 100%
Toyota Belgium NV/SA 100%
Bolivia
Avenue Cristobal de Mendoza No. 164 UV:14 Mzno:5 Bldg. Imcruz, Santa Cruz
Imcruz Comercial S.A. 100%
Corporación de Inversiones Imcruz Corp. S.A. 100%
Inversiones Piraí S.R.L. 100%
Imcruz Corredores de Seguros S.R.L. 100%
Brunei
KM3.6, Jalan Gadong, Bandar Seri Begawan
Champion Motors (Brunei) Sdn Bhd 70%
NBT (Brunei) Sdn Bhd 70%
NBT Services Sdn Bhd 70%
Bulgaria
163 Tsarigradsko Shosse Str, Sofia
Inchcape Brokerage Bulgaria EOOD 100%
TM Auto EOOD 100%
Toyota Balkans EOOD 100%
Cayman Islands
c/o JTC (Cayman) Limited P.O. Box 30745, 94 Solaris Avenue, 2nd Floor, Camana Bay, Grand Cayman,
KY1-1203
Interamericana Trading Corp. 100%
Chile
Av. La Dehesa 265, Ciudad Santiago comuna Lo Barnechea Región Metropolitana
Mobility Services Chile SpA 100%
Universal Motors SpA 100%
Williamson Balfour Motors SA 100%
Williamson Balfour SA 100%
Chile CONTINUED
Dercolatina SpA 100%
Sociedad Corredora de Seguros Derco SpA 100%
Derco Chile Repuestos SpA 100%
Dercocenter SpA 100%
Derco SpA 100%
Sociedad Inmobiliaria SCR SpA 100%
Servicios Operacionales Comerciales y Administrativos SpA (formerly known as Sociedad Comercializadora
de Motos S.A.) 100%
GOVERNANCE
Sociedad Comercializadora de Repuestos SpA 100%
Colombia
Calle 99 N° 69c – 41 Bogotá
Inchcape Digital Delivery Centre Colombia S.A.S 100%
Matrase S.A.S 100%
Inchcape Colombia S.A.S 100%
Inmobiliaria Inchcape Colombia S.A.S 100%
BravoAuto S.A.S 100%
Vuelta Grande a 150 metros de la Glorieta de Siberia via Cota-Chia CLIS BG34
Distribuidora Hino de Colombia SAS 100%
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
Chía, Cundinamarca, Colombia
Derco Colombia S.A.S. 100%
Derco Agencia de Seguros LTDA 100%
Cook Islands
First Floor, BCI House, Avarua, Rarotonga
IB Enterprises Ltd 100%
Costa Rica
La Uruca, de la Pozuelo 200 metros oeste, frente al Hospital Mexico
Arienda Express SA 100%
Inchcape Protection Express Sociedad Agencia de Seguros SA 100%
Vehiculos de Trabajo SA 100%
Vistas de Guanacaste Orquideas SA 100%
Djibouti
Route de Venise – Djibouti Free Zone – PO Box 2645
Red Sea Automotive FZCO 100%
Inchcape Djibouti Automotive Sarl 100%
Ecuador
Av. 10 de Agosto N36-226 y Naciones Unidas, Quito, 170507
Autolider Ecuador S.A.S 100%
El Salvador
Boulevard Luis Poma y Calle Llama del Bosque Pte. #1, Urb. Madreselva, Antiguo Cuscatlán, La Libertad
Inchcape El Salvador, S.A. de C.V. 100%
Estonia
Läike tee 38, Peetri küla, Rae vald, Harjumaa 75312
Inchcape Motors Estonia OÜ 100%
Ethiopia
Bole Sub City, Kebele 03, H.Nr. 2441, Addis Ababa
The Motor & Engineering Company Of Ethiopia (Moenco) S.C. 94%
Finland
Ansatie 6 a C, 01740 Vantaa, Kotipaikka, Helsinki
Inchcape Motors Finland Oy 100%
Inchcape JLR Finland Oy 70%
Greece
48 Ethnikis Antistaseos Street, Halandri 15231
British Providence SA 100%
Eurolease Fleet Services SA 100%
Toyota Hellas SA 100%
Polis Inchcape Athens SA 100%
Guam
443 South Marine Corps Drive, Tamuning, Guam 96913
Atkins Kroll Inc 100%
Guatemala
20 Calle 10-91, Zona 10, Guatemala, Guatemala
Inchcape Guatemala SA 100%
Honduras
Penthouse Edificio Torre Mayab, Colonia Loas del Mayab, Avenida Republica de Costa Rica,
Tegucigalpa
Inchcape Honduras S.A. 100%
Hong Kong
11/F, Tower B, Manulife Financial Centre, 223-231 Wai Yip Street, Kwun Tong, Kowloon, HK 100%
British Motors Ltd 100%
Crown Motors Ltd 100%
Future Motors Ltd 100%
Inchcape Finance (HK) Ltd 100%
Inchcape Hong Kong Ltd 100%
Inchcape Mobility Limited 100%
Inchcape Motor Services Ltd 100%
Mega EV Ltd 100%
Nova Motors Ltd 100%
Indonesia
Indomobil Tower, 19th Floor, JI. Mt Haryono no 11, Bidara Cina, Jakarta, Timur
PT JLM Auto Indonesia 60%
Ivory Coast
01 BP 3893, Abidjan O1
Distribution Services Cote d’Ivoire SA 100%
Toyota Services Afrique SA 100%
GOVERNANCE
Kenya
LR 1870/X/126, Ground Floor, Oracle Towers, Waiyaki Way, P.O. Box 2231-00606, Nairobi
Inchcape Kenya Ltd 100%
Latvia
4a Skanstes Street, Riga, LV-1013
Baltic Motors Imports SIA 100%
Inchcape Motors Latvia SIA 100%
Inchcape JLR Baltics SIA 70%
Lithuania
Laisves av. 137, Vilnius, LT-06118
UAB Autovista 67%
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
UAB Inchcape Motors 67%
Macau
Avenida do Coronel Mesquita, No 48-48D, Edf. Industrial Man Kei R/C, Macau
Future Motors (Macao) Ltd 100%
Yat Fung Motors Ltd 100%
Netherlands
Gustav Mahlerlaan 1212, 1081 LA Amsterdam, the Netherlands
Inchcape International Group BV (i) 100%
New Zealand
Bell Gully, Level 22, Vero Centre, 48 Shortland Street, Auckland, 1010, New Zealand
Inchcape Motors NZ Ltd 100%
North Macedonia
21 8th September Boulevard, 1000 Skopje
Toyota Auto Center DOOEL 100%
Panama
Vía General Nicanor A. de Obarrio (Street 50), Plaza Bancomer
lIaother SA 100%
Ilachile SA 100%
Ciudad de Panamá, Vía Cincuentenario Andrés Mojica, Ave. 6ta B., Lote X 5B, Corregimiento
de San Francisco, Distrito de Panamá, Provincia de Panamá
Arrendadora Automotriz SA 100%
Motors Japoneses SA 100%
Sun Motors SA 100%
Lopez, Lopez & Associates, 53rd street Marbella, World Trade Center, 5th floor, suite 502,
Panama City
Isthmus Exchange S.A. 100%
Peru
Av. El Polo Nro. 1117, Santiago de Surco, Lima
Inchcape Motors Peru SA 100%
Poland
Al. Prymasa Tysiąclecia 64, 01-424 Warszawa
Inchcape Motors Polska Sp z.o.o 100%
Philippines
28F Robinsons Cyberscape Gamma, Topaz and Ruby Roads, Ortigas Center, San Antonio,
Pasig Cit, Second District, NCR, 1605
Inchcape Digital Delivery Center Philippines Inc. 100%
Puerto Rico
Sabana Gardens Industrial Park Calle B Lotes 6 al 9a, Carolina, PR 00983 and PO Box 29718,
San Juan, PR 00929
K.I. Investments Inc. 100%
Sabana Gardens Industrial Park Calle B Lotes 6 al 9a, Carolina, PR 00983 and PO Box 29718, San
Juan, PR 00924-0092
Millenium Sales and Services, Inc. 100%
Inchcape Puerto Rico, Inc (formerly Suzuki del Caribe, Inc.) 100%
GOVERNANCE
Romania
Pipera Boulevard No 1, Voluntari, Ilfov, 077190
Inchcape Motors Srl 100%
Toyota Romania Srl 100%
Inchcape Broker de Asigurare Srl 100%
Inchcape Bravoauto Srl 100%
Saipan
San Jose Village, 1 Chalan Monsignor Guerrero, Saipan, 96950, Northern Mariana Islands
Atkins Kroll (Saipan) Inc 100%
Singapore
2 Pandan Crescent, Inchcape Centre, Singapore 128462
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
Borneo Motors (Singapore) Pte Ltd 100%
Century Motors (Singapore) Pte Ltd 100%
Champion Motors (1975) Pte Ltd 100%
Inchcape Automotive Services Pte Ltd 100%
Inchcape Motors Private Ltd 100%
Spain
C. De Don Ramon de la Cruz, 38, 28001 Madrid
Inchcape Inversiones España SLu 100%
Tanzania
AFED Business Park, JK Nyerere Rd, PO.Box 21885, Dar Es Salaam
Inchcape Automotive Limited 100%
Thailand
No. 4332 Rama IV Road, Prakhanong Sub-District, Klongtoey District, Bangkok
Inchcape (Thailand) Company Ltd 100%
No. 2133 New Petchburi Road, Bangkapi Sub-District, Huaykwang District, Bangkok 10310
Inchcape Services (Thailand) Co Ltd 100%
United Kingdom
Inchcape Retail, First Floor, Unit 3140 Park Square, Solihull Parkway, Birmingham B37 7YN
Armstrong Massey (York) Ltd 100%
Armstrong Massey Holdings Ltd (dissolved January 2023) 100%
Autobytel Ltd 100%
Chapelgate Motors Ltd 100%
Ferrari Concessionaires Ltd (v) 100%
Gerard Mann Ltd 100%
Inchcape Estates Ltd 100%
Inchcape Motors International Ltd 100%
Inchcape North West Ltd 100%
Inchcape Retail Ltd 100%
Inchcape Trade Parts Ltd 100%
Inchcape Transition Ltd 100%
Inchcape UK Corporate Management Ltd 100%
Inchcape KMG Ltd 100%
Mann Egerton & Co Ltd 100%
Nexus Corporation Ltd 100%
Notneeded No. 144 Ltd 100%
The Cooper Group Ltd 100%
Tozer International Holdings Ltd 100%
Tozer Kemsley Millbourn Automotive Ltd 100%
PO Box 33 Dorey Court Admiral Park St Peter Port GUERNSEY GY1 4AT
St James’s Insurance Ltd 100%
Uruguay
Rambla Baltasar Brum 3028, Montevideo
Autolider Uruguay S.A. 100%
Joint ventures
Percentage
Name and registered address owned
Australia
GOVERNANCE
Level 6, 15 Talavera Road, Macquarie Park, NSW, 2113
Inchcape Financial Services Australia Pty Limited 50%
Chile
Av. Americo Vespucio 1842, Quilicura, Santiago
Sociedad Comercial e Inmobiliaria Autoshopping S.A. 50%
Sociedad Comercial Ecovalor S.A. 50%
Greece
48 Ethnikis Antistaseos Street, Halandri 15231
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
Tefin SA 50%
Unless stated below, all holdings have one type of ordinary share capital:
(i) Ordinary A and Ordinary B shares
(ii) Ordinary shares, B Class shares, J Class shares and L Class shares
(iii) Ordinary shares and E Class shares
(iv) Ordinary shares, A Class shares, C Class shares, D Class shares and E Class shares
(v) Ordinary shares, Ordinary A shares and 8% non-cumulative redeemable preference shares
(vi) Ordinary shares and redeemable cumulative preference shares
SOLICITORS
Herbert Smith Freehills
CORPORATE BROKERS
Jefferies Hoare Govett
JP Morgan Cazenove
WWW.INCHCAPE.COM
REGISTERED NUMBER 609782